Quarterlytics / Industrials / Electrical Equipment & Parts / Espey Mfg. & Electronics Corp. / FY2024 Annual Report

Espey Mfg. & Electronics Corp.
Annual Report 2024

ESP · AMEX Industrials
Claim this profile
Ticker ESP
Exchange AMEX
Sector Industrials
Industry Electrical Equipment & Parts
Employees 148
← All annual reports
FY2024 Annual Report · Espey Mfg. & Electronics Corp.
Loading PDF…
Home 
from 
Home
Empiric Student Property plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic Report
Who We Are 
Values
The customer  
comes first 
Our customer  
experience is  
of paramount  
importance to the 
development of our  
strategic priorities.
We take ownership 
We are reliable, 
respectful, and 
responsive. We do  
what we say we will do.
Culture
Our people are key to 
delivering a high-quality, 
personalised service  
to our customers. 
We work tirelessly to 
create a team who are 
diverse and inclusive, 
agile, proactive, 
thoughtful, 
and responsive.
Our 
purpose
To help students make the most of 
their university life by creating and 
managing some of the highest quality 
and most thoughtfully designed 
accommodation, which is secure, 
modern and homely.
Underpinned by our values and culture

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
01
1	
An alternative performance measure.  
See page 48 for further details.
The business has delivered another year of great progress against its 
strategic objectives, most pleasingly in respect to our growth agenda. 
Having successfully concluded the Company’s first equity raise since 
2017, our focus remains squarely on its deployment and delivery.
2024 saw us add three fantastic new sites to the portfolio growing our existing clusters in 
Bristol, Glasgow and Manchester. We also unlocked value from existing sites with planning 
consent achieved at Victoria Point in Manchester, and have continued to make good progress 
on our programme of refurbishment, driving enhanced rental growth.
Highlights
Financial 
5.6p
IFRS Earnings Per Share (basic)
2023 | 8.8p
Change | -36%
3.7p
Dividend per Share
2023 | 3.5p
Change | +6%
70%
Gross Margin1
2023 | 69%
Change | +1% pt
119.6p
EPRA NTA Per Share1
2023 | 120.7p
Change | -0.9%
27.2%
EPRA Loan to Value1
2023 | 30.6%
Change | -3.4% pts
£1.1bn
Property Valuation
2023 | £1.1bn
Change | +1.6% (LfL)
£801.3m
IFRS NAV
2023 | £734.2m
Change | +9.1%
4.2p
EPRA Earnings Per Share1
2023 | 4.0p
Change | +5%
6.6%
Total Return (3 year, annualised)1
2023 | 7.4%
Change | -0.8% pts
Strategic report
01	
Highlights
02	
At a Glance
04	
Our Market
08	
Business Model
10	
Our Strategy
16	
Chairman’s Statement
20	
Chief Executive Officer’s Review
28	
Monitoring our Performance (KPIs)
32	
Operating Review
38	
Principal Risks and Viability
44	
Financial Review
48	
EPRA and other Alternative Performance 
Measures
52	
ESG Report
Governance report
94	
Chairman’s Introduction  
to Corporate Governance 
98	
Board of Directors
100	
Board Overview
110	
Nomination Committee Report
116	
ESG Committee Report
118	
Audit and Risk Committee Report
123	
Remuneration Committee Report
142	
Directors’ Report
145	
Directors’ Responsibilities
Financial statements
146	
Independent Auditor’s Report
153	
Consolidated Statement of Comprehensive 
Income
154	
Consolidated Statement of Financial Position
155	
Company Statement of Financial Position
156	
Consolidated Statement of Changes in Equity
157	
Company Statement of Changes in Equity
158	
Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows
159	
Notes to the Financial Statements
185	
Glossary
186	
Company Information and Corporate Advisers

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
02
At a glance 
Where we operate
Beds by region as at  
31 December 2024
Scale is representative  
of beds by region
97%
The Empiric portfolio is well aligned 
to high-growth locations with
As at 31 December 2024:
74
Operational Assets
31 December 2023 | 79
7,685
Beds
31 December 2023 | 7,908
23
Cities and Towns
31 December 2023 | 27
North East
152
South East
535
Scotland
1,259
North West
1,448
West  
Midlands
1,086
Wales
519
Yorkshire
1,345
South West
1,341
Empiric offers students some 
of the highest quality and 
most thoughtfully designed 
accommodation which is secure, 
modern and homely, and enables 
them to thrive, learn and succeed.
Our studio-led properties and customer-first philosophy provides some of the  
best experiences available to students. Our boutique proposition allows our people  
to get to know our students and provide a more personalised, responsive service,  
such that we can better support students during their higher-education journey.  
Our properties are typically unique and smaller than most, often incorporating a sense of 
individual character and heritage. This helps foster a sense of community, encouraging 
our students to stay with us for longer, creating their Home from Home.
Home 
from 
Home 
by value classified as either  
Super Prime Regional or 
Prime Regional by our valuer

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
03
Financial snapshot 
As at 31 December 2024
1	
An alternative performance measure.  
See page 48 for further details.
£1.1bn
Portfolio valuation
 £1.1bn
£1.1bn
2024
2023
4.2p
EPRA EPS1
4.2p
4.0p
2024
2023
6.6%
Total Return (3 year, annualised)1
6.6%
7.4%
2024
2023
3.7p
Dividend per share
3.7p
3.5p
2024
2023
119.6p
EPRA NTA1
2024
2023
 119.6p
120.7p
27.2%
EPRA LTV1
27.2%
30.6%
2024
2023
Differentiated  
Business Model  
within the Popular  
PBSA Property Sector
Responsible and 
Industry-Leading 
Operating Brand
Sustainable  
Long-Term  
Business Model
Delivering  
Attractive Sustainable 
Shareholder Returns
Socially and 
Environmentally 
Responsible
Progressive Culture 
Embedded by Core 
Values and Purpose
We target investment in prime regional cities which attract students from the 
growing pool of affluent international, postgraduate and returning undergraduates, 
whose premium accommodation requirements are relatively under-served by 
the PBSA market. This segmented supply and demand imbalance drives both 
occupancy and rental growth, creating relatively high-yielding investments 
providing attractive total returns. 
Hello Student, our operating brand, has become one of the most effective, 
responsible and recognisable in the sector. In the 2024 Global Student Living 
Index, Hello Student was awarded Gold Operator Certification, with an NPS score 
of +32, well exceeding the average for University and Private Halls (+12 and +19 
respectively), and a further improvement on 2023 when we scored +30.5. We pride 
ourselves on high quality customer service and amenities.
There has been consistently strong growth in student numbers over the past 
decade, with strong demand set to continue for the foreseeable future.
We target a gross margin of over 70% and annualised total returns of 7%-9%. 
We are a company who is socially and environmentally responsible. We have set 
an ambitious Net Zero target of no later than 2033 and have allocated significant 
capital to invest in decarbonisation initiatives aimed at reducing energy 
consumption and managing future EPC risk.
Our culture and values are embedded in our business and in our team.
Investment proposition

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
04
Our market
“The UK is the most sought after 
European location for investors 
looking to deploy capital into 
student accommodation.”
Will Atkinson  |  Chief Investment Officer 
+14.7%
in 2024
Super Prime Regional PBSA reported 
the highest capital growth of
During 2024, the UK Purpose-
Built Student Accommodation 
sector continued to demonstrate 
its resilience in the face of wider 
macroeconomic headwinds, 
underpinned by the sustained 
student demand for modern 
accommodation. Investor appetite 
continues to evolve and diversify, 
fuelled by the undersupply of high-
quality operational beds, long-term 
predicted growth in demand and  
a reduced delivery of new supply. 
Strengthening investor appetite for the sector  
was evident in the year’s transaction volumes, with  
Savills reporting growth of 13 per cent year on year,  
and £3.5bn traded(1). The UK is the most sought after  
European location for investors looking to deploy  
capital into student accommodation, despite the relative 
maturity of UK PBSA(2).
PBSA continues to outperform the wider UK property 
sector with the CBRE PBSA Index 2024 showing robust 
returns, delivering annual total returns (to September 
2024) of 9.8 per cent. This compares favourably to 
Industrials which delivered annual returns of 9.7 per cent 
and the overall UK commercial property sector which 
delivered a total return of 7.7 per cent (to December 
2024). The CBRE PBSA Index reports that capital values 
rose faster than in 2023, increasing on average from  
2.4 per cent to 4.0 per cent in 2024. 
Last year’s highest capital growth was in Prime Regional 
assets with this switching in 2024 to the Super Prime 
Regional markets which increased by 14.7 per cent (3).  
Our portfolio is well aligned to both these sub-sectors 
with 97 per cent by value classified as Super Prime 
Regional or Prime Regional at December 2024.
97%
aligned to Super Prime or Prime 
Regional locations.
Our portfolio is
The UK PBSA 
sector continued 
to demonstrate 
its resilience in 
the face of wider 
macroeconomic 
headwinds

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
05
612,000
Full-time postgraduate students, 
now represent over one quarter of  
the total student population.
75%
since academic year 2017/18.
Postgraduate student numbers 
have increased
Occupational demand
The growth of students accelerated immediately after  
the pandemic and has since eased, aligning with the long-
term trend. The number of university students studying 
full-time in the UK has risen by nearly a quarter to 2.4 
million in the five years to 2022/23 (the most recently 
reported academic year), with a further 580,000 students 
attending part-time. 
Overall undergraduate applications in 2024 according 
to UCAS were down 0.3 per cent to 594,940 with a 
continuing trend of declining demand for nursing courses 
down 10 per cent contrasted by growing demand in 
STEM courses with engineering and technology courses 
having seen 10 per cent growth, and applications to both 
mathematical sciences and computing experiencing an 
increase of 7 per cent. The application rate for UK 18-year-
olds was 41.3 per cent, down from 41.5 per cent in 2023, 
but up from 38.2 per cent recorded in 2019. International 
applications increased by 0.7 per cent showing the 
continued attraction of the UK higher education sector. 
The highest increases were from China (+3 per cent),  
Turkey (+37 per cent) and Canada (+14 per cent)(4). 
Applications from other countries, such as Nigeria,  
have seen a significant drop, largely due to the country’s 
high inflation rates(5) and changes in the UK student visa 
scheme in respect of dependants.
The trend in undergraduate acceptances in 2024 reported 
by UCAS shows a slightly different result. Overall there 
has been an increase in students placed onto full-time 
undergraduate courses by 0.9 per cent to 493,940 
which included a record 277,790 UK 18-year-olds being 
accepted. This coincides with a lower acceptance rate for 
international students, with the number of acceptances 
marginally dropping by 0.6 per cent from 61,470 last 
year to 61,110. From those international undergraduate 
applicants, China has remained the largest international 
market even after a 1.9 per cent decline since the  
prior year(6). 
Postgraduate students studying full-time in their first year 
increased by 56,990 to 444,320 in 2022/23 which reflects 
a 75 per cent increase in postgraduate student entrants 
since 2017/18. Overall there were 612,000 full-time 
postgraduate students in 2022/23 representing 25 per 
cent of the overall UK student population and consisting 
of 67 per cent international, 30 per cent UK and 4 per cent 
originating from the EU(7).
PBSA sector’s occupancy is very similar to last year, at 
91.7 per cent, showing only a marginal decrease from 92.6 
per cent in the prior year. Studio flats were the first to let, 
remaining the preferred offering for international students 
as with previous years(5), benefitting from a target 
market in a higher price bracket, setting it apart from 
the competitive cluster flat market. Looking forward, the 
StuRents Annual Report 2024(5) predicts the continuation 
of steady growth into 2024/25 and then beyond driven by 
the growing number of the 18-year-old population which 
is forecast to increase year on year until 2030. Similarly, 
UCAS has reported that the increase in tuition fees from 
£9,250 to £9,535(8) is not expected to affect application 
numbers, in line with the last time fees were increased.

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
06
Our market | continued
beds completed in 2024.
Development of PBSA beds 
remains at a decade low 
11,270
PBSA supply
It is anticipated that the sector will continue to have a 
significant shortfall of beds in 2025, with several factors 
constraining supply(13). Viability remains a key challenge 
for developers, with higher build costs, enhanced building 
safety requirements, sustainability demands, increased 
financing costs and increasingly difficult planning 
environments all discouraging development. Material 
and labour costs are expected to increase further, with 
the BCIS Building Forecast expecting building costs to 
increase 17 per cent over the next 5 years(14). Delivery dates 
have been delayed by the introduction of the Building 
Safety Act, particularly the Gateway Two process(13). 
A two-tier market is developing in UK PBSA. Knight Frank 
report that 65 per cent of existing PBSA supply was built 
before 2012(15), with the majority of stock ageing and 
requiring refurbishment or repositioning. Knight Frank 
report that just under 260,000 new student beds have 
been delivered since 2012. In the same period, almost 
470,000 full-time students have been added to the  
UK university population, exacerbating the supply  
demand imbalance for high-quality accommodation(15). 
Development remains at a decade low, with under  
9,950 beds completing in 2023 and only 11,270  
delivered in 2024(16). By comparison over 30,000 beds 
were completed each year between 2016 and 2020, with 
delivery peaking at 38,600 in 2018(13). Developer sentiment 
is improving in certain cities, reflected in more PBSA 
planning applications brought forward. In the year to 
September 2024, developers sought planning consent for 
30,900 with 25,700 beds approved(5). Supply is becoming 
increasingly focused on the best performing markets 
with 71 per cent of all planning applications in just ten 
UK locations including Bristol, Glasgow and Manchester, 
driven by favourable student demand and higher rents 
improving viability. The shortage of housing options for 
students is also being compounded by a continued loss 
of Houses in Multiple Occupation (“HMO”), with landlords 
due to pay surcharges on additional properties, as 
announced in the October 2024 Budget(13).
Investor activity and transactions
The interest rate environment during 2023 stifled 
transactional activity, but improving sentiment has 
led to higher transaction volumes in 2024, with Savills 
reporting a 13 per cent year on year increase to £3.5bn(1). 
Portfolios traded in the year, including Project Aqua, 
711-beds in Exeter and Glasgow bought by LGIM for 
£122 million reflecting 5.3 per cent and Project Jade, a 
4,335-bed regional portfolio acquired by PGIM for £184 
million, reflecting 6.25 per cent. Standing assets traded in 
London and the regions. Pavilion Court, a 699-bed asset 
in London sold for £125 million to Apollo, reflecting 4.65 
per cent and 99-bed True Student Glasgow West End was 
purchased by Aviva Investors and Curlew for £23 million, 
reflecting £232,000 per bed. In December 2024, Goldman 
Sachs and Generation Partners purchased two assets 
totalling 900 beds in Bournemouth and Cardiff for £108.5 
million, reflecting 6.0 per cent(18).
The year saw a limited number of traditional forward funds 
but some large scale land transactions did transact, with 
Greystar purchasing a 1,014-bed site, One Medlock in 
Manchester, from Dominus, and the 836-bed Triangle site 
in Selly Oak from Apsley Capital and Galliard. In London, 
Unite acquired the 444-bed King’s Place in Southwark(20). 
Transaction volumes increased to
£3.5bn
Representing a 13% year-on-year 
increase on 2023.

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
07
Date
CBRE Benchmark Investment Yields
Dec 22 (%)	
Mar 23 (%)	
Jun 23 (%)	
Sep 23 (%)	
Dec 23 (%)	
Mar 24 (%)	
Jun 24 (%)	
Sep 24 (%)	
Dec 24 (%)
Yield
9.00
8.00
7.00
6.00
5.00
4.00 
3.00
	 Student – Central London 
Direct let
	 Student – Prime Regional 
Direct let
	 Student – Secondary Regional  
Direct let
	 Industrial – Prime Distribution
	 Offices – Regional Cities
Key
Direct-let yields best in class
Benchmark direct let investment yields reported by  
CBRE have remained unchanged in 2024, with Central 
London, Prime Regional and Secondary Regional yields 
stable at 4.25 per cent, 5.0 per cent and 8.5 per cent 
respectively(21). This reflects investor demand for prime 
properties, with investors seeking discounts for assets 
which do not meet best-in-class criteria. The Bank of 
England base rate sharpened 50 basis points in the  
second half of 2024, with a 25 basis point cut from 5.25 
per cent to 5.0 per cent in August, and further 25 basis 
point cut to 4.75 per cent in November(22). Savills report 
strong demand from lenders to deploy capital on high-
quality PBSA opportunities. Although underlying interest 
rates remain elevated, competition is exerting downward 
pressure on margins, with lenders becoming more flexible 
on financing packages to secure opportunities(1).
Looking ahead, the continued growth in 18-year-olds and a 
forecast recovery in non-EU students is expected to further 
drive demand for PBSA beds. Occupancy is expected to 
remain strong and rental growth is forecast to remain in-
line with the long-term average(13). This is however highly 
nuanced in some markets, with higher supply driving 
price sensitivity. The supply of PBSA will continue to be 
constrained by several factors, underpinning PBSA’s 
position as a top-performing sector, attracting new 
entrants and underpinning investor confidence.
Sources:
1 	
Savills. UK PBSA investment hits £3.5bn in 2024, according 
to Savills. Savills News. [Online] 2025. [Cited: 21 January 
2025.] https://www.savills.co.uk/insight-and-opinion/savills-
news/371418/uk-pbsa-investment-hits-%C2%A33.5bn-in-
2024--according-to-savills
2 	
https://pdf.euro.savills.co.uk/uk/spotlight-on/european-
pbsa-investment-barometer-report---2024.pdf
3 	
CBRE. CBRE Purpose-Built Student Accommodation Index 
2024. 2024.
4 	
Advance HE. UCAS - 2024 sees more 18-year-olds apply for 
higher education. Governance News Alert. [Online] [Cited: 22 
January 2025.] https://www.advance-he.ac.uk/knowledge-
hub/2024-sees-more-18-year-olds-apply-for-higher-
education. 
5 	
StuRents. Annual Student Accommodation Report 2024. 
2024.
6	
UCAS. Record Acceptances for UK 18 Year Olds as 
International Growth Flattens Out. [Online] 2024. [Cited:  
5 December 2024.] https://www.ucas.com/corporate/news-
and-key-documents/news/record-acceptances-uk-18-year-
olds-international-growth-flattens-out.
7	
HESA. Higher Education Student Statistics: UK, 2021/22. 
HESA. [Online] 2023. [Cited: 22 January 2025.] https://www.
hesa.ac.uk/news/19-01-2023/sb265-higher-education-
student-statistics
8	
UCAS. Undergraduate Tuition Fees and Student Loans. 
[Online] 2024. [Cited: 5 December 2024.] https://www.ucas.
com/money-and-student-life/money/student-finance/
undergraduate-tuition-fees-and-student-loans.
9	
CBRE. UK Real Estate Market Outlook 2024. 2023.
10	
Bank of England. Official Bank Rate history. [Online] 2024. 
[Cited: 10 December 2024.] https://www.bankofengland.
co.uk/boeapps/database/Bank-Rate.asp.
11	
Savills. The number of applications to UK universities shows 
the demand for Purpose-Built Student Accommodation 
(PBSA) remains positive. The Savills Blog. [Online] 2024. 
[Cited: 20 December 2024.] https://www.savills.co.uk/blog/
article/365003/commercial-property/ucas-application-
numbers-and-the-impact-on-purpose-built-student-
accommodation.aspx.
12	
JLL. Where next for student housing? 2024.
13	
Knight Frank. Knight Frank Student Accommodation Survey 
2024. 2024.
14	
CBRE. UK Real Estate Market Outlook 2025. 2024.
15	
BCIS. BCIS building forecast. BCIS. [Online] 2025. [Cited: 22 
January 2025.] https://bcis.co.uk/news/bcis-construction-
industry-forecast/.
16	
Knight Frank Next Gen 2025.
17	
CBRE 2024 Investment Evidence Schedule 22012025.
18	
Shakespeare Martineau. Purpose-Built Student 
Accommodation (PBSA) is increasingly being developed 
in city centres up and down the UK to meet the growing 
demand from the student population. [Online] 2024. [Cited: 
5 December 2024.] https://www.shma.co.uk/our-thoughts/
renters-reform-bill/.
19	
CBRE 2024 Investment Evidence Schedule 22012025.
20	 JLL. UK Living Capital Markets Q3 2024. 2024.
21	
Savills. UK PBSA investment hits £3.5bn in 2024, according 
to Savills. Savills News. [Online] 2025. [Cited: 21 January 
2025.] https://www.savills.co.uk/insight-and-opinion/savills-
news/371418/uk-pbsa-investment-hits-%C2%A33.5bn-in-
2024--according-to-savills.
22	 CBRE. Investment Yields December 2024. 2024.

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
08
Business model
R
e
c
y
cl
e
O
p
e
ra
t
e
Creating  
homely, modern, 
vibrant communities  
for discerning 
customers
 L
o
c
a
ti
o
n
s
/s
p
e
ci
fi
c
at
i
o
n
s
A
c
q
u
ir
e
/
d
e
v
e
l
o
p
Our culture
Our customers and our people are our key focus. We aim 
to deliver stand-out customer service, which in turn drives 
occupancy and financial returns through working together.
Our business model 
combines a high-quality, 
characterful portfolio of 
Purpose-Built Student 
Accommodation with 
an efficient in-house 
operational platform, 
designed to grow and  
create long-term  
sustainable returns  
for our Stakeholders.
Key strengths
Portfolio
We have an attractive, characterful 
portfolio that offers high-quality,  
well located accommodation for  
our customers.
Our people
Our people are key to our customers’ 
journey. Our passionate and committed 
colleagues allow us to deliver hassle-free 
student accommodation with a sense of 
community and belonging that supports 
mental health and wellbeing.
Specialist knowledge
We have the knowledge to acquire, 
develop and operate high-quality, 
sustainable student accommodation.
Brand
Hello Student® is a leading  
brand providing clear identity 
in the PBSA market.
Data analytics
We drive improvements in customer 
experience and performance through 
data analytics. We seek to understand 
behavioural characteristics using  
both geographic and demographic 
segmentation.
Financing
We have an appropriately leveraged 
balance sheet with strong liquidity, 
allowing the business to be proactive  
and capitalise on opportunities as  
they arise.
How we add value

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
09
Locations/specifications
We are selective about where we invest, with a focus on 
the towns and cities that are home to the most successful 
universities and where student numbers are rising faster 
than average. We select sites based on their compatibility 
with the types of accommodation we provide and their 
proximity to universities and amenities.
Our buildings have on average around 100 beds, which 
helps to foster a more homely, collegiate feeling to living. 
However, through our clustering strategy we are able to 
yield the economies of scale which are generated from 
larger buildings.
Operate
Our assets are marketed through our Hello Student® 
platform, a clear and identifiable brand. Encouraging  
our people to live our values helps ensure that customers 
have the best experience possible, driving improved 
occupancy and returns. We have a student Wellbeing 
Manager and welfare programme in place to ensure that 
we provide the 24/7 support that our customers can 
expect when they stay with us.
Acquire/develop
We acquire standing assets when an opportunity  
arises which complements our portfolio and  
core strategy.
We consider developing assets when we can acquire them 
at a higher yield on cost than acquiring standing assets. 
Forward-funded projects are typically less complex than 
direct developments and have a lower risk profile, as the 
planning and construction and risk lies with the third-
party developer. However, we have a strong and proven 
track record in direct development too.
Recycle
We invest in our portfolio for the long term, however  
we continually review the portfolio to ensure capital  
is effectively allocated. Where an opportunity  
exists to create improved returns for shareholders  
we are unemotive about recycling capital to create  
greater value.
Customers
Our customers benefit from having a great 
home to live in during their studies, at all-in 
rent that represents best value.
NPS in the Global Student Living Index
+32
Higher than PBSA private hall average +19
Shareholders
Shareholders benefit from Total Returns 
which are underpinned by income and 
continued rental growth.
6.6%
Annualised 3 year 2.0%
1 year
Our people
Our people have the opportunity to develop 
their careers in an exciting and growing sector.
Colleague Engagement Score
78%
Suppliers
Fostering long-term relationships with high 
performance, service-oriented suppliers and 
service providers who align with our values.
Communities
The communities in which we operate  
benefit from increased employment,  
reduced pressure on local housing stock,  
and from the improvements we fund to  
social infrastructure in the surrounding area.
Outcomes

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
10
Our strategy
1
Customers
2
Brand
3
Our People and Operations
4
Building
5
Shareholders
Delivering 
against our 
strategic 
objectives 
KPI links
A.	 Rebooker Rate
B.	 Net Promoter Score
C.	 Revenue Occupancy
D.	 Safety – Number  
of Accidents
E.	 Colleague 
Engagement
F.	 Energy consumed  
per bed
G.	 EPC risk mitigation
H.	 Gross Margin
I. 	 EPRA earnings per 
share
J.	 Dividend Cover
K.	 EPRA Net Tangible 
Assets per share
L.	 Total Return
Risk links
External risks
E1.	 Revenue Risk 
E2.	Property Market Risk 
E3.	Climate Change Risk
E4.	Financing Risk
E5.	Inflation Risk
Internal risks
I1.	 Health and Safety Risk
I2.	 Information 
Technology Risk
I3.	 People Risk
I4.	 Safe and Sustainable 
Buildings Risk

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
11
1 Customers
Principal Risks  |  page 38
Strategy in Action  |  page 26
#1
Best Student Wellbeing 2024
Awarded by GSLI
69%
now resolved within 72 hours
Customer queries
Monitoring our Performance (KPIs)  |  page 28
Associated KPIs
A
B
C
D
F
Associated risks
E1
E4
E3
I3
I4
Strategic objective
Our customers are at the heart of what we 
do. We want our customers to have a great 
experience and stay with us year after year 
and to recommend us to their friends. 
We aim to achieve customer satisfaction 
by creating vibrant communities in our 
homes and by giving our customers a sense 
of safety, wellbeing and belonging in an 
environment of high-quality communal 
areas and facilities.
We aim to deliver a friendly personalised 
service and be there when our customers 
need us.
Progress in the year
	î Our net promoter score was +32,  
compared to PBSA private halls  
average +19.
	î 69% of customer queries now resolved  
within 72 hours.
	î 20 properties ranked within top three by 
StudentCrowd in cities across the UK.
	î Awarded Best Student Wellbeing 
by GSLI.
Key aims for 2025
	î Continued progression in NPS.
	î Drive improving StudentCrowd ranking  
and happiness score.

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
12
Our strategy | continued
2 Brand
Progress in the year
	î Launched new website improving 
booking experience. 
	î Launched WeChat mini programme to 
engage directly with Chinese students. 
	î Refreshed research into ‘What students 
want’ from their rooms and their 
buildings and how they want to live 
together, helping to inform brand 
evolution.
Strategic objective
We want to raise awareness of the  
Hello Student® brand among students,  
to support our premium accommodation 
and service offering. We want to be known 
as a responsible provider.
Key aims for 2025
	î Continue brand roll-out. 
	î Launch ‘Out of Home’ student podcast.
	î Refine customer experience roadmap.
+32
compared to PBSA private halls  
average +19
Our net promoter score
#1
in six cities in which we operate
StudentCrowd ranking
Principal Risks  |  page 38
Monitoring our Performance (KPIs)  |  page 28
Associated KPIs
A
B
C
D
G
H
Associated risks
E1
E3
I1
I2
I3
I4

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
13
3 Our people and operations
Principal Risks  |  page 38
Strategic objective
We are committed to making Empiric  
“a great place to work” and destination  
of choice for candidates wanting to work  
in the student accommodation sector; 
through this we will be able to deliver  
a high standard of customer service.
We will continually enhance our in-house 
functions and performance coach our 
colleagues to help them provide the  
best and most efficient customer  
service experience.
Progress in the year
	î Launched ‘Hello Future Stars’ leadership 
development programme. 
	î Employee retention maintained at 78%.
	î Diversity target set for Senior 
Leadership Team.
61%
of eligible vacancies filled  
by internal promotions
Vacancies and promotions
21%
of responding employees identify  
as being from an ethnic minority
Ethnic minorities
Monitoring our Performance (KPIs)  |  page 28
Associated KPIs
Associated risks
E1
I1
E3
E4
I2
I3
I4
A
B
C
D
E
Key aims for 2025
	î Review and enhance reward and recognition 
offering.
	î Implement diversity strategy.
	î Rationalise operating model for city structure 
to drive efficiencies. 

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
14
Our strategy | continued
4 Building
Principal Risks  |  page 38
Monitoring our Performance (KPIs)  |  page 28
Associated KPIs
Associated risks
Strategy in Action  |  page 36
Strategic objective
We will maximise the value from the asset 
portfolio by actively managing the portfolio  
to recycle capital and to improve returns 
and sustainability. This is achieved by 
maintaining a portfolio of well located 
investments with attractive yields and  
rental growth opportunities.
Progress in the year
	î Three acquisitions completed in  
top-tier cities.
	î Completed full refurbishment of 
Brunswick Apartments, Southampton.
	î 73% of portfolio EWS1 certified.
	î Detailed planning consent achieved 
for the addition of 310 new beds at 
Victoria Point, Manchester. 
173
rooms across the portfolio in 2024
Refurbishment of
£45m
generated from sales in 2024
Non-core disposal programme
A
B
C
D
F
G
H
E1
E2
E3
E5
I1
I2
I4
Key aims for 2025
	î Continue to grow beds under management.
	î Develop implementation plan for Victoria 
Point, Manchester.
	î Continue roll-out of Postgrad product in three 
further cities. 

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
15
5 Shareholders
Principal Risks  |  page 38
Strategic objective
We want to provide our shareholders  
with attractive sustainable returns. 
This is achieved through improving the 
profitability, performance and scale of  
our portfolio. 
Progress in the year
	î Delivered 6% increase in total dividend 
paid for year. 
	î Improved engagement on ESG matters 
placing targets to advisory vote at AGM.
	î Expanded investor relations programme 
with engagement in corporate access 
days and hosting property tours in 
Bristol, Glasgow and Edinburgh. 
3.7p
+6% on 2023
Dividend
6.6%
annualised 3 year
2.0%
for the year
Total accounting return
Monitoring our Performance (KPIs)  |  page 28
Associated KPIs
Associated risks
A
B
C
D
F
G
I
K
H
J
L
E1
E2
E3
E4
E5
I1
I2
I3
I4
Key aims for 2025
	î Deploy proceeds from equity raise in line with 
commitments and demonstrate accretion.
	î Engage with shareholders on new 
remuneration policy. 
	î Improve diversity. 

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
16
Given the backdrop of challenging 
market conditions presented by 
changes in government policy and 
ongoing inflationary cost pressures, 
the Company has delivered another 
strong operational performance in 
2024, with like for like rental growth 
across the financial year in excess of 
nine per cent, strong occupancy and 
improving customer service scores. 
Chairman’s statement
“Despite challenging market conditions,  
good progress has been made this year  
on our growth agenda.”
Mark Pain  |  Non-Executive Chairman
Macro-outlook 
remains 
positive for the 
foreseeable 
future

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
17
The business has made good progress on its growth 
agenda. In the first half of the year, we acquired two 
well-located properties in top-tier university cities where 
we had an existing operational presence, allowing us to 
exploit the benefits of our clustering model. 
In October, a successful capital raise was concluded 
raising £56.1 million, over half of which has been 
deployed or committed into accretive acquisitions and 
refurbishment opportunities as at 31 December 2024. 
I would like to thank our existing and new shareholders 
for their support and confidence in the Company’s 
proposition and strategy. 
In December, in line with plans outlined to investors 
alongside the capital raise, a third new site was acquired 
in Manchester and the team remain focused on the timely 
deployment of residual proceeds. Also in Manchester, 
in support of our growth agenda, we achieved planning 
consent for a comprehensive redevelopment at Victoria 
Point, which when implemented will add over 300 beds  
to this strong operational cluster and acutely 
undersupplied city. 
Performance & dividend
With occupancy of 99 per cent for the 2023/24 
academic year and 97 per cent for the 2024/25 academic 
year, demand remains strong for our high-quality 
accommodation. Like for like rental growth comfortably 
exceeded inflation at 10.5 per cent and 7.0 per cent 
respectively. 
Pleasingly, our customer service scores continue 
to surpass many of our competitors with further 
improvement achieved on NPS, which now sits at +32, 
considerably ahead of All Private Halls of +19. We were  
also pleased to be voted number one on Student Crowd  
in two cities in which we operate. 
Having set a dividend target for the financial year of 
3.5 pence per share, we are pleased that despite the 
challenges faced, the performance of the business 
continues to support a progressive dividend and we have 
increased our payment for the 2024 financial year to  
3.7 pence per share, a six per cent increase on 2023. 
The Board intends to continue to make quarterly 
payments to shareholders throughout 2025. It is the 
Board’s intention that dividends remain fully covered  
by recurring earnings and are progressive in nature.  
The Board will initially target a minimum dividend of  
3.7 pence per share for the financial year to  
31 December 2025.
Governance
Although the Board had a schedule of regular meetings 
and informal calls throughout the year, a number of 
additional meetings were held to discuss a prospective 
joint venture to promote growth and accelerate the roll 
out of the Group’s postgraduate product. However, after 
careful consideration the Board decided to end these 
discussions, noting that the timing of implementation 
was at risk and the associated disruption to the 
Company’s business plan was not in the best interests 
of shareholders. With a change in market sentiment the 
Board recognised an opportunity to conduct a capital 
raise allowing the Company to pursue these objectives 
independently. 
Further details regarding the Board, its operations and 
the reports from its various Committees can be found on 
pages 100 to 141.
Building a sustainable business
The Board is committed to creating a sustainable business 
with a positive social, environmental and economic legacy 
for all stakeholders and has set clear targets in order to 
achieve Net Zero as a business by 2033. We have been 
pleased to see the impact of energy efficiency initiatives 
beginning to feed through to falling average energy use 
per bed. Our 2025 EPC target has already been exceeded 
with 64 per cent of the portfolio categorised as EPC B  
or above. 
In order to further improve transparency, and in response 
to requests from shareholders, the Board will participate 
in an ESG disclosure and benchmarking process with 
CDP annually from 31 December 2025, with the first set of 
findings from this exercise due to be published in 2026. 
We are also pleased to report that our Scope 3 emissions 
and carbon balance sheet are disclosed for the first time 
this year, details of which can be found on page 89.
97%
occupancy rate for the 
2024/25 academic year, with 
99% occupancy achieved for 
the 2023/24 academic year

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
18
Chairman’s statement | continued
The wellbeing of our customers and employees is always 
paramount and we were delighted to win the Best Student 
Wellbeing award for UK and Ireland at this year’s GSLI 
Awards. With the mental health of our students remaining 
a key focus area, we introduced mental health first aid 
training at many of our sites and it’s pleasing to see this 
being recognised within the industry.
Health and Safety
Health and Safety is the responsibility of the Board and 
reports are regularly provided to keep Directors updated 
of incidents or improvements. Health, safety and fire 
audits were conducted and completed during the year 
and a three-year plan is currently being progressed to 
enhance our monitoring and investment to ensure all our 
buildings are as safe and secure as possible. 
Diversity, succession and culture
There have been no changes to the Board this year, 
extending a period of stability and resulting in another 
solid Board evaluation. However, with no change in Board 
membership, it has not been possible to address the 
diversity targets set by the Parker and the FTSE Women 
Leaders Review. Steps have been taken to improve 
diversity within the wider business, and this is discussed 
further on page 114. The results of the Board evaluation 
can be found on page 112.
Succession plans for the Executive Directors and 
Executive Committee have been prepared on both a short 
and long-term basis, prospective internal candidates 
identified, and a bespoke leadership development 
programme introduced to help prepare them for their 
potential future role. 
The Company has identified a number of metrics which 
will help it monitor and improve the culture within the 
business and for its customers. These include the NPS and 
eNPS scores, which we consider to be interlinked and will 
support our purpose, values and strategy. Further details 
can be found on page 101.
Annual General Meeting
Although all resolutions were passed at the Annual 
General Meeting held on 22 May 2024, the advisory vote 
regarding the ESG commitments for 2024 and 2025 
received a 25 per cent vote against. In order to better 
understand the result, and inform future decision making, 
engagement with shareholders was sought post the 
Annual General Meeting (“AGM”) and directly with certain 
shareholders during the Company’s results roadshows 
during August and September. It appears in part that 
shareholders would prefer to see a clearer articulation 
between cost and returns that can be expected for each 
of the targets set and this will be addressed when the 
targets are next put to shareholder vote in 2026. 
The Company’s 2025 AGM will be held on 4 June 2025. 
Shareholders are encouraged to take the opportunity to 
meet with and pose questions to members of the Board. 
Further details about the time and location of the meeting 
are provided in the Notice of AGM which will be published 
separately and available on the Company’s website.
Looking ahead
With student demand remaining strong and 
attractiveness of the UK’s top-quality universities 
continuing to attract international appeal, the macro-
outlook remains positive for the foreseeable future.
However, in the short term we, like many businesses, 
continue to face challenges. Higher employment related 
costs, significant increases in minimum wage and the 
sustained rebasing of energy costs all require careful 
management and strategic thought.
We remain steadfast in our commitment to our shareholders. 
We will continue to focus on growth, offering top quality 
accommodation alongside improving customer service. 
This allows us to drive rental growth whilst continuing to 
offer value for money to discerning students. 
Finally, on behalf of the Board, I would like to thank our 
employees and all our stakeholders who have continued 
to support the Company during the year. With your 
support, we look to the future with continued optimism.
Mark Pain  |  Non-Executive Chairman
12 March 2025
3.7p
The Board will target 
a minimum dividend 
payment of 
per share for 2025

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
19
24/7
Students have access  
to our welfare programme
“The Company has identified a 
number of metrics which will help 
it monitor and improve the culture 
within the business and for its 
customers.”

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
20
Chief Executive Officer’s review 
Delivery of 
growth agenda 
remains our 
strategic focus
The business has delivered another 
strong financial and operational 
performance during 2024.
“2024 saw us add three fantastic new sites to  
the portfolio, growing our existing clusters 
in Bristol, Glasgow and Manchester. We 
also unlocked value from existing sites with 
planning consent achieved at Victoria Point in 
Manchester, and have continued to make good 
progress on our programme of refurbishment, 
driving enhanced rental growth.”
Duncan Garrood  |  Chief Executive Officer

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
21
53%
Record eligible re-booker 
performance
In validation of our strategy, student demand for 
high-quality accommodation aligned to the UK’s best 
universities has remained strong. Rental growth captured 
for the academic year 2024/25 lettings cycle exceeded 
our initial expectations and delivered growth of seven  
per cent on a like for like basis.
Reflecting the continued strong demand for our product, 
occupancy of 97 per cent was achieved across the 
portfolio for the 2024/25 academic year. Occupancy 
was slightly below the exceptional levels achieved in the 
previous two academic years of 99 per cent, but in line 
with our target. 
Leeds and Sheffield, where eight per cent of our beds are 
located, experienced a decline in occupancy this year.  
A trend witnessed across the wider purpose built student 
accommodation (“PBSA”) market. In Leeds this was 
partly as a result of an increase in the number of new Buy 
to Let properties coming onto the market in the middle 
of the lettings cycle, which were widely reported as 
being let to students. We do not expect this to continue 
as the letting window settles into a full year cycle and 
investors focus on longer stay occupants at higher rates. 
Furthermore, the prospective changes within the Renters 
Rights Bill could make letting to students considerably 
less attractive for non-PBSA operators, including HMOs. 
In Sheffield, the University of Sheffield experienced a 
fall in international student numbers this year, however 
universities have experienced success in taking a more 
active approach to international student recruitment and 
this should continue to drive student numbers toward 
the country’s top-tier universities. Our expectation is 
that this disruption should not impact the longer-term 
attractiveness of these two cities given their Universities 
are both ranked in the 2025 Times Top 30 universities in 
the UK.
Despite widespread publicity about international student 
numbers, created in part by the previous government’s 
amendment to student visa rules, strategic review of the 
graduate route and negative rhetoric around student 
immigration, our market share of international students 
has increased in the current sitting academic year. 
Demographically, international students now represent  
69 per cent of all bookings (up from 51 per cent in 
academic year 2023/24), with Chinese students remaining 
our largest international market at 40 per cent, up from  
32 per cent in the prior year.
The 2024/25 sales campaign delivered another record  
re-booker performance, with 23 per cent of our rooms 
sold to students who were already staying with us. 
Adjusting for those students who were not eligible to 
rebook, for example where their course concluded in 
academic year 2023/24, we achieved an eligible re-booker 
rate of 53 per cent. This is a great achievement and 
tangible endorsement of customer satisfaction and the 
value inherent in our service proposition. 
Underpinned by strong rental growth and stable yields, 
our portfolio valuation grew a further 1.6 per cent like for 
like, 4.2 per cent when the abolition of Multiple Dwellings 
Relief is disregarded. The balance sheet remains in good 
shape with prudent gearing of 27.2 per cent which sits 
comfortably within our long term target, providing a 
degree of headroom. All near-term refinancing risk has 
been removed.
Our October 2024 equity raise was well received and I 
thank our long standing shareholders for their continued 
support and also welcome new shareholders to the 
register. We raised gross proceeds of £56.1 million at 
a four per cent discount to the closing share price the 
day prior to launch, which are being used to pursue 
an independent growth strategy of acquisition and 
refurbishment, negating the need for a prospective joint 
venture as was initially considered.
We have been pleased to grow our dividend again this 
year, delivering progression of six per cent year on year  
for shareholders.

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
22
Chief Executive Officer’s review | continued
+32
NPS improved further to 
Resilient market fundamentals
The PBSA market continues to demonstrate resilience 
in the face of wider macroeconomic headwinds, 
underpinned by sustained student demand for 
prestigious UK universities and modern accommodation. 
Investor appetite is fuelled by the undersupply of high-
quality operational beds, long-term predicted growth 
in demand and constrained delivery of new supply with 
reducing supply of the traditional [alterative] HMO 
accommodation.
Overall the demand and supply imbalance in PBSA 
continues unabated, however this is highly nuanced in 
some markets, which have greater supply, demonstrating 
a level of price sensitivity. Participation rates in the 
UK’s higher education sector remains historically high 
with over 2.4 million full-time students. The UK remains 
an attractive, high quality, and relatively affordable 
destination of choice for international students compared 
to other markets, with students of Chinese origin 
continuing to dominate the UK’s international  
student market.
The growth in student numbers, which accelerated post 
pandemic has since normalised, aligning with longer 
term trends. The continued growth in domestic 18-year-
olds and a forecast recovery in international students is 
expected to ensure this continues to remain robust.  
The recent three per cent increase in the tuition fee cap 
to £9,535 is not expected to impact application numbers 
from UK domestic students.
A clear flight to quality continues with higher tariff, 
typically the Russell Group’s research-led, universities 
experiencing year on year growth in applications to the 
detriment of medium and lower tariff universities.  
This validates our strategy of focusing our portfolio on 
these cities, which deliver growth and investment.
It is anticipated that the sector will continue to have a 
significant shortfall in supply, with only 11,270 new beds 
delivered in 2024. Viability remains a key challenge 
for developers, with higher build costs, increased 
development periods, enhanced building safety 
requirements, sustainability demands, increased financing 
costs and a challenging planning environment continuing 
to discourage development.
Supply will therefore be increasingly focused on the 
best performing markets which are fuelled by continued 
favourable student demand where higher rents improve 
development viability. The shortage of housing options 
for students is also being compounded by the continued 
loss of HMOs, exacerbated by the recent Autumn Budget 
and proposals within the Renters Rights Bill which 
currently continues its way through Parliament.
Portfolio growth and active property management
It has been an active and successful year from a portfolio 
management perspective. Eight residual non-core 
properties were disposed of during 2024, generating 
£45.2 million and reducing the number of cities in  
which we operate by four. These sales represented  
433 operational beds and have improved our portfolio’s 
alignment to prime and super prime locations to  
97 per cent.
Since March 2021, including the above, the Company has 
generated £146.4 million from the disposal of non-core 
assets, 0.2 per cent below book value in aggregate, which 
considering the challenging market conditions during this 
period, is a strong endorsement of our portfolio valuation.
In February 2024, we acquired a small development 
opportunity in Bristol for £5.6 million. This former office 
building is located adjacent to our existing College 
Green building. A planning application was submitted to 
facilitate a change in use to student accommodation and 
the delivery of over 50 new PBSA beds into this strong 
operational cluster. Preparatory works have also begun at 
two sites in Southampton and Bath which are earmarked 
for conversion to the Company’s postgraduate product. 
A planning application was submitted in May 2024 to 
facilitate an extension and full refurbishment of our 
existing operational site at Victoria Point in Manchester. 
In December, Manchester City Council granted detailed 
planning permission fully in line with our application, 
which once fully implemented will add 310 new beds into 
this acutely undersupplied city.
In July 2024, the Company acquired a 94-bed operational 
asset in the heart of Glasgow’s west end for £9.7 million. 
The property is well located, near our Willowbank hub site 

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
23
in the city, and acquired almost entirely pre-let for the 
2024/25 academic year, delivering an effective net initial 
yield of over 7.5 per cent. The property benefits from 
refurbishment potential, which together with the benefits 
of clustering is expected to unlock an enhanced rental 
tone and deliver improved operating margins for the city.
In December 2024, following our equity raise, we 
acquired a 136-bed all studio scheme in Manchester for 
£19.75 million. Again, the property is well located close 
to Manchester University and opposite our existing 
Victoria Point hub site in the city, delivering the same 
value enhancing opportunities that can be delivered in 
Glasgow. The operational asset is expected to deliver a  
7.0 per cent net initial yield from September 2025.
A second acquisition, linked to the equity raise 
deployment plan, is under offer with advanced 
negotiations anticipated to conclude shortly.  
We will provide a further update once concluded. 
One of our larger properties, Brunswick Apartments, 
Southampton, which had been closed for the duration 
of the 2023/24 academic year, reopened to students in 
September 2024. This 173 bed property received a full 
room and amenity refurbishment, alongside fire safety 
and Net Zero related works and has delivered strong 
rental growth, double digit IRR performance and received 
excellent customer feedback.
Delivering high-quality, consistent customer service
Our key performance indicator for the delivery of this 
strategic priority is Global Student Living’s Net Promoter 
Score (“NPS”). 
In both surveys conducted during 2024, our operating 
brand, Hello Student, achieved an improved NPS relative 
to 2023. We end the year with an NPS score of +32 (2023: 
+30.5), significantly outperforming the benchmark All 
Private Halls score of +19.
Of all respondents, 86 per cent rated their level of 
satisfaction as either good or very good with 78 per cent 
of our customers responding that their accommodation 
had a positive impact on their overall well-being. 
This important aspect of our service proposition was 
recognised at this year’s Global Student Living awards, 
when Hello Student was awarded the accolade for Best 
Student Wellbeing.
The delivery of superior service requires a high performing 
and engaged team and we therefore monitor employee 
engagement as a key non-financial performance indicator. 
In 2024, the Company celebrated its tenth anniversary 
since establishment and to mark the occasion, the 
executive team hosted a series of team engagement 
days around the country celebrating this milestone but 
also setting out its vision for the future and providing 
all employees with the opportunity to engage with the 
executives on a one-to-one basis. Our engagement 
scores benchmark well amongst some of the top 
performing UK companies.
We have invested in a new end to end ERP system and 
launched a new customer facing website during 2024, 
which has improved the booking experience, making it 
even easier for customers to secure their room with us. 
Safety
We are responsible for ensuring that everyone who is 
living, working in or visiting our buildings is kept safe.  
We ensure that our buildings comply with not only all 
relevant regulations but strive to align to best practice 
within the industry.
Having allocated £46 million toward a five year 
programme of initiatives which began in 2021, we have 
continued to progress works on a risk-based basis. 
In 2024 we invested a further £13.2 million towards 
attainment of the latest EWS1 certification standard, an 
investment which is fully reflected in property valuations. 
By 31 December 2024, 73 per cent of the portfolio had 
achieved this certification standard.
Our buildings continue to be inspected on a regular 
basis to ensure that we identify and eliminate hazards. 
To assess the buildings, we have engaged with specialist 
consultants to undertake thorough assessments of 
general safety, hazards, prevention of fire risks and  
water systems.
“We remain encouraged 
by the outlook for student 
numbers for the 2025/26 
academic year and beyond, 
from both a domestic and 
international perspective.” 

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
24
Chief Executive Officer’s review | continued
The business conducted its first externally supported 
crisis management test in 2024, simulating a serious 
wellbeing concern alongside a fire in a vacant building. 
Good feedback was received from our primary authority 
fire service on our partnership and approach to incident 
management.
Creating a sustainable business 
The business remains committed to achieving Net Zero 
by 2033. As part of this journey, our plan, including 
interim targets for the next two years, was put to an 
advisory shareholder vote at the 2024 Annual General 
Meeting, helping foster transparency and engagement 
with shareholders on this important topic. Although 
the resolution was passed, the result was somewhat 
disappointing, with 25 per cent of responding 
shareholders voting against. In order to better understand 
the result, and inform future decision making, we sought 
engagement with shareholders. From those shareholders 
that provided feedback, it appeared in part that they 
required a clearer articulation between the cost and 
return that could be expected for each target. This will be 
addressed when next put to shareholders in 2026.
The key performance indicators we monitor are EPC risk 
management and energy consumption per bed. Great 
progress has been made in the management of EPC 
risk this year, with 64 per cent of our sites rated EPC B 
or better, a target achieved more than a year earlier as 
envisaged in our Net Zero strategic plan. Our like for 
like energy consumption per bed has fallen by three per 
cent to 4,351 kwh per bed, reflective of our investment in 
energy efficiency initiatives.
Further details are set out in the ESG Report on page 52.
Strategy and outlook
As we look forward into 2025, we remain encouraged 
by the outlook for student numbers for the 2025/26 
academic year and beyond, from both a domestic 
and international perspective. Growth in the number 
of UK 18 year olds is set to continue through to 2030, 
and internationally, we have seen a considerably more 
welcoming rhetoric from the new education minister  
and greater focus by universities on international  
student recruitment.
We are therefore confident of achieving another 
successful year from an occupancy perspective and 
believe our strategy of refurbishment and our focus on 
continually improving levels of customer satisfaction will 
deliver like for like rental growth in excess of inflation.
Our strategic focus will remain on driving operational 
efficiencies through growth. First and foremost, the 
continued deployment of proceeds from our October 
2024 equity raise, the continued roll out of our Postgrad 
by Hello Student brand, completing our undergraduate 
refurbishment programme, but also as opportunities 
arise, selectively recycling capital to further strengthen 
our alignment to top-tier universities.
The year ahead will, however, not be without its 
challenges. The sustained rebasing of energy costs looks 
set to continue for the foreseeable future and this will be 
coupled with the impact of the autumn budget and annual 
review of the national Real Living Wage, both of which 
are set to drive compensation related costs significantly 
higher from April. This has precipitated a review of our 
operating model and will likely result in some amount of 
restructuring. Our decision not to pursue a joint venture 
also enables us to reduce resources pre-recruited in  
its anticipation.
Despite the challenges faced this past year, we are 
delighted to be in a position to declare a dividend in 
excess of our initial 3.5 pence target for 2024. Today we 
have announced our final quarterly dividend for 2024 
of 1.075 pence per share taking the total dividend paid 
and payable in respect of 2024 to 3.7 pence per share, an 
increase of six per cent on 2023. With the Board remaining 
committed to a progressive dividend policy, we will 
therefore initially target a minimum dividend of 3.7 pence 
per share for the 2025 financial year.
Duncan Garrood  |  Chief Executive Officer
12 March 2025
“We believe our strategy 
of refurbishment 
and our focus on 
continually improving 
levels of customer 
satisfaction will deliver 
like for like rental 
growth in excess  
of inflation.”

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
25
3.7p
Dividend
minimum target for 2025

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
26
Strategy in action 
Mental health and wellbeing are  
of the utmost importance to us  
as a business both commercially  
and as a duty of care for the 
continued safety of our customers 
and our people.
Training 
Two Mental Health First Aid courses were delivered by our 
Wellbeing Manager who is a qualified Mental Health First 
Aid instructor. The aggregated scores demonstrated an 
impressive increase in confidence and knowledge among 
participants. Reported confidence in addressing mental 
health incidents rose from 6.1 to 8.8, and knowledge 
scores improved from 5.9 to 9.2. These outcomes are a 
testament to the effectiveness in empowering attendees 
to handle mental health concerns with greater assurance 
and competence.
Improving provision for customers with  
additional needs 
To improve the handling of reasonable adjustments, eight 
new documents were created and launched to assist team 
members in supporting our customers with disabilities. 
These included guidance for writing Personal Emergency 
Evacuation Plans and how to handle assistance animal and 
reasonable adjustment requests. 
These developments ensure that customers receive 
accurate information and feel supported from the 
moment they book, while also bringing the Company  
into full compliance with the Equality Act.
Mitigating risk 
Amendments to our standard form tenancy agreement 
were made to mitigate operational risks. Key changes 
included implementing a minimum age requirement for 
overnight guests, addressing safeguarding concerns, and 
introducing a clause to prohibit accommodation  
of individuals with unspent criminal convictions.  
These improvements have been adopted and aid 
enhanced customer wellbeing within our buildings,  
while reducing the organisation’s exposure to risk.
Leadership  
in  
wellbeing 

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
27
78%
of Hello Student customers stated  
that their accommodation has an overall 
positive impact on their wellbeing.
GSLI survey results
Supporting wellbeing in a 24 hour business
In our 24-hour business, we understand that customers 
can face significant wellbeing challenges outside of 
typical working hours. These situations can place unique 
demands on our team members, especially when they are 
working alone. To provide comprehensive support, the 
Operational Risk and Wellbeing team has developed a 
dedicated SharePoint site offering:
	î Mental health guidance to help our teams spot the 
warning signs of mental ill health;
	î Signposting information to help connect customers 
with appropriate resources; and
	î A repository of newly created documentation outlining 
how we assist customers during times of crisis.
This site is a cornerstone of our commitment to ensuring 
that team members have the guidance and tools needed 
to provide effective support, even during the most 
difficult situations.
Raising the profile
Our Wellbeing Manager was invited to be a panel 
member at the 2024 GSLI conference, where our 
commitment to promoting wellbeing provision at 
our sites was showcased. Our efforts were reflected 
in the GSLI survey results, where customers rated 
whether they considered their accommodation team 
cared about their wellbeing. Hello Student scored 
well at 74 per cent, with 78 per cent stating that their 
accommodation has an overall positive impact on  
their wellbeing. 
We were delighted to have our 
efforts recognised within the 
industry and awarded Best 
Wellbeing Provision for UK & 
Ireland at the 2024 GSLI awards.

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
28
Non-Financial KPIs
Our strategy
Performance
Performance
+32
23%
23%
22%
2024
2023
+32
+30.5
Purpose
The rebooker rate demonstrates our ability to retain 
customers within the Hello Student® brand, which is an 
indicator of the quality of service we provide.
How we measure
Percentage of students staying with us in the previous year 
who chose to stay with us this year in either the same room 
or another room in the same site or city, expressed as a 
percentage of total rooms sold. 
Associated KPIs
1
2
3
4
5
A   Rebooker Rate (%) 
2024
2023
Purpose
Allows us to benchmark against our peers.
How we measure
Calculated by the Global Student Living Index from 
responses received from students staying with us and 
submitting answers to a standardised questionnaire.
Associated KPIs
1
2
3
4
5
B   Net Promoter Score
Our key performance indicators  
are central to our business and  
allow us to monitor our performance 
against commitments made to  
our stakeholders. 
Linked to strategic priorities and 
management incentives, these are 
designed to align with shareholder 
returns and drive accountability.
Monitoring 
our 
performance 

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
29
Performance
64%
Performance
Performance
51%
4,351kWh
2024
78%
4,351kWh
4,481kWh
2023
Performance
2024
2023
78%
Purpose
A key metric to monitor the progress towards achieving 
2,000 kWh per bed by 2033.
How we measure
Total building energy intensity divided by the number of 
operational beds on a like for like basis
85%
Associated KPIs
Performance
2
3
F   Energy consumed per bed (kWh)
0
2024
2023
Purpose
A key metric to allow us to monitor progress towards  
improving average EPC ratings and delivery of this aspect  
of our Net Zero strategy.
How we measure
Percentage of properties by value which have been certified  
EPC B or better.
Associated KPIs
3
5
97%
Purpose
Colleague engagement scores provide an insight into the 
happiness of our people across a range of topics regarding 
their working environment.
How we measure
Satisfaction rated based on a standardised questionnaire 
sent to all employees.
 G   EPC risk mitigation  
(EPC B or better) (%)
Associated KPIs
0
64%
1
2
3
4
5
E   Colleague Engagement (%) 
97%
2024
2023
99%
Purpose
This is a key reporting metric to the Health & Safety 
Executive as well as a measure of our health and safety 
strategy and procedures.
How we measure
The number of reportable incidents throughout the  
Group each year. 
Associated KPIs
AY 2024/25
AY 2023/24
1
2
3
4
5
Purpose
Revenue occupancy demonstrates the quality and location 
of our assets, the strength of our sales process and our 
ability to set appropriate rents.
How we measure
Calculated as a percentage of gross annualised revenue we 
have secured for a given academic year.
Associated KPIs
1
2
3
4
5
C   Revenue Occupancy (%)
D   Safety – Number of Accidents
Strategic Links 
1.	
Customers
2.	 Brand 
3.	 People and Operations
4.	 Buildings
5.	 Shareholders
Definitions
For definitions see page 185.
1

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
30
Purpose
The gross margin reflects our ability to drive occupancy  
and to control our operating costs.
How we measure
Gross profit expressed as a percentage of rental income.
Associated KPIs
2
3
5
2024
Purpose
Change reflects the aggregate value created or lost during 
the year, through both change in retained capital value and 
value returned to shareholders in the form of dividends.
How we measure
Percentage change in EPRA Net Tangible Assets per share 
across the financial year plus dividends paid during the 
financial year.
Associated KPIs
5
2024
2023
6.6%
7.4%
6.6%
Performance
L   Total Return (3 year, annualised) 
2023
70%
69%
Purpose
A consistent measure of recurring earnings which provides 
comparability and a measure upon which dividend 
payments are based and assessed.
How we measure
Industry standard earnings metric, calculated in line with 
EPRA best practice recommendations.
70%
Performance
H   Gross Margin (%) 
Associated KPIs
Purpose
Movement in EPRA Net Tangible Assets per share provides 
a measure of the Company’s value attributable to each and 
every share on issue.
How we measure
Industry standard calculation of net tangible assets as set 
out in the EPRA Best Practice Recommendations divided by 
the diluted number of shares on issue.
Associated KPIs
5
2024
2023
119.6p
120.7p
119.6p
Performance
K   EPRA NTA per share (p)
1
2
3
4
5
2024
2023
4.2p
4.0p
4.2p
Performance
I   EPRA earnings per share (p) 
Purpose
Illustrates our ability to pay dividends from recurring, 
current year, earnings.
How we measure
EPRA earnings per share expressed as a percentage  
of dividends paid and declared in respect to the  
financial year.
Associated KPIs
5
114%
114%
114%
Performance
J   Dividend Cover (%) 
2024
2023
Financial KPIs
Strategic Links 
1.	
Customers
2.	 Brand 
3.	 People and Operations
4.	 Buildings
5.	 Shareholders
Definitions
For definitions see page 185.

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
31
“A gorgeous modern accommodation which 
makes me feel safe while in the busy city of Bristol. 
Although located on the bustling Clifton Triangle, 
the site remains quiet and tucked away from the 
night life. The team are always on hand to help  
with issues and are always smiley and friendly.”
Resident  |  St Mary’s, Bristol
“The attention to detail in the 
amenities, the cleanliness of 
the accommodation and the 
promptness in addressing any 
requests were truly beyond  
my expectations.”
Resident  |  Bath Street, Glasgow

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
32
The business has continued to demonstrate a degree of 
resilience in the face of increasingly challenging wider 
market conditions, achieving good rates of occupancy 
whilst delivering strong like for like rental growth, 
comfortably above the rate of inflation.
Demand continues to exceed supply in most of the key 
cities in which we operate. New supply of high quality, well 
located accommodation remains limited and continues to 
be outpaced by increasing demand, exacerbated by the 
continued decline in private landlords particularly HMO 
operators and Buy-to-Let investors while the cohort of 
UK 18 year olds continues to increase. The prospective 
changes within the Renters Rights Bill have the potential 
to amplify this issue, making letting to students 
considerably less attractive for non-PBSA operators.
Another strong re-booker performance was achieved for 
the current sitting 2024/25 academic year, with 23 per 
cent of our rooms sold to students who were already living 
with us, providing a tangible endorsement of our product 
and of the service we provide.
Portfolio overview 
A summary of the Group’s portfolio is set out below, 
segmented in line with our valuer’s view of quality.  
Almost 97 per cent of the portfolio is now invested in 
Prime or Super Prime locations. 
Since 31 December 2023, the portfolio has grown in value 
by 1.6 per cent, like for like. This includes the impact of the 
removal of Multiple Dwellings Relief in March, which had 
it remained in place, would have resulted in like for like 
growth of 4.2 per cent. With the portfolio’s net initial yield 
unchanged at 5.5 per cent, this is the result of income 
growth achieved for the 2024/25 academic year.  
The reversionary yield was also held at 5.7 per cent, 
providing confidence that as the letting cycle advances 
for the new 2025/26 academic year, a further valuation rise 
could be expected if investment yields remain as stable as 
we have seen over the past 18 months.
Operating review
Valuer’s quality segmentation
Properties
Operational 
beds
Market value 
£m
Market value 
%
Super prime regional
23
2,443
538.7
47.5
Prime regional
45
4,579
558.1
49.2
Super Prime and Prime Regional 
68
7,022
1,096.8
96.7
Secondary 
7
663
38.2
3.3
Total
75
7,685
1,135.0
100.0
Strategic segmentation
Total  
market value  
£m
NIY  
%
Operational portfolio
1,114.0
5.5
Commercial portfolio
16.5
8.0
Development portfolio
4.5
Total
1,135.0
Deployment of proceeds following equity raise
In October 2024, the Company raised £54.3 million, net of 
costs, in order to pursue an independent growth strategy 
of acquisition and refurbishment, negating the need for a 
prospective joint venture as had been initially considered.
Proceeds were earmarked for deployment into two well 
aligned acquisition opportunities in top-tier university 
cities and to accelerate the roll out of the Group’s 
Postgraduate exclusive product. 
In December 2024, the first of two acquisitions, Tatton 
House in Manchester, was acquired for £19.75 million.  
This 136 bed, all-studio scheme is well located, being 
less than ten minutes’ walk to the Manchester University 
campus and directly opposite our existing Victoria 
Point Hub. This location allows us to instantly unlock 
operational efficiencies and during the letting cycle 
for academic year 2025/26, by offering the full amenity 
provision of our wider cluster to prospective residents of 
Tatton House, which currently has no on-site amenity.  
This operational PBSA asset is expected to deliver a seven 
per cent net initial yield from September 2025. 
A second acquisition is under offer and currently 
expected to conclude in early April 2025, in line with  
our deployment assumptions.
Preparatory works have begun at three existing sites 
earmarked for conversion to the Group’s Postgraduate 
product, with over £10 million on track for investment 
during 2025. Furthermore, our academic year 2025/26 
sales programme has been amended with planning and 
design underway to facilitate the refurbishment of a 
further four Postgraduate exclusive sites during 2026.  
We continue to expect these Postgraduate 
refurbishments to deliver unlevered IRRs in excess of  
12 per cent.

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
33
Portfolio management
With overall investment market activity up 13 per cent 
on 2023, there has been greater opportunity to progress 
the tail of our non-core disposals, with eight relatively 
small properties sold during the year for £45.2 million 
representing 433 beds. Importantly, the sales represented 
four further non-core city exits, improving the portfolio’s 
alignment to both prime and super prime locations and 
top-tier universities, complimenting the improvement in 
the portfolio’s overall gross margin to 70 per cent.
Three acquisitions were completed during the year.  
All three were well aligned, located in top-tier cities which 
cluster well with our existing sites. All three acquisitions 
present further opportunities to add value through future 
development or refurbishment.
In February 2024, we acquired College House in Bristol. 
Adjacent to our College Green site, this former office 
building was acquired for £5.6 million. The property is 
arranged over five floors with a small retail parade at 
street level, occupied by tenants who are complementary 
to our customer base having re-let or regeared all three 
units. The property will be transformed into a new 57-bed 
student accommodation scheme, which will cater to post-
grad students. This all studio scheme will incorporate 
a library and co-working space in the basement while 
offering access to other amenities including gyms and 
private dining rooms within our Bristol cluster. The 
property is expected to open to students in early 2026. 
Once complete, we anticipate this development will 
comfortably exceed our target five year IRR of 12 per cent.
A second acquisition, Claremont House in Glasgow was 
acquired in July for £9.7 million. Located in the heart of 
Glasgow’s supply constrained West End, and in close 
proximity to the university and our existing hub site of 
Willowbank. The property which clusters extremely well 
with our other sites in the city, was acquired fully let for 
the current sitting academic year and has delivered a  
net initial yield of over 7.5 per cent since September.  
The property benefits from an ability to unlock further 
rental growth from future refurbishment.
In December 2024 we acquired Tatton House in 
Manchester for £19.75 million, in line with the deployment 
plan outlined in the Company’s October 2024 equity 
raise, outlined above. This operational asset delivers many 
of the same value enhancing opportunities that can be 
delivered at Claremont House and is expected to deliver  
a 7.0 per cent net initial yield from September 2025.
A planning application was submitted in May 2024 to 
facilitate an extension and full refurbishment of our 
existing operational site at Victoria Point in Manchester. 
In December, Manchester City Council granted detailed 
planning permission, which once implemented will add 
310 new beds while allowing a masterplan refurbishment 
of all existing rooms including reconfiguration to 
create more studio units. The city continues to suffer an 
acute under supply of PBSA beds and has consistently 
performed well for us from an occupancy and rental 
growth perspective given the site’s location and open 
green space. An implementation and funding plan will 
now be established with a view to starting work on site  
in late 2026.
Refurbishment & development
Our annual refurbishment programme continues to target 
the delivery of 200 to 300 beds annually, with an IRR 
return hurdle of between 9-11 per cent. 
The 2024 refurbishment programme was focused on  
one of our larger properties, Brunswick Apartments  
in Southampton.
This 173 bed scheme was closed for the duration of the 
2023/24 academic year to facilitate fire safety works 
which allowed for a full building refurbishment and 
reconfiguration. The works involved refurbishment of 
all rooms and the creation of a new amenity provision. 
Although total bed count was unchanged, a greater  
studio focus was achieved, including adding some 
new large one bed apartments alongside full building 
decarbonisation work.
The Company’s decision to close the property was made 
following consideration of the impact on our customers 
and site teams of a more staggered multi-year works 
programme. It was concluded that closure would allow all 
works to be carried out concurrently, thereby accelerating 
the programme of fire safety and decarbonisation work 
alongside the refurbishment programme, ultimately 
delivering the property’s potential considerably earlier 
and improving longer term customer satisfaction. 
Upon reopening in September 2024, the scheme 
delivered an increase in average weekly rents of over 50 
per cent when compared to its pre-refurbishment year of 
operation. Notwithstanding an element of market rental 
growth which is now captured, this performance has 
surpassed expectations delivering a yield on cost above 
6.5 per cent and an IRR in excess of 12 per cent, inclusive 
of the impact of the removal of Multiple Dwelling Relief 
during 2024.
The 2025 refurbishment plan is expected to deliver 
approximately 200 refurbishment rooms for the start 
of the 2025/26 academic year. Three of the four sites 
undergoing refurbishment will reopen as postgraduate 
exclusive accommodation from September 2025.

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
34
Operating review | continued
Commercial portfolio
The commercial estate continues to grow in quality, 
now comprising 34 units across a diverse mix of uses, 
including retailers, restaurants, bars, and telecoms 
infrastructure. A series of new agreements have 
strengthened the portfolio, including a 25-year lease 
in central Nottingham to a large UK-based hospitality 
group which opened its premium Manhattan bar concept. 
Additionally, a reversionary lease agreement was made 
with a national Japanese inspired restaurant operator 
in Selly Oak, Birmingham. Terms included a new 10-year 
lease and significant rental uplift, securing a popular 
offering and breakout space for our customers.
We have also progressed strategic asset management 
initiatives to unlock further value. One example is the 
replacement of a non-strategic tenant in Nottingham 
with a national restaurant operator, which has agreed 
to take the space on a 15-year term-certain lease while 
maintaining similar rent terms of the former tenant. 
Another initiative involves a national supermarket chain, 
where we are set to re-gear several of their convenience 
store leases to increase length of tenure, enhancing long-
term income stability whilst being complementary to our 
student customers and the wider community.
Looking ahead, the focus within the commercial estate 
will be on re-gearing leases with strong tenants, filling all 
vacant units, and exploring opportunities to repurpose 
underutilised spaces to generate additional revenue.
Capital expenditure programme
Progress against our five year programme of 
refurbishment, fire safety works and green initiatives is  
set out below. 
In respect to our programme of fire safety works, all 
properties have been surveyed with 73 per cent of the 
portfolio now EWS1 certified. In arriving at the portfolio’s 
market value, the valuer applies a pound for pound 
deduction for the forecasted cost of the remaining works 
as well as, if applicable, a revenue disruption cost.  
Like many other real estate investors, we have submitted 
compensation claims against companies involved in 
the assets’ construction. Given the size and repurposed 
nature of a large number of our properties, the likelihood 
of success is less certain, but a modest contribution has 
been assumed against the costs of remediation.
Undergraduate
refurbishment
(£m)
Fire safety 
works  
£m
Green 
initiatives  
£m
Five year plan 
(2021 – 2025)
36.0
46.0
12.0
Invested to date
32.5
30.5
4.1
Forecast 2025 
investment
3.5
10.1
4.2
In addition to the above, ongoing capital life cycling works 
continue to require around £4.0 million per annum. 
2025 is the final year of the original capital expenditure 
works programme. Although the quantum of future capital 
expenditure is anticipated to be significantly lower than 
that set out in this original programme, there will be a 
need to revisit the forecasted spend for 2026 and beyond. 
Certain newly acquired properties have been purchased 
with the benefit of refurbishment potential which, given 
the attractive rental growth anticipated, refurbishment 
remains firmly within the Group’s strategic plan of  
capital works.

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
35
“Perfect location, extremely  
well trained and responsive staff, 
clean and good facilities, and the 
studios are big, with big beds  
and a good layout.”
Resident  |  Metrovick House, Newcastle
“I’ve been living here for almost  
3 years now, and I must say, it’s been 
a fantastic experience. The location 
is absolutely spot on, it is convenient 
for everything I need. The facilities 
are perfect, and the price is really 
reasonable for what you get, it’s 
definitely great value for money. 
The reception staff are always 
friendly and welcoming, and more 
than happy to help with any issues. 
Honestly, it’s been such a pleasant 
place to live.”
Resident  |  St. Peters Studios, Aberdeen

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
36
Unlocking 
value through 
refurbishments 
Following a strategic review of 
the Company’s portfolio in early 
2021, a number of properties were 
identified as fundamentally meeting 
our key criteria of building type 
and location, but were in need of 
extensive refurbishment in order  
to fully align to the Hello Student 
core offering. In March of 2021,  
16 per cent of the portfolio fell into 
this category and was subject to a 
viability review to ensure accretive 
returns were achieved.
The Company’s decision to close the property for 
the entirety of an academic year was made following 
consideration of the impact on our customers and site 
teams of a more staggered multi-year works programme. 
It was concluded that closure would allow all works to 
be carried out concurrently, thereby accelerating the 
programme of fire safety and decarbonisation work 
alongside the refurbishment programme, ultimately 
delivering the properties potential considerably earlier 
and improving longer term customer satisfaction.
In the four years that have followed, over 800 rooms have 
been extensively refurbished at a cost of £32.5 million, 
which have provided returns in line with our refurbishment 
target of 9-11 per cent, on an unlevered IRR basis.
Brunswick Apartments, Southampton 
One significant refurbishment which completed in 2024 
was Brunswick Apartments in Southampton.
This 173 bed scheme was closed for the duration of the 
2023/24 academic year to facilitate fire safety works which 
allowed for a full building reconfiguration. The works 
involved full room refurbishment whilst creating a greater 
studio focus, including adding some new large one bed 
apartments alongside full building decarbonisation.
>800
rooms have been extensively 
refurbished at a cost of £32.5 million
Strategy in action 

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
37
“Staff are nice and the building is 
so beautiful and clean and tidy.”
  Resident  |  Brunswick Apartments, Southampton
The property’s closure was well trailed and communicated 
in a thoughtful manner. No interruption was experienced 
by our customers, with a reprovision plan in place for 
those that wished to remain with us during the year of 
closure. Our employees were also redeployed to ensure 
they could be retained during the period of closure. 
This extensive refurbishment programme progressed 
both to plan and budget. The site reopened to students in 
September 2024, having sold extremely well.
The property delivered an increase in average weekly 
rents of over 50 per cent when compared to its pre 
refurbishment year of operation. Notwithstanding an 
element of market rental growth which is now captured, 
this performance has surpassed expectations delivering a 
yield on cost above 6.5 per cent and an IRR in excess of  
12 per cent, inclusive of the impact of the removal of 
Multiple Dwelling Relief during 2024.
This now fully amenitised building is well positioned 
to further exploit the benefits of our clustering model. 
The nearby property of London Road, which will open 
as a postgraduate exclusive scheme in Autumn 2025 is 
amenity light by design with access to the Brunswick 
House Hub driving a notably improved rental tone.
Given the success of the refurbishment programme to 
date, our investment strategy favours the acquisition of 
well-located properties that present an opportunity for us 
to unlock further value through refurbishment.
+50%
increase in average weekly rents compared  
to pre refurbishment year of operation

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
38
	
 
Low
Medium
High
High
Medium
Low
Impact
Probability
E5
I4
I1
E4
E2
Adapting risk management in a changing environment
External Risks
E1	 Revenue Risk
E2 	Property Market Risk
E3	 Climate Change Risk
E4 	Financing Risk
E5 	Inflation Risk
Internal Risks
I1	
Health & Safety Risk
I2	 Information Technology Risk
I3	 People Risk
I4	 Safe and Sustainable  
	
Buildings Risk
Principal risks and viability
The Group seeks to 
minimise, control and 
monitor the impact of risks 
on profitability, reputation 
and strategic priorities, 
whilst maximising the 
opportunities they present 
in the context of longer- 
term viability.
The Board regularly assesses the risk 
appetite of the Group, with the Audit and 
Risk Committee formally reviewing the 
effectiveness of our risk management 
process and internal control systems. 
We recognise that a number of risks 
are faced which could impact on the 
achievement of our strategy. While it 
is not possible to identify or anticipate 
every risk, we have established a robust 
risk management process to identify, 
manage and mitigate risk. The Group’s 
process for identifying and managing 
risk is set by the Board. The Board has 
delegated the oversight of risk to the 
Audit and Risk Committee.
Risks are identified by applying a dual 
approach, ‘bottom up’ at the operational 
level having established responsible risk 
owners throughout the business and 
layered with a ‘top down’ or corporate 
overlay as determined by the Board. 
Identified risks are assessed by rating 
each risk gross and net of mitigating 
controls. The Board considers emerging 
risks and uncertainties which may 
prevent the Group achieving its strategic 
objectives and tracks the evolution of 
existing and emerging risks throughout 
the year.
The Audit and Risk Committee reviews 
the plan biannually with the design, 
implementation and monitoring being 
the responsibility of management on a 
day-to-day basis. Risks, both principal 
and emerging, are considered in terms 
of their impact and likelihood across a 
property cycle from both a financial and 
reputational perspective.
Although not exhaustive, risks facing 
the Group are categorised into three 
categories being; external risks; internal 
risks and emerging risks.
The Audit and Risk Committee considers 
emerging risks. These are new or 
unforeseen risks, of which the Committee 
is aware, however their potential impact 
is not fully known. The Committee 
reviews these biannually alongside the 
principal risks and uncertainties. The 
Audit and Risk Committee has detailed 
below the risks it believes are emerging 
and the potential impact it may have on 
our principal risks:
Changes to our risks profile
The Group's risk profile has remained 
relatively stable during the year. 
Continued rental growth, coupled with 
strong occupancy mitigates against 
the likelihood of a material downturn 
in property valuations, however 
government policy and disruption 
caused by alternative accommodation 
providers has increased revenue risk. 
Refinancing related activity completed 
during the year continues to reduce 
financing related risk.
E3
I3
E1
I2

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
39
External risks
Strategic Links
1.	 Customers 
2.	Brand 
3.	People and Operations 
4.	Buildings 
5.	Shareholder Outcomes
Strategic Links
	
	
Increasing
	
	
No change
	
	
Decreasing
Risk and brief description
Potential impact
Mitigation in place
Trend
E1
E1
Revenue risk
Owner: Chief Customer Officer
There is a risk that the student 
demand for our product will 
decrease, e.g. inconsistent brand 
proposition, governmental 
intervention, competition from 
alternative accommodation 
providers or affordability concerns.
—
Link to Strategy
3 5
	î Loss of revenue
	î Erosion of asset values
	î Void costs or increasing 
level of bad debts
	î Potential breach of 
bank covenants
	î Customers not 
meeting contractual 
commitments
	î Executive Committee and the Board closely monitor government policy, 
student numbers and other micro and macro-economic factors. 
	î Monitoring restrictions and ensuring marketing is targeted to key 
international and domestic markets. 
	î We ensure our assets are well located serving established leading 
universities with a higher proportion of Post Grad occupiers.
	î Standard operating procedures and expanded mechanical and 
electrical programme. 
	î Substantial domestic student demand and management of demographics.
Heightened 
due to various 
challenges faced 
by government 
policy, and 
interruption 
caused by 
alternative 
accommodation 
providers.
E2
E2
Property market risk
Owner: Chief Investment Officer
Increasing yields across the 
property sector impacting 
valuations.
—
Link to Strategy
4 5
	î Erosion of asset values
	î Potential breach in 
bank covenants
	î Lower Total Return for 
shareholders
	î Our assets are in prime locations, diversifying risk. CBRE classifies over 90% 
of the portfolio as prime or better. 
	î We maintain prudent levels of gearing, with an LTV limit of 40% and a long-term 
target of 35%. 
	î The higher education sector comprises both domestic and international 
students, which helps to underpin the student accommodation market. 
	î Of the UK property sub-sectors, direct-let PBSA is currently expected to be 
one of the most resilient sectors. 
Stable due to 
expectation that 
interest rates have 
peaked.
E3
E3
Climate change risk
Owner: Chief Financial  
& Sustainability Officer
Climate change has the potential 
to impact every business in the 
world. For our business, it could 
impact planning legislation 
restricting supply of PBSA, create 
physical risks such as flooding and 
increase government legislation and 
regulation, for example.
—
Link to Strategy
1 2 3 4 5
	î Financial and reputational 
risk associated with 
inappropriate action
	î Cost of transition
	î 	Net zero commitment and plans established.
	î Behavioural training to be carried out with tenants during 2025.
	î Specialist advisers appointed internally and externally to ensure plans are 
implemented in line with Net Zero pathway.
 
Stable, with 
continued 
significant focus 
by the business 
with no significant 
change from prior 
year.

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
40
Principal risks and viability | continued
Risk and brief description
Potential impact
Mitigation in place
Trend
Ex
E4
Financing risk
Owner: Chief Financial  
& Sustainability Officer
The availability of debt or equity 
on acceptable terms, particularly if 
capital deployment commitments 
are not met.
—
Link to Strategy
1 2 3 4 5
	î Limiting future growth 
potential 
	î Price-taker in fire sale 
scenario 
	î Reduced shareholder 
returns 
	î Average maturity of debt of 4.7 years with £75.4 million in cash and undrawn 
committed facilities as at 31 December 2024.
	î We maintain prudent levels of gearing, with an LTV limit of 40% and a long-term 
target of 35%.
	î Strong relationships with key lending institutions.
	î Specifically identified deployment opportunities.
	î Credit approval received on £35 million revolving credit facility.
 
Reduced following 
extended 
debt maturity, 
successful 
capital raise and 
continued lender 
appetite for the 
PBSA sector.
Ex
E5
Inflation risk
Owner: Chief Financial & 
Sustainability Officer 
Inflationary pressure on staffing, 
operational costs, utilities and 
costs associated with development, 
refurbishment works, fire safety or 
other regulatory requirements.
—
Link to Strategy
1 2 3 4 5
	î Reduced profitability and 
dividend capacity 
	î Inability to deliver 
desired return on 
investments
	î Consumption related utility costs hedged beyond 2025.
	î Reassessment of capital expenditure and acquisition plans.
	î Resilient revenue stream.
	î Inflationary pressures have eased.
 
Stable.  
Inflationary 
pressures have 
eased but offset 
by concerns in 
respect to the 
longer-term 
impact of the 2024 
Autumn Budget.
Risk and brief description
Potential impact
Mitigation in place
Trend
Ex
I1
Health & safety risk
Owner: Chief Executive Officer
The occurrence of a major health 
and safety incident including 
terrorism, fire or infectious 
outbreak.
—
Link to Strategy
1 2 3 4 5
	î Injury and impact on 
customers, contractors, 
staff and visitors 
	î Compensation costs 
incurred 
	î Reputational impact 
	î Loss of life in a worst-
case scenario
	î Health and safety metrics are reported to executive committee monthly. 
	î Policies, procedures and training for all staff. 
	î Ultimate Board responsibility involving regular Board reporting from the 
Executive with Head of Health and Safety. 
	î Live compliance dashboard which is monitored daily. 
	î Regular review of fire safety regulations to ensure our buildings remain 
compliant with standards, going above and beyond requirements. 
 
Stable due to 
minimal change 
in the health 
and safety 
environment. 
External risks | continued
Internal risks

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
41
Internal risks | continued
Strategic Links
1.	 Customers 
2.	Brand 
3.	People and Operations 
4.	Buildings 
5.	Shareholder Outcomes
Strategic Links
	
	
Increasing
	
	
No change
	
	
Decreasing
Risk and brief description
Potential impact
Mitigation in place
Trend
I2
I2
Information technology risk
Owner: Chief Financial & 
Sustainability Officer 
The Group suffering from a 
cyber security breach, loss or 
mismanagement of personal 
customer data, wider IT or 
infrastructure failure.
—
Link to Strategy
1 2 3
	î Reputational damage
	î Deteriorated customer 
experience
	î Higher costs and reduced 
profitability
	î Financial impact due to 
potentially significant 
fines under GDPR 
legislation
	î A business continuity plan is in place to enable Group operations to continue in 
the event of a failure or breach.
	î The IT network is centralised across the Group with an in-house IT team.
	î Security training programme for all staff.
	î Data monitoring system to protect our platforms across the IT estate and strong 
Data Protection Office in place.
	î Regular penetration testing.
 
Stable.  
No significant 
change in risk 
profile during 
the year.
I3
I3
People risk
Owner: Chief Operating Officer
Loss of front-line staff and the 
knock-on impact on customer 
service.
Inability to retain key employees or 
attract specialists.
—
Link to Strategy
1 2 3 5
	î Impact on customer 
service due to low rates 
of retention
	î Loss of key business 
knowledge
	î Inability to complete 
refurbishment 
programme
	î We are a Real Living Wage Employer ensuring that we attract and retain talent 
where possible.
	î Employee engagement at 78%.
	î Ongoing training and development programme designed to upskill staff 
regularly and progress forward with their career within the business.
	î Succession planning and early supply chain engagement.
	î Exit interviews are used to identify any areas for improvement within the 
business.
  
Reduced  
following 
improvement in 
retention rates 
and development 
of key employee 
succession plans.
I4
Safe and sustainable 
buildings risk
Owner: Chief Executive Officer
How our buildings will withstand 
increased legislation around fire 
safety as well as increasing minimum 
energy performance standards. 
—
Link to Strategy
1 2 3 4 5
	î High compliance costs
	î Reputational impact
	î Potential challenges 
around insuring our 
buildings
	î Compensation claims
	î Decreased liquidity of 
our buildings
	î Significant capital expenditure plan allocated to ensure our buildings comply 
with future fire safety legislation.
	î Regular review of fire safety regulations and checks to ensure our buildings, at a 
minimum, remain compliant with standards.
	î Continuous assessment of our buildings and allocating significant resource 
toward future green initiatives.
	î Mandatory health and safety training.
Stable.  
Our focus on 
fire safety and 
potential upcoming 
legislation 
remains high.

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
42
Principal risks and viability | continued
Emerging risks
Risk and brief description
Impact on principal risk 
probabilities
Mitigating factors
Geopolitical crisis 
A geopolitical dispute between China, or 
any other sovereign state who generates a 
significant amount of student revenue, and 
the UK could result in foreign governments 
placing embargoes on their students 
coming to study in the UK.
	î Revenue Risk 
	î Property Market Risk 
	î Financing Risk 
	î Broad marketing campaigns targeted to both the domestic and international market with a particular 
focus on underweight international locations.
Restrictions in international 
students 
Immigration restrictions imposed by the 
UK Government could substantially reduce 
revenue from international students.
	î Revenue Risk
	î Substantial domestic demand. 
	î 	Marketing focus on expanding domestic reach and diversifying away from reliance on  
international markets.

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
43
Viability statement
Assessment period
The Directors have considered a three year time horizon 
in assessing longer term viability. A three year period to 
31 December 2027 has been selected for the following 
principal reasons:
	î the Board reviews budgets and plans that extend to 
three years; and
	î the Group’s revenue is annual in nature, with typical 
lease terms of 51 weeks. At any given balance sheet date 
there is revenue visibility of approximately 20 months, 
with an extension to 36 months not unreasonable given 
a number of the Group’s customers choose to stay 
during their higher education journey, which is usually 
three years.
In concluding on the appropriateness of a three 
year viability term, the Directors were mindful of any 
significant events that may reasonably be expected to fall 
immediately after 31 December 2027, the Group’s current 
position and business plan projections, financial forecasts 
and the potential impact of the principal risks set out on 
page 38.
The Group has no debt facilities falling due during the 
viability period. The first maturity of £120.0 million falls in 
April 2028. With over three years remaining to refinance 
or extend this facility, continued lender appetite for the 
sector, modest gearing, currently at 27.2 per cent and 
low quantum of capital commitments, the Group remains 
confident that this future risk can be planned for and well 
managed within the timeframe remaining.
Assumptions
The Group’s three year business plan incorporates the 
following key assumptions:
	î occupancy remains stable, given the current demand 
for student accommodation in top-tier cities, to which 
the Group is increasingly aligned;
	î revenue growth of at least four per cent annually;
	î utilities costs at hedged rates, with projected market 
rates applied to residual exposure thereafter;
	î cost inflation assumed at three per cent throughout  
the forecast period;
	î valuations remain stable;
	î only acquisitions linked to the Company’s equity raise 
go ahead, with no further acquisitions or disposals 
completed; 
	î a Revolving Credit Facility of £35 million is secured 
against a pool of unencumbered assets on terms set out 
in a credit approved term sheet; and
	î exercising substitution rights under a facility agreement 
to release £18 million of restricted cash from disposals. 
The Group’s three year business plan was stress 
tested using both specific and cumulative “downside” 
assumptions to model a general deterioration in  
market conditions and operational performance.  
All of the Group’s risks could have an impact on viability. 
Climate change is considered by the Directors to  
be a risk requiring investment to enhance environmental 
performance and to meet the commitment to achieve 
Net Zero Carbon by 2033, however the costs anticipated 
within the viability period are not expected to be 
significant. 
The Board placed particular emphasis on those risks 
which could result in reduced income and valuations or 
a shortfall in liquidity. Sensitivity analysis was carried out 
which involved flexing a number of downside assumptions 
to consider alternative macroeconomic conditions and 
the impact of these principal risks both individually 
and in combination. This included flexing key base case 
assumptions as set out above.
Key assumptions underlying the downside scenario were 
as follows:
	î occupancy falls to 90 per cent for the 2025/26, 2026/27 
and 2027/28 academic years;
	î revenue growth reduced to as low as two per cent in 
academic year 2027/28;
	î significant increase in the level of bad and doubtful 
debts;
	î exposure to utility cost volatility increased to 1.5 times 
projected market rates;
	î inflation increased to five per cent, significantly above 
the Bank of England target rate of two per cent;
	î floating interest rates rise a further one per cent; 
	î property valuations suffer a shock decline of ten  
per cent;
	î certain of the Group’s non-committed and non-
regulatory capex programmes are curtailed or paused 
during the forecast period.
Downside analysis was carried out to evaluate the 
potential impact on the Group’s financing covenants. 
Under the downside scenario, the Group is expected to 
remain in compliance with the loan-to-value and interest 
cover covenants of its individual financing arrangements. 
In addition to considering a downside scenario, reverse 
stress testing has also been undertaken, indicating the 
point at which debt covenants would be breached. No 
facility interest cover ratios are expected to breach unless 
occupancy rates fall below 77% for two consecutive 
academic years, with all facilities breaching if occupancy 
rates were to fall below 60 per cent. The first loan to value 
breach would not be expected unless lender valuations 
fell by more than 17 per cent, with all loan to value 
covenants breaching if valuations were to fall by more 
than 46 per cent.
Mitigants
The Directors considered what mitigants to the downside 
scenarios were available. These include, but are not 
limited to, pausing uncommitted capital expenditure, 
utilising cash generated in a fire sale scenario from those 
assets remaining unsecured or subject to debenture and a 
temporary suspension of the dividend.
Conclusion
As a result of the work performed and the mitigants 
available, in the unlikely event that the stress tests 
performed prove to be insufficient, the Directors are of 
the view that the Group’s strategy will provide a sound 
platform upon which to continue to be viable. 
The Directors therefore conclude that there is a 
reasonable expectation that the Group can continue 
in operation and is capable of meeting its debts and 
obligations as they fall due during a period of not less  
than three years from the balance sheet date.

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
44
Financial review 
Another  
strong 
operational 
result 
In October 2024, the Group successfully 
completed its first equity raise since 2017, 
raising £56.1 million, (£54.3 million net  
of costs). 
“A £124.9 million seven year 
refinancing was completed during 
the first half of 2024, consolidating 
four smaller facilities which were 
scheduled to mature in 2024 and 2025 
and removing refinancing risk for the 
near term.”
Donald Grant  |  Chief Financial & Sustainability Officer

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
45
Financial review
In October 2024, the Group successfully completed its 
first equity raise since 2017, raising £56.1 million, (£54.3 
million net of costs) following the placement of 60.4 
million new ordinary shares representing ten per cent of 
the Company’s issued share capital prior to the placing 
announcement. Proceeds are earmarked to accelerate 
growth through deployment into two new acquisition 
opportunities and to fund refurbishment works required 
to roll out the Group’s Postgraduate product across 
16 identified assets. The latter had previously been the 
subject of a potential joint venture, the plans for which 
were terminated given market conditions at the time 
provided the Company with the opportunity to take an 
independent path. Abortive costs were £0.5 million.
A £124.9 million seven year refinancing was completed 
during the first half of 2024, consolidating four smaller 
facilities which were scheduled to mature in 2024 and 
2025 and removing refinancing risk for the near term.  
The weighted average cost of debt now stands at 4.5 
per cent, an increase of 20 bps from 31 December 2023 
and in line with guidance provided. Following the equity 
placement, EPRA LTV has fallen to 27.2 per cent.
Blending like for like rental growth across the 2023/24 
and 2024/25 academic years of 10.5 per cent and 7.0 per 
cent respectively, the financial year of 2024 has delivered 
growth of 9.3 per cent. Occupancy remained strong 
throughout with 99 per cent for 2023/24 and 97 per cent 
for 2024/25. 
Growth in revenue coupled with the exit of four further 
non-core cities has increased the Group’s overall gross 
margin to 70 per cent from 69 per cent in the prior year, 
despite ongoing cost challenges, in particular with 
respect to utility costs. Following the 2024 expiry of  
an historic fixed cost arrangement, we have once  
again largely fixed utility costs for 2025 to mitigate  
future volatility.
Administrative expenses were £15.4 million, including 
a £0.5 million charge relating to abortive joint venture 
arrangement costs. Once removed, underlying costs of 
£14.9 million were in line with expectation, increasing  
6.4 per cent on the prior year.
Income statement
2024  
£m
2023  
£m
Revenue
84.2
80.5
Property expenses
(25.6)
(25.2)
Gross profit
58.6
55.3
Gross margin
70%
69%
Administrative expenses
(15.4)
(14.0)
Operating profit
43.2
41.3
Revaluation
15.4
30.1
Losses on disposals
(4.2)
(0.6)
Derivative mark to market loss
(1.3)
(0.2)
Net finance costs
(18.7)
(17.2)
IFRS Profit
34.4
53.4
EBITDA
43.9
42.1
Weighted average ordinary shares (m)
616.2
603.4
IFRS EPS (pence)
5.6
8.8
EPRA EPS (pence)
4.2
4.0
Net debt to EBITDA (times)
6.8
7.6
Balance sheet
2024  
£m
2023 
£m
Property (market value)
1,135.0
1,097.9
Bank borrowings drawn
(374.3)
(360.3)
Cash on hand
75.4
40.5
Net debt
(298.9)
(319.8)
Other net liabilities
(34.8)
(43.9)
Net assets
801.3
734.2
Diluted number of shares
669.6
608.0
EPRA NTA per share (pence)
119.6
120.7
EPRA LTV
27.2%
30.6%

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
46
Financial review | continued
Notwithstanding the abolition of Multiple Dwellings Relief, the portfolio valuation 
increased by £15.4 million, 1.6 per cent on a like for like basis. This is primarily income 
led, with no overall change in the portfolio’s yield of 5.5 per cent. The valuer has taken a 
more cautious approach to future income growth this year, providing the potential to 
outperform the current reversionary potential of 5.7 per cent.
Eight non-core assets were disposed of during 2024, generating £45.2 million at an 
overall loss of £4.2 million. Funds are earmarked for redeployment into the Group’s core 
capital expenditure programme. Since launching the Company’s programme of non-core 
asset disposals, £146.4 million has been generated at an overall discount of 0.2 per cent 
to book values.
Net finance costs of £18.6 million include a charge of £0.9 million related to accelerated 
debt issue cost amortisation following refinancing activity completed in the first half 
of the year. On an underlying basis, net finance costs of £17.7 million were 2.9 per cent 
higher than the prior year, reflecting the higher weighted average cost of debt. All drawn 
debt is currently either fixed or subject to interest rate protection.
EPRA earnings per share has increased by five per cent to 4.2 pence per share, 
comfortably covering dividends paid and proposed for 2024 of 3.7 pence per share.
EPRA net tangible assets per share has reduced by 0.9 per cent to 119.6 pence.  
The reduction in NTA per share is primarily due to the dilutive impact of the placement 
of 60.4 million new ordinary shares at a 93 pence per share. Although initially dilutive, 
it is anticipated that the deployment of placing proceeds will result in NTA per share 
accretion beyond 2025.
Evolution of net asset value
£m
31 December 2023
734.2
EPRA earnings
25.9
Revaluation
15.4
Capital raise (net of costs)
54.3
Dividends paid
(22.0)
Loss on disposals
(4.2)
Other
(2.3)
31 December 2024
801.3
Portfolio valuation
2024  
£m
2023  
£m
Gain1  
£m
Change  
%
Like for like property portfolio
1,063.9
1,031.7
16.2
1.6
Acquisitions
36.2
–
(2.2)
Disposals
–
49.5
(1.6)
Other non-like for like (development)
34.9
16.7
3.0
Portfolio valuation
1,135.0
1,097.9
15.4
1	
Net of capital expenditure and headlease amortisation
On a like for like basis the portfolio increased in value by 1.6 per cent during the year.  
This includes the impact of the abolition of Multiple Dwellings Relief which has materially 
increased purchaser cost assumptions inherent in the valuations of our English and Welsh 
properties. For comparability, the like for like valuation gain would have been 4.2 per cent 
had Multiple Dwellings Relief continued to be in place at 31 December 2024.
Cities with particularly strong demand such as Bristol, Edinburgh, Glasgow and 
Manchester performed well. The latter includes our site at Victoria Point on which 
planning permission has been granted to add 310 new beds to the scheme. The weakest 
performance was from those cities experiencing lower demand, such as Sheffield and 
Leeds which have tempered the overall like for like valuation increase.
Three acquisitions were concluded during the year in Bristol, Glasgow and Manchester. 
The latter being the first of two acquisitions funded from the proceeds of the October 
2024 equity raise. Acquisitions have favoured operational assets in top-tier university 
cities where the Group has an existing operational presence and can therefore benefit 
from the efficiencies realised through clustering.
Eight assets were disposed of during the year, achieving an exit from four non-core cities; 
Stoke, Reading, Oxford and London. The latter two being non-core by virtue of scale.
Our Brunswick Apartments scheme in Southampton underwent a significant 
refurbishment during 2024 and was closed to students for the duration of the 
2023/24 academic year. A net valuation uplift of £3.0 million has been recorded post 
refurbishment. Given the quantum invested and associated disruption to income, this 
property is classified in the table above as ‘other non-like for like’. 

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
47
Debt
In March 2024, we refinanced four small near term debt facilities into one consolidated 
seven year £124.9 million facility. Following refinancing, the Group’s weighted term to 
maturity has been extended to 4.7 years from 3.9 years at December 2023. The weighted 
average cost of debt is currently 4.5 per cent, with all drawn debt subject to interest rate 
protection. The next debt maturity is not now scheduled until April 2028.
Compliance with all covenants was maintained throughout the year. With a weighted 
average LTV covenant of 63 per cent and a weighted average ICR covenant of 1.9 times, 
good headroom continues to remain.
Cashflow
2024  
£m
2023  
£m
Operating cash flow
43.0
43.7
Property disposals
42.6
42.6
Property acquisitions and capital expenditure
(74.9)
(34.0)
Finance income
0.8
0.2
Net cash flows from investing activities
(31.5)
8.8
Capital raise (net of costs)
54.3
–
Dividends paid
(22.5)
(20.2)
Net borrowings drawn/(repaid)
14.1
(31.0)
Finance costs
(22.5)
(16.6)
Financing cash flows
23.4
(67.8)
Net cash flow
34.9
(15.3)
The disposal of eight small non-core assets during 2024 generated proceeds net of 
disposal costs of £44.0 million. Proceeds have largely been reinvested in the Group’s core 
capital expenditure programme of undergraduate refurbishments and ongoing fire safety 
works. Capital expenditure, together with the acquisition of three new properties during 
2024 has resulted in the deployment of £73.1 million.
The Group’s October 2024 equity raise generated £54.3 million, net of costs.  
These proceeds were earmarked for acquisitions and to fund refurbishment related 
capital expenditure, facilitating the transformation of 16 properties to the Group’s 
postgraduate specification, with associated cash deployment to fall during 2025. 
Proceeds earmarked for acquisition related activity were partly deployed toward the 
December 2024 acquisition of Tatton House in Manchester, which was acquired for 
£19.75 million, before costs.
Cash applied toward dividend payments in the year totalled £22.5 million, including  
£0.5 million of withholding tax due on the final dividend payment in 2023, settled in 
January 2024.
Cash applied to the settlement of finance costs has increased compared to 2023.  
The Group held higher overall drawn debt at a marginally higher cost, with the weighted 
cost of debt increasing from 4.3 per cent at 31 December 2023 to 4.5 per cent this year, 
increasing finance costs by approximately £2.5 million. Finance cost payments also 
include £3.9 million paid toward arrangement fees and hedging costs associated with  
the Group’s £124.9 million refinancing which was completed earlier in the year.
Going concern
The Board places particular focus on the appropriateness of adopting the going concern 
assumption when preparing the Company’s and the Group’s financial statements.
In light of the Group’s liquidity position, its modest level of capital commitments of £2.8 
million, weighted average unexpired debt term and overall level of gearing, the Directors 
have concluded that, in reasonably possible adverse scenarios, there remains adequate 
resources and mitigants available to continue to operate until at least 31 December 2026, 
being a period of not less than 12 months from the date of approval of these financial 
statements. The Directors therefore concluded that it remains appropriate to adopt the 
going concern basis of preparation when compiling the Annual Report and Accounts for 
the year ended 31 December 2024.
Attention is drawn to Note 1.4 to the financial statements for further details surrounding 
the conclusion reached.
Dividends
A final interim dividend of 1.075 pence per share has been declared for the final quarter  
of 2024, bringing total dividends paid and payable in respect of 2024 to 3.7 pence.  
This represents a six per cent increase on the total dividend paid in respect of 2023  
and an 88 per cent pay-out on EPRA EPS. 
With all recent dividends having been paid entirely as Property Income Distributions, 
there is sufficient headroom to pay this final dividend of the year as an ordinary company 
dividend. Payment will be made on 11 April 2025 to shareholders on the register at  
28 March 2025.
Donald Grant  |  Chief Financial & Sustainability Officer
12 March 2025

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
48
EPRA and other alternative performance measures
Our performance in line with industry standard measures
The following is a summary of the EPRA performance measures included in the Group’s results. As defined by the EPRA Best Practice Recommendations, these are a set of standard 
disclosures for the property industry designed to drive consistency in reporting.
EPRA measure
Definition of measure
Note/ 
reference
2024
2023
Earnings (£m)
The Company’s underlying earnings from operational activities
8
25.9
24.1
Net tangible assets (“NTA”)
The underlying value of the Company assuming it buys and sells assets
9
119.6
120.7
Net disposal value (“NDV”)
The value of the Company assuming assets are sold, and the liabilities are settled, not held to maturity
9
122.8
124.2
Net reinstatement value 
(“NRV”)
The value of the assets on a long-term basis, assets and liabilities are not expected to crystallise under 
normal circumstances
9
129.6
126.8
Net initial yield
Rental income less operating costs divided by the market value of the property, increased with purchasers 
costs
Opposite
4.9%
5.0%
Cost ratio (incl. direct vacancy 
costs)
Administrative & operating costs including costs of direct vacancy divided by gross rental income.
Opposite
49%
49%
Cost ratio (excl. direct vacancy 
costs)
Administrative & operating costs excluding costs of direct vacancy divided by gross rental income
Opposite
48%
48%
Like for like rental income (in 
respect of academic year)
Compares the growth in rental income that has been in operation and not under development, throughout 
both the current and comparative year
Financial 
review
7.0%
10.5%
Like for like capital
Compares the growth in capital values of the Group’s portfolio which was controlled by the Group at both 
balance sheet dates, net of capital expenditure and excluding development properties
Financial 
review
1.6%
3.0%
Loan to value
Ratio of net debt, including net payables, to the sum of the property-related assets, including net 
receivables, of the Group, expressed as a percentage
Page 50
27.2%
30.6%
Vacancy rate
Estimated Market Rental Value (“ERV”) of vacant space divided by ERV of the whole portfolio
Page 50
3.4%
0.7%
Other alternative performance measures
An alternative performance measure (“APM”) is a financial measure of historical or future financial performance, financial position or cash flows of an entity which is not a financial 
measure defined or specified in International Financial Reporting Standards (“IFRS”).
APMs are presented to provide useful information to readers and have been, or are still, consistent with industry standards. The table below sets out the additional non-EPRA derived 
APMs included within the Annual Report and Accounts.
Measure
Definition of measure
Note/ 
reference
2024
2023
Total Return
Growth in EPRA NTA plus dividends paid as a percentage of opening EPRA NTA
31
2.0%
7.6%
Net debt (£m)
Borrowings less cash and cash equivalents
Financial 
Review
298.9
319.8
Dividend cover
EPRA earnings relative to dividends declared for the year
31
114%
114%
Dividend pay-out ratio
Dividends declared relative to EPRA earnings
31
88%
88%

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
49
Group
EPRA Net Initial Yield (“NIY”) and topped-up NIY
Year ended  
31 December 2024  
£m
Year ended  
31 December 2023  
£m
Investment property
1,135.0
1,097.9
Less: development
(5.7)
(3.0)
Completed property portfolio
1,129.3
1,094.9
Allowance for purchaser’s cost
67.3
37.1
Grossed up completed property portfolio valuation
1,196.6
1,132.0
Annualised cash passing rental income
84.1
81.7
Property outgoings
(25.6)
(25.2)
Annualised net rents
58.5
56.5
Add: notional rent expiration of rent-free periods or other lease incentives
0.1
0.1
Topped-up net annualised rent
58.6
56.6
EPRA NIY
4.9%
5.0%
EPRA “topped-up’’ NIY
4.9%
5.0%
EPRA Cost ratios 
Operating expense line per IFRS income statement
25.6
25.2
Administration costs 
15.4
14.0
Ground rent costs
-
-
EPRA Costs (including direct vacancy costs)
41.0
39.2
Direct vacancy costs
(0.2)
(0.4)
EPRA Costs (excluding direct vacancy costs)
40.8
38.8
Gross Rental Income less ground rents – per IFRS
84.2
80.5
Less: service fee and service charge costs components of Gross Rental
-
-
Gross Rental Income 
84.2
80.5
EPRA Cost Ratio (including direct vacancy costs) 
49%
49%
EPRA Cost Ratio (excluding direct vacancy costs) 
48%
48%

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
50
EPRA and other alternative performance measures | continued
Group
EPRA Loan to Value (“LTV”)
Year ended  
31 December 2024  
£m
Year ended  
31 December 2023  
£m
Bank borrowings drawn
374.3
360.3
Net payables
11.4
16.8
Less cash held at the year end
(75.4)
(40.5)
Net borrowings
310.3
336.6
Investment property at fair value
1,118.6
1,072.5
Property held for sale
10.7
22.4
Property under development
5.7
3.0
Intangible assets
5.5
3.1
Property value
1,140.5
1,101.0
EPRA LTV 
27.2%
30.6%
EPRA capital expenditure analysis
Group
EPRA capital expenditure analysis
Year ended  
31 December 2024 
£m
Year ended  
31 December 2023  
£m
Acquisitions
37.2
–
Development
0.9
0.3
Investment properties
Incremental lettable space
–
–
No incremental lettable space
31.9
32.2
Total capex
70.0
32.5
Conversion from accrual to cash basis
2.1
(0.1)
Total capex on cash basis
72.1
32.4
EPRA vacancy rate
EPRA vacancy rate
2024
2023
Estimated rental value of vacant space (£m)
3.0
0.7
Estimated rental value of whole portfolio (£m)
87.9
86.2
EPRA vacancy rate (%)
3.4%
0.8%

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
51
“It’s been a really good experience, 
the staff are very friendly and you 
definitely get a good value for your 
money , highly recommend if looking 
for anywhere to stay for uni.”
Resident  |  London Road, Southampton

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
52
ESG report 
We believe that ESG should be fully 
embedded throughout the Company 
for us to succeed as a sustainable 
business. We have therefore 
developed a robust and transparent 
management framework and strategy 
that has a positive impact for all  
our stakeholders. 
We set ambitious and challenging goals that guide 
our strategy and operations for the future and in 
2022, we published our Net Zero Strategy which 
outlined our target of achieving Net Zero for 
Scopes 1 and 2 by 2033 and for Scope 3 by 2050. 
The publication of our annual ESG Report reflects 
our commitment to transparency, measuring our 
progress each year against both short and long-
term targets. 
Our commitment 
to Stakeholders 

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
53
2024
2023
4
4
2
Board
2
Employees
369
56% males; 44% female
Conflicts of interest policy
We recognise the importance of maintaining the 
highest ethical standards and avoiding situations where 
a Director’s personal interests may conflict with their 
duties to the Company. To this end, we have a Conflicts of 
Interest policy designed to identify, manage, and resolve 
potential conflicts. This policy is intended to ensure that 
all decisions made by the Board are made in the best 
interests of the Company and its stakeholders.
Materiality
Working alongside our third-party ESG consultants,  
we have collated all ESG data from around the business 
and completed a materiality assessment matrix, to 
determine the ESG topics that were material to us and to 
our stakeholders. The matrix is reviewed annually by our 
ESG Committee, and the latest version is included in the 
latest ESG Report, available on our website. 
As we operate within the Real Estate Industry, we utilised 
the Sustainability Accounting Standards Board (“SASB”) 
framework and guidance on materiality.  
The SASB Standards help companies identify, measure, 
and manage the sustainability-related risks and 
opportunities that most directly affect cash flows, access 
to finance and cost of capital. Providing this comparable 
and standardised framework also allows information to 
be clearly communicated to our stakeholders, specifically 
our investors. This framework highlighted that ‘Physical 
Impacts of Climate Change’, and ‘Water & Wastewater 
Management’ were deemed as key areas of importance to 
our business. 
We and our investor audience are aware of the changing 
landscape around materiality and as we develop and build 
out our ESG reporting each year, we will take guidance and 
direction from the International Sustainability Standards 
Board’s (“ISSB”) financial materiality guidance.
Governance and strategy
The ESG strategy is aligned to our overall business 
strategy and reinforced by the Company’s Board of 
Directors. To improve efficiency and focus on ESG 
matters, the Board has delegated specific responsibilities 
to a formal ESG Committee, which comprises all Board 
Directors. This Committee operates within defined terms 
of reference and presents recommendations to the Board. 
The executive Directors manage day-to-day operations, 
following Board-approved policies and authorities. 
However we believe that we need the collaboration of all 
our people to successfully deliver on our ESG strategy 
and have developed an ESG Management Framework that 
has embedded the management of climate change issues 
within all areas of our business. This is outlined further in 
the report of the ESG Committee on page 116.
Board diversity
Female representation on the Board during 2023 and 
2024 was 33%, being two out of six Board members in 
total. There are currently no Directors of ethnic origin  
on the Board and this is discussed further on page 114.  
As diversity remains an important topic for our business, 
and within the Real Estate sector, the Board is mindful of, 
and reviews annually, gender and ethnic diversity across 
the entire workforce, within the senior leadership team 
and at Board level.  
 
 Male   
 Female 

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
54
ESG report | continued
 
Over
300
days invested by our team members 
in charitable or community initiatives
Key 2024 ESG- 
related highlights
Governance
	î Placed short term targets to shareholder vote at 
the Company’s Annual General Meeting improving 
transparency and stakeholder engagement
	î Published our first comprehensive standalone  
ESG Report
	î Concluded on CDP as the Company’s appropriate 
benchmark for reporting ESG credentials 
Environmental 
	î Like for like energy consumption per bed reduced 
three per cent
	î 64 per cent of the portfolio now rated EPC B  
or better, comfortably ahead of target 
	î Improved Scope 3 emissions data collection  
with first time Scope 3 reporting alongside our  
first carbon balance sheet
	î Improved behaviours through two well received 
energy awareness campaigns across all sites in 
both summer and winter
Social
	î Launched apprenticeship scheme and leadership 
development programme for future leaders
	î Set diversity target for the Senior  
Management Team
	î Mental Health First Aid training provided across  
all sites
	î Awarded Best Student Wellbeing 2024 by GSLI
	î Over 300 days invested by our team members in 
charitable or community initiatives
2024 ESG commitments
Description
Key areas of progress in 2024
Governance
Climate Risk 
Management
	î Monitor and review climate-related risks 
and mitigation controls.
	î Conduct a climate scenario analysis on our 
supply chain and supply routes.
	î Climate-scenario modelling year-on-year 
comparisons.
	î Financial modelling to understand 
the impact of identified risks and 
opportunities.
	î In 2024 we continued to monitor and 
review our climate-related risks and 
mitigation controls through an updated 
climate scenario analysis and risk register. 
	î In 2024, we conducted a climate scenario 
analysis of our supply chain and supply 
routes, which helped us better understand 
its vulnerability to climate change.
Conflict 
Management
	î Launch bespoke conflict management 
training to employees with a focus on risk 
mitigation. Identify sources of conflict and 
address them proactively, reducing the risk 
of escalated disputes and legal issues.
	î Rollout lone worker devices.
	î Conflict management training launched 
& lone worker devices issued to all 
appropriate site-based employees.
External 
Benchmarking
	î Consider and conclude on an appropriate 
external benchmarking study for the 
Company to participate in from 2025 
onwards.
	î In 2024 we concluded on CDP as the 
Company’s appropriate benchmark for 
reporting our ESG credentials.

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
55
25%
of our portfolio has been  
decarbonised, representing  
21 assets
2024 ESG commitments
Description
Key areas of progress in 2024
Environmental
Net Zero 
Operations
	î Over 40% of the portfolio by floor area to 
be fossil fuel-free.
	î Lower like for like energy consumption to 
below 4,250 kWh per bed.
	î Complete the conversion of a further 12 
buildings to Net Zero operations.
	î Commission decarbonisation studies on 
all remaining properties.
	î We have decarbonised 25% of our portfolio 
by area, representing 21 assets.
	î Like for like energy consumption per bed 
was reduced by 2.9% to 4,351 kWh (2023: 
4,481 kWh), significantly driven by the 
rollout of smart heating systems in over 
3,000 rooms.
	î In 2024 two buildings (Summit House, 
Cardiff and Brunswick Apartments, 
Southampton) became sites powered by 
on-site renewable electricity generation, 
utilising both solar PVs and ASHPs. 
Conversions are planned for a further 
seven sites - these will be powered by 
either PV panels or a combination of PV 
and ASHP technology.
	î So far we have installed energy-creating 
plant at 28 sites. 13 sites have had solar PV 
systems installed, a further seven now have 
ASHPs in place and ten have combined 
heat and power (“CHP”) systems.
	î Decarbonisation surveys are confirmed  
for 14 sites.
Greener Solutions 
Installation
	î Record all onsite energy creation (PVs) 
across the portfolio.
	î The recording of onsite energy creation has 
started at certain sites, with coverage to be 
improved upon during 2025.
Emissions data 
collection and 
SBTi targets
	î Improve Scope 3 emissions data collection.
	î Refine the emissions target, aligning to 
SBTi within the next two years.
	î We continue to work to improve our 
emissions data collection process actively. 
In 2024 we reported on our Scope 3 data 
for the first time alongside our first carbon 
balance sheet.
	î We remain committed to refining our 
emissions target within the next two years. 
We will be aligning with the SBTi and its 
definition of Net Zero (a minimum of a 90% 
reduction in absolute emissions with a 
maximum of 10% abated through offsets).

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
56
ESG report | continued
1,500
rooms sub-metered in 2024, providing 
us with further data for future training 
and behavioural adjustment.
2024 ESG commitments
Description
Key areas of progress in 2024
Environmental continued
Green capex
	î Install air source heat pumps (“ASHP”s)  
and PVs at >10 sites.
	î Roll out >3,000 in-room heating controls 
(Smart Panels, Smart TRVs or meters).
	î Full LED and PIR upgrades on >20 buildings 
that include plug and play fitting to help 
with future maintenance costs.
	î Set climate related investment thresholds.
	î ASHPs and PVs have been installed at 
two sites (Summit House, Cardiff and 
Brunswick Apartments, Southampton).
	î ‘Smart’ Radiator Valve Actuators (TRVs) 
have now been installed in over 3,000 
rooms. Smart in-room heating systems 
were installed at Brook Studios and 
Summit House in 2024 as part of energy 
efficiency refurbishments at both sites.
	î 167 Atamate and 1,653 SmarterDM smart 
heater units were installed and 1,285 
EcoSync ‘smart’ TRV units.
	î Estimated carbon savings of over 400 
tonnes (Atamate - 19,654kg; SmarterDM 
- estimated 280,000kg; EcoSync - 
100,673kg).
	î Full LED and PIR upgrades have now been 
planned for >20 buildings. 2024 saw LED 
upgrades at five sites: Windsor House, 
Cardiff; Maritime Studios; Ayton House; 
Centro Court; and St Peter.
	î Climate-related investment thresholds 
linked to investment decision-making  
will be considered further in the next 
reporting cycle.
Data gathering
	î Use data to inform planned summer and 
winter education programmes to support 
energy efficiency behavioural change.
	î We ran two well-received energy awareness 
campaigns across all sites in both summer 
and winter, leading to improved energy-
saving behaviours. 
	î We sub-metered over 1,500 rooms again 
in 2024, providing us with further data for 
future training and behavioural adjustment.

2024 ESG commitments
Description
Key areas of progress in 2024
Environmental continued
Building Energy 
Management 
System (“BEMS”)
	î Conduct BEMS surveys and upgrades  
at >30 sites.
	î Execute comprehensive Building 
Management System (“BMS”) upgrades 
across the portfolio, allowing for remote 
monitoring, data collection and control. 
	î Record all onsite energy creation (PVs) 
across the portfolio.
	î BEMS surveys have now been completed 
for >30 sites and our next target is to carry 
out upgrades and repairs to 5-10 BMS.
EPC Ratings
	î >55% of portfolio to be rated EPC B  
or better.
	î The percentage of our sites with EPC 
ratings of B or better has continued to 
increase, reaching 64% in 2024 (2023: 51%)- 
comfortably ahead of target. We plan to 
extend this target to >65% of the portfolio 
in 2025.
Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
57
64%
of portfolio rated EPC B or better
Social
Health and Safety
	î Establish Legal Register.
	î Deliver Wellbeing Management System 
and Framework, including lone working. 
	î Deliver Incident Management Guides 
to ensure consistent management and 
escalation of site-based incidents. 
	î Complete dynamic risk assessments of  
all sites, specific to local area.
	î Create a Security Self-Assessment tool 
which will require teams to objectively 
review the security in our properties and 
identify opportunities for improvements  
to physical and personal security.
	î Eight new documents were created and 
launched in 2024 to assist team members 
when supporting our customers with 
disabilities, including guidance for writing 
Personal Emergency Evacuation Plans  
and how to handle assistance animal  
and reasonable adjustment requests.

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
58
ESG report | continued
2024 ESG commitments
Description
Key areas of progress in 2024
Social continued
Opportunities  
for all
	î Launch apprenticeship scheme.
	î Complete bespoke leadership 
development programme for  
future leaders.
	î Define diversity focus areas and targets.
	î Provide training and accreditation to 
maintenance operatives.
	î Apprenticeship scheme and leadership 
development programme for supporting 
future leaders, “Hello Future Stars” 
launched.
	î Diversity target set for the Senior 
Management Team.
Enhance mental 
health and 
wellbeing
	î Achieve a net promoter score of +33.
	î Achieve employee engagement scores 
within the top 25th percentile of an 
externally benchmarked comparator group.
	î Mental Health First Aid training for all sites.
	î Our net promotor score (“NPS”) has 
improved and continues to rise. Our Q4 
2024 Global Student Living Index (“GSLI”) 
survey results showed an NPS of +32.
	î We achieved our goal to provide Mental 
Health First Aid training across all sites. 
Eight new documents were created and 
launched to assist team members in 
supporting our customers with disabilities.
Operations
	î Improve customer response times 
targeting resolution within 72 hours on  
70% of cases raised via the Student App.
	î Invest over 300 days in community or 
charitable support initiatives.
	î Our team members reached our target of 
over 300 days invested in charitable and 
community initiatives. Customer response 
times improved to 69% within 72 hours.
Engagement
	î Launch behaviour programme to engage 
employees and customers and measure 
impact on energy use across a sample  
of sites.
	î During 2024, we launched and completed 
an engaging energy awareness campaign 
which received great customer feedback 
and drove improved energy-saving 
behaviour.
NPS
+32
our Net Promoter Score  
continues to improve

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
59
Physical impacts of climate change
As part of our TCFD reporting, we assess physical climate 
risks that could impact our operations. More information 
about which physical risks we identified as a business can 
be found in the TCFD section of this report. As climate 
change intensifies, it is imperative for businesses to 
incorporate climate risk assessments into their strategies. 
This is particularly crucial for our assets located in 
vulnerable areas, where adaptation measures like flood 
insurance, physical asset resilience, and strategic lease 
terms are essential to ensure long-term sustainability.
Sustainable properties
We installed energy creating plant at 28 sites. Thirteen of 
which have had solar PV (photovoltaic) systems installed, 
a further seven properties have air source heat pumps in 
place, with combined heat and power systems in place 
at ten. Two sites have both air source heat pumps and PV 
systems installed.
To improve heating efficiency, ‘smart’ Radiator Valve 
Actuators (TRVs) have been installed in 3,105 rooms, 
contributing to a significant five per cent reduction in 
energy use per bed in 2024. The system collects data 
every five minutes, allowing for continuous improvement. 
Efforts to optimise boiler operation and reduce energy 
costs are underway and will continue in 2025. 
In 2024, waste management practices focused on 
recycling, with initiatives like local mattress recycling. 
Mattresses are now reconditioned and recycled every 
three to four years. Valuable materials such as foam, metal 
springs and textiles are also reclaimed and repurposed for 
other uses, helping divert additional waste from landfills. 
Biodiversity initiatives included creating meadows, 
installing beehives, and incorporating green roofs at 
various sites. The living green walls at St Mary’s contribute 
to our environmental impact, and bird and bat boxes 
support local wildlife. In 2025, we hope to continue our 
focus on preserving green spaces and actively improving 
environmental practices. 
“Biodiversity initiatives included 
creating meadows, installing 
beehives, and incorporating green 
roofs at various sites. The living 
green walls at St Mary’s contribute 
to our environmental impact,  
and bird and bat boxes support 
local wildlife.”
3,105
rooms have , ‘smart’ Radiator Valve 
Actuators (TRVs) installed to improve 
heating efficiency.

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
60
ESG report | continued
Employee health and safety 
The Board defines our Health and Safety Policy, which 
outlines the organisational structures responsible for 
its implementation. Our Head of Health, Safety and Fire 
and our Security and Business Continuity Manager take 
responsibility for our Health and Safety Management 
Systems within the Company. 
We are committed to conducting all our activities in a safe 
and secure manner, which is underpinned by our health 
and safety management standards and our commitment 
to continual improvement. Our Safety Blueprint details 
the governance structure we have to drive accountability, 
how we communicate with our teams to involve them 
in the proactive management of health and safety and 
how we manage health and safety risks. The Board is 
responsible for reviewing the Health and Safety Blueprint 
and the annual Health and Safety Plan for all areas of 
the business. They ensure that the Health and Safety 
Management System is proportionate, implemented 
and reviewed annually. Continuing throughout 2024, the 
Board has received monthly reports to help monitor the 
Company’s safety performance. 
We promote a culture of continuous improvement, to 
prevent any major incidents. Our aim is to eliminate 
significant accidents. The robust reporting system 
ensures that all accidents and near misses are logged 
and reported. Safety and professionalism are of 
utmost importance across all our sites. We extend 
this commitment to our onsite subcontractors, 
mandating their participation in the evaluation process 
for SafeContractor accreditation. This ensures they 
meet essential criteria and adhere to industry-specific 
regulations, to ensure a secure and dependable 
partnership. 
“We are committed to 
conducting all our activities 
in a safe and secure manner, 
which is underpinned 
by our health and safety 
management standards 
and our commitment to 
continual improvement.”
Asset health and safety 
The implementation of SafetyNet, a custom low-code 
incident reporting system, revolutionised our approach 
to health and safety. SafetyNet includes functionalities 
like Fire Risk Assessment, Audits, Compliance Checklists, 
Dashboards, and Contractor Management. Safety and 
professionalism are of utmost importance across all  
our sites. 
Since its launch, SafetyNet has significantly increased 
reported incidents, leading to thorough investigations 
and risk reduction measures. The transition to digital 
reporting has streamlined ease of completion, facilitating 
timely and enhanced compliance monitoring. The 
reported incidents cover Security, Wellbeing, and Fire, 
providing a comprehensive view of overall risk. We 
extend the above safety commitment to our onsite 
subcontractors, mandating their participation in the 
evaluation process for SafeContractor accreditation. 
This ensures they meet essential criteria and adhere to 
industry-specific regulations, to ensure a secure and 
dependable partnership. 
Health and Safety Statistics
Description
2024
Injury Rate (“IR”)
2.7
Lost Day Rate (“LDR”)
1.8
Accident Severity Rate (“ASR”)
0.009
Absentee Rate (“AR”)
2.4
Work-related fatalities for all  
direct employees
Nil
% of assets for which H&S impacts are 
assessed or reviewed for compliance  
or improvement
100

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
61
Stakeholder
Why We Engage
How We Engage
Topics
Outcome
Customers
The needs of our customers drive our 
brand and service offer. They provide 
vital feedback on how we can improve 
and better fulfil their needs. We have a 
responsibility to provide a secure and 
homely living environment and to care 
for their wellbeing. This is central to 
the Board’s strategic decision-making 
and any associated operational 
change.
	î On a day-to-day basis within  
our buildings.
	î Through biannual customer surveys.
	î Through our social media presence.
	î Through building relationships with 
universities in the towns and cities in 
which we operate.
	î Safety in their homes.
	î Customer service.
	î Value for money.
	î Building 
configuration.
	î Wellbeing.
	î Energy saving.
	î Birthday Card 
initiative.
	î Introduction of Mental 
Health First Aiders. 
	î Global Student Living awarded our 
operational brand, Hello Student,  
the accolade of Best Student Wellbeing 
2024.
	î Improving net promoter score.
	î 20 properties ranked within top three 
sites available in cities in which we 
operate (rated by our customers on 
Student Crowd).
	î Engaging energy awareness campaign 
completed receiving great customer 
feedback.
Employees
Our people are vital to the successful 
delivery of our business plan. We 
have a responsibility to provide our 
people with a safe place to work and 
to care for their wellbeing to enable 
them to prosper and succeed in their 
professional lives.
The values and culture of our 
organisation is embedded within  
our teams.
	î On a day-to-day basis we use Workplace 
as an internal communication tool.
	î Quarterly townhalls are held where  
our people can raise questions and 
provide feedback.
	î Through the One Team Collective.
	î One Team Tour, engagement 
programme completed by the executive 
team providing an opportunity for 
employees to engage directly with  
the Executives.
	î Safety at work.
	î Pay and reward.
	î Fair and equal 
treatment.
	î Business updates.
	î Real Living Wage Employer with a 
focus of improving the compensation 
arrangements for our lowest paid 
employees. 
	î Strong employee retention rate of  
78% per cent.
	î Diversity target set for senior leadership 
team.
	î 98% of employees have completed all  
of their essential training modules. 
Communities
The communities in which we operate 
help us fulfil our purpose of enhancing 
the university experience of our 
customers. We aim to understand each 
unique local community in which we 
drive decision making of how best we 
can make a difference.
	î Through on-site communication  
with members of the public and  
local communities.
	î We have membership with the British 
Property Federation where we can 
interact with communities and 
government on a wider basis.
	î Interaction through the property 
licensing disclosures we have  
to undertake.
	î Local job creation.
	î Provision of 
appropriate  
housing stock.
	î Supporting local 
charities.
	î Support provided to Switch 180 and the 
British Heart Foundation nationally.
	î Programme of charitable and community 
work across all sites with over 300 
days provided and over £4,000 raised 
by the workforce toward charitable or 
community initiatives during 2024.
Our stakeholders and how we engage with them

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
62
See also the Section 172 statement on page 96.
ESG report | continued
Stakeholder
Why We Engage
How We Engage
Topics
Outcome
Shareholders
Our shareholders are key stakeholders 
in our business. The Board has 
a responsibility and desire to 
communicate key matters relating  
to the Group openly and honestly  
to our shareholders.
The Group also has a wider 
responsibility to shareholders to 
enhance the value of the business  
and fulfil its purpose ethically.
	î Face-to-face meetings with investors 
typically following annual and interim 
results.
	î The publication of our Annual Report 
which presents a comprehensive 
update of the Company.
	î At our Annual General Meeting.
	î When significant change is proposed, 
for example, material transactions or 
changes to the remuneration structure.
	î Financial results, 
business performance 
and significant 
transaction.
	î Dividend payments.
	î ESG.
	î Remuneration policy.
	î Diversity.
	î Capital Raise. 
	î Numerous meetings with current 
and prospective shareholders held 
throughout the year.
	î Property tours conducted in Bristol, 
Edinburgh and Glasgow.
	î Attendance at industry conferences.
	î Consultation on equity raise.
	î Shareholder vote on future ESG strategy.
Environment
Our environment is fundamental to our 
future. We have a duty to operate our 
business in an energy efficient way, 
giving specific regard to the impact 
of our operations on the environment 
and utilising methods throughout our 
properties that mitigate the risk of 
environmental damage.
	î Biannually we provide a detailed ESG 
update within our Annual and Interim 
Reports.
	î Reduction in 
greenhouse gas 
emissions.
	î Becoming a 
sustainable business.
	î Published stand-alone ESG Report.
	î Improving our energy efficiency per bed 
with a 5 per cent reduction achieved.
	î Managing EPC risk with over 60 per cent 
of the portfolio now EPC B or better. 
	î Energy hedging contract secures 
electricity procured 100 per cent from 
renewable sources.
	î Scope 3 emissions disclosed for the  
first time. 
Lenders
Our lending partners are key to our 
financing strategy. They support the 
delivery of our day-to-day business 
plan through the extension of 
financing arrangements to facilitate 
developments, capital expenditure or 
acquisitions.
	î Open and regular dialogue with 
relationship managers. Proactive 
engagement in respect of sale and 
acquisition pipelines and early dialogue 
on refinancing requirements.
	î Ongoing covenant reporting.
	î Refinancing and 
hedging needs.
	î Update on asset 
management 
initiatives and related 
impact.
	î Covenant compliance 
and related security 
pool.
	î Prudent management of maturing 
debt with refinancing of all near dated 
maturities.
	î Quarterly covenant compliance reporting 
and regular engagement throughout the 
year.
	î Site visits.
Agents and 
Consultants
These stakeholders act on the 
Company’s behalf, therefore it is 
fundamental that we ensure they 
understand our business requirements 
and meet the high standards of 
conduct that we expect of ourselves.
	î Regular meetings and day to day 
communication.
	î Disposals, acquisitions 
and leasing.
	î Summer turnaround.
	î External tenders. 
	î Review of ERP 
provision and 
appointment.
	î Non-core disposal programme and 
annual refurbishment activity.
	î Tender of external valuation contract 
resulting in the appointment of Cushman 
& Wakefield.
	î Appointment of Yardi Systems as the 
Company’s ERP provider.

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
63
Employee wellbeing
In respect to our people, we have established several 
forums, to offer colleagues a variety of ways to share their 
views with the executive committee. For example, a formal 
employee representative group, the ‘One Team Collective’ 
(“OTC”); an anonymous ‘Talk To Us’ online suggestion 
box; and internal service surveys or annual engagement 
surveys. We conducted an engagement survey and 
completed a series of roadshows with the executive team 
who made themselves available to all employees at three 
separate venues around the UK. 
The OTC, now in its third year of formation, is a workforce 
advisory panel consisting of 11 employee representatives 
from across the Group. Its focus is to support meaningful 
dialogue on topics raised by our employees. The OTC met 
four times during 2024. All meetings were attended by 
Alice Avis, the Company’s Senior Independent Director 
who maintains regular dialogue with the Collective’s Chair 
throughout the year.
Wellbeing standard 
We have a ‘Wellbeing Standard’, which works to monitor 
and assess hazards and risks that could impact the 
wellbeing of team members. We work to identify all  
points of workplace stress and conduct risk assessments, 
to eliminate or control the risks caused by stress.  
The risk assessment will include the six key management 
standards; demands, controls, support, relationships, 
role, and change. The risk assessment process will include 
consultation with the One Team Collective on issues 
relating to the prevention of work-related stress.  
Access is then provided to confidential counselling for 
team members affected by stress, caused either  
by work or external factors. Managers and supervisors  
are provided with training and where applicable,  
access to resources, to help identify and address 
wellbeing concerns.
Customer wellbeing 
Customer experience, mental health and wellbeing are of 
utmost importance to us as a business, both commercially 
and as a duty of care for the continued safety of our 
customers. External data completed by students via 
the Global Student Living Index and general feedback 
received from site teams has helped us to identify areas 
for improvement. A programme of work was built and 
implemented, based on the above sources and resulted 
in improvements in our customer survey scores which led 
to being awarded Gold Operator certification officially in 
2024 from the Global Student Living Index. 
We understood from regular third-party customer surveys 
that a student’s accommodation, in terms of the quality, 
design of the building and the service they experience  
can have a marked impact on their mental health  
and wellbeing. 
In 2024, as a result of feedback received, we have 
continued to build on and develop a programme of events 
for students to engage with and encourage a sense of 
community. This included existing students welcoming 
new students to their new home from home on check 
in day and improved amenity space for residents to be 
able to socialise or study in a communal environment as 
part of our refurbishment of Brunswick Apartments in 
Southampton site in 2024. 
“We have also designed 
improved amenity space 
for residents to be able 
to socialise or study in a 
communal environment as 
part of our refurbishment of 
Brunswick Apartments in 
Southampton site in 2024.”

369
Total employees at  
31 December 2024,  
with two individuals  
non-specified.
Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
64
Key    
 Male 
 Female 
2024
2023
201
163
147
Total employees
204
2024
2023
17
14
7
Senior Management
8
2024
2023
3
3
2
Executive Management
2
ESG report | continued
Gender Pay Gap
Mean 2024
Mean 2023
Median 2024
Median 2023
Group Gender Pay Gap
13.45% 
(Male paid 
more than 
female)
10.1% 
(Male paid 
more than 
Female)
3.17%  
(Male paid  
more than 
Female)
1.85% 
(Male paid 
more than 
Female)
Group Gender Bonus Gap
44.76% 
(Male paid 
more than 
Female)
29.33% 
(Male paid 
more than 
Female)
-47.08%  
(Female paid 
more than  
Male)
-15.50% 
(Female paid 
more than 
Male)
Gender diversity statistics 
Diversity and inclusion
We believe in creating a diverse and gender-balanced 
workforce which reflects the customers and communities 
we serve. Our employees are committed to promoting 
an inclusive, positive and collaborative culture. We treat 
everyone equally irrespective of age, gender, sexual 
orientation, race, colour, nationality, ethnic origin, 
religion, religious or other philosophical belief, disability, 
gender identity, marital or civil partner status,  
or pregnancy or maternity. Our workforce and customers 
are from diverse backgrounds so we need to ensure that 
our workplace remains inclusive and allows our people 
and our customers a place where they can thrive. We are 
an equal-opportunity employer and will always aim to 
extend diversity as vacancies arise. 
Investing in future talent
In 2024, we launched a leadership development 
programme “Hello Future Stars” designed to support our 
businesses future leaders.
We have a Reward Policy across the business to ensure we 
are paying and rewarding all team members in a fair and 
transparent way based on clearly communicated rationale. 
We review pay for all team members on an annual basis 
(effective 1 January). The purpose of this policy is to set a 
fair and equal approach across the business.
The average hours of training that employees have 
undertaken in 2024.
2024
2023
Average number of training 
hours completed per employee
8 hours
21 hours
Percentage of total employees who received a regular 
performance and career development review in 2024
2024
2023
% of total employees who 
received a regular performance 
and career development review 
in 2024
100%
100%
Employee turnover and new hires
We aim to ensure our employees are proud and happy 
to work with us. The average percentage of voluntary 
employee turnover across the Group was 22% in 2024.
Employee turnover in 2024
2024
2023
Total Group
22%
15%
Number of permanent new hires in 2024
2024
2023
Under 30
44
43
Between 30 – 50
48
42
Over 50
14
17
Total
106
102

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
65
Raised over
£63,000
for the British Heart Foundation
Modern slavery
Protecting human rights and preventing modern slavery 
is important to us. We are fundamentally opposed to 
slavery and committed to understanding the risk of it and 
ensuring it does not occur anywhere within our business 
or supply chain.
Our most significant risk area in relation to slavery and 
human trafficking is within our supply chain, particularly in 
connection with the sourcing by suppliers of construction 
material, certain goods and the provision of manual labour 
in property development and management services.
While most of our direct suppliers are based in the UK,  
we are aware that some of their materials are sourced 
from around the world. However, all of our service 
suppliers are based in the UK and are SafeContractor 
accredited and are therefore regarded as low risk.
As part of our broader initiative to identify and 
mitigate risk in our supply chain, we have updated our 
consideration of factors such as:
	î reviewing our current contractors and suppliers, 
particularly in relation to supply chain, with a view to 
developing preferred supplier list arrangements based 
on robust selection;
	î centralising more contracts as a core part of our 
supplier management strategy; 
	î strengthening our compliance review processes within 
procurement practices; and 
	î developing strong relationships with UK-based 
suppliers and contractors that align to our business 
code of conduct expectations.
Furthermore, with nearly 7,700 students and 369 
employees under our care, we have a duty to ensure their 
safety, which includes freedom from modern slavery. 
 
Prior to recruiting staff, we complete checks on all Right 
to Work documents, including passports, share codes 
and overseas VISAs. We also complete DBS checks on all 
front-line operational staff. On appointment, employees 
are expected to familiarise themselves with our policies 
which they must confirm they have read and understood. 
The policies are available on an internal intranet site  
and include: 
	î Data Protection
	î Whistleblowing and Grievance Policies 
	î Anti Bribery 
	î Anti Money Laundering
	î Diversity, Equality and Inclusion
	î Duty to prevent Sexual Harassment
Additionally, employees must complete training to  
ensure they have a high level of understanding of the  
risks throughout our business. For modern slavery they  
are provided with practical guidance and ‘red flags’  
they should identify in the workplace or within the  
student accommodation.
Any concerns or grievances may be raised using the 
Whistleblowing policy which can be found on the website. 
The policy applies to all employees, suppliers, agents, 
contractors and customers of Empiric Student Property 
plc, and its subsidiary Hello Student Management Limited. 
We continue to believe there is a low risk of slavery and 
human trafficking in our colleague base. We regularly 
review this risk assessment and monitor our activity 
as part of our broader approach to ensuring we are a 
responsible and sustainable business.
For our full Modern Slavery statement please refer to  
www.hellostudent.co.uk or www.empiric.co.uk
Communities
In our third year partnering with the British Heart 
Foundation (“BHF”), its #PackForGood campaign saw 
Hello Student collect and donate nearly 3,000 bags of 
preloved clothing and household items, raising over 
£63,000 for the BHF’s life-saving research. Through our 
donations, we also helped divert 23,994 kg worth of waste 
headed for landfills, up 25 per cent on the previous year – 
highlighting our ongoing commitment to reducing waste 
at our student property sites. We will continue to support 
the #PackForGood campaign throughout the 2024 and 
2025 academic years. 
Our team members invested over 300 days toward 
charitable or community initiatives during 2024.

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
66
About the TCFD
The Group supports the Taskforce on Climate-related 
Financial Disclosures (“TCFD”) and believes it provides a 
strong foundation for developing our climate strategy. 
We understand that climate change presents potential 
risks to our property portfolio, business continuity 
and capital expenditure plans. There is a need for 
comparability in reporting across sectors, as businesses 
collectively tackle climate change. In 2024, we 
continued to follow the recommendations of the TCFD 
framework, assessing and improving our understanding 
of how climate-related risks and opportunities impact 
our business. This report aims to align with the TCFD 
recommendations to the greatest extent possible.  
While significant progress has been made in 
incorporating climate-related considerations into our 
governance, strategy, risk management, and metrics and 
targets, we are committed to continuous improvement 
in our TCFD reporting and are actively working to 
address identified gaps. Our most recent standalone 
TCFD report is available on our website.
Complying with the TCFD
UKLR 6.6.6R(8) requires mandated companies to include 
a Task Force on Climate-related Financial Disclosures 
(TCFD) statement in their annual report. As a premium-
listed Company, we have complied with the requirements 
of UKLR 6.6.6R(8) by including climate-related financial 
disclosures consistent with all 11 TCFD recommendations. 
In preparing these disclosures, we undertook a detailed 
assessment, taking into account Section C (‘Guidance 
for All Sectors’) of the TCFD Annex. Regarding progress 
against climate-related targets, we acknowledge that 
comprehensive progress reporting is pending which will 
be addressed in 2025. Current targets, based on current 
assessments, guided our actions for 2024. Our strategic 
resilience to climate-related risks is addressed through 
detailed risk mitigation strategies, as presented in our 
Risk and Opportunity Tables. We also acknowledge that 
our reporting on strategic resilience to climate-related 
risks can be further enhanced. We will provide more 
specific data on how our strategies perform under various 
climate scenarios, including those consistent with a 2°C 
or lower warming pathway.
Governance
Overview
The Group is committed to good governance and 
management of climate-related risks and opportunities 
in a responsible and transparent manner. We believe we 
need the collaboration of all our people to successfully 
deliver our ESG strategy, which is aligned with our overall 
business strategy and reinforced by the Company’s 
Board and senior leadership team. The Group has a well-
developed ESG Management Framework that embeds  
the management of climate change issues within  
our business.
Board-level oversight
The Board has overall responsibility for the oversight 
of climate-related risks and opportunities. The Board 
monitors and oversees progress against climate-
related goals and targets through delegation to the 
ESG Committee. All Board members are members of 
the ESG committee, which met three times during the 
year (March, August and December). Climate change is a 
standing agenda item at these meetings. These meetings 
included discussions of risks and opportunities related to 
climate change, climate disclosures, monitoring progress 
against climate-related targets and the integration of 
sustainability practices into business strategy. Future 
topics will include regulatory compliance, stakeholder 
engagement, carbon footprint reduction strategies, 
renewable energy initiatives, and the development of 
long-term climate goals. The Board considers climate 
change when reviewing business strategy, when making 
investment decisions and when setting annual budgets. 
The remuneration policy was updated in 2023, creating a 
clear linkage to ESG performance indicators and linking 
variable compensation arrangements to Health and Safety 
compliance objectives. All objectives remain subject to 
the discretion of the Remuneration Committee.
Non-financial and Sustainability Information Statement
Task Force on 
Climate-related 
Financial Disclosures 
(“TCFD”)

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
67
The Board
To assist in the effectiveness of the Board, it delegates certain matters to formal Board Committees to review and make  
recommendations back to the Board. All Committees must operate within their terms of reference which are set by the Board.  
Day-to-day operations are carried out by the executive Directors, who must adhere to policies and authorities set by the Board.
Nomination  
Committee
Considers the composition, 
skills and succession 
planning  
of the Board.
Audit and Risk  
Committee
Ensures the Group’s 
financial reporting and risk 
management is properly 
monitored, controlled  
and reported.
Remuneration  
Committee
Reviews remuneration 
of executives and 
senior leadership team 
in accordance with 
shareholder approved 
policy.
ESG  
Committee
Safeguards the interests, 
and monitors engagement 
with, stakeholders to 
ensure the Company 
demonstrates sound social 
and environmental risk 
management.
Senior Leadership Team
Working with the executive Directors, the senior leadership team ensure Company policies are embedded in the business  
and its operations and that strategic decisions are executed appropriately.
Governance structure
The Board structure for overseeing climate risks and opportunities
Read more on | page 116
Read more on | page 123
Read more on | page 118
Read more on | page 110

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
68
Task Force on Climate-related Financial Disclosures (“TCFD”) | continued
The Chief Financial and Sustainability Officer ensures  
that climate-related risks and opportunities are assessed, 
identified and managed, including management of  
the wider ESG projects on a monthly basis.  
Taking responsibility that the potential climate-related 
impacts are formally reported to the ESG Committee and 
the Board. In August 2024, our ESG advisors facilitated 
a workshop providing refresher training for the Board 
and management on climate change matters, including 
climate-scenario analysis to support the Board in fulfilling 
their duties to identify and monitor climate change 
risks and opportunities. All Board and ESG Committee 
members were in attendance. Subsequently, the Board 
and ESG Committee reviewed climate-scenario modelling 
to assess risks and opportunities related to climate 
change, which were then consolidated into a  
climate-risk register. 
The Board reviewed the climate risk register in its 
December 2024 meeting and approved the inclusion 
of significant climate-related risks into the Group’s 
comprehensive risk register. Climate-related investment 
thresholds linked to investment decision-making will be 
considered further in the next reporting cycle.
Management-level oversight
The Board ensures the dissemination of strategic 
priorities to senior management, who are responsible 
for implementing the Company’s ESG strategy within 
the business, including climate-related matters. The 
Board entrusts the ESG Committee and, in respect of 
risk management, the Audit and Risk Committee, with 
overseeing the ESG strategy and monitoring progress 
toward goals and targets related to climate issues.  
Both committees report to the Board three times a year.  
The ESG committee reviews climate change as a standing 
agenda item in its meetings and incorporates the climate 
change lens into reviewing business strategy. 
In 2024, our external ESG advisors attended the August 
meeting to provide support in assessing and addressing 
climate-related issues. They attend ESG Committee 
meetings as necessary to update the Board on the 
progress of climate modelling and the results from the 
climate scenario analysis.
Strategy
We recognise that climate change is a complex issue and 
acknowledge our responsibility to minimise our impact 
on the planet. In 2022, we identified climate change as 
an emerging risk; however, following further discussions 
in ESG Committee meetings, its status was updated 
to a principal risk in 2023 and remained so for 2024. 
Climate change is a dynamic process, and its impacts 
are constantly evolving. Extreme weather events are 
becoming more frequent and intense, and other  
climate-related changes, such as sea-level rise and 
shifting weather patterns, are also occurring. Assessing 
climate change as a risk annually has enabled us to stay 
ahead of such changes and adapt our risk management 
strategies accordingly.
This year, we have conducted and updated a climate 
scenario analysis to gain meaningful insight into 
climate-related risks and opportunities for our business 
over the short, medium and long term. We utilised the 
TCFD framework to develop our understanding and 
management of climate-related risks and opportunities 
relevant to our business, incorporating these into the 
strategic and financial planning process for the business.
Climate scenario analysis
Climate scenario analysis is a powerful tool that visualises 
various future scenarios using potential global warming 
pathways. By understanding these potential scenarios, 
we can better assess the risks and opportunities that may 
impact our operations, both directly and indirectly in 
various ways, such as new regulations, shifting  
market dynamics, or acute weather events like storms  
and wildfires.
In a world of uncertainty, climate scenarios are intended 
to explore a range of potential futures scenarios that may 
significantly alter the basis for business-as-usual.  
Multiple scenarios are used to analyse how different 
variables can result in varying outcomes. The climate 
models used for this analysis include data from the 
Intergovernmental Panel on Climate Change’s (IPCC) 
Representative Concentration Pathways (RCP), the 
International Energy Agency’s (IEA) World Energy Model 
(WEM), the Network for Greening the Financial System 
(NGFS) and other existing models.
The TCFD recommends the use of climate scenarios that 
are plausible and credible. Each scenario focuses on a 
different combination of key factors. The scenarios used 
in our 2024 analysis are in alignment with the ISO 14091 
standard. Climate scenarios are used to differentiate a 
range of possible scenarios rather than a single theme. 
Each climate scenario should contribute insight into 
the future that relates to strategic and/or financial 
implications of climate-related risks and opportunities. 
Scenarios provide a common reference point for 
understanding how climate change could evolve under 
different scenarios. Each was chosen to show a range 
of higher and lower-risk outcomes. It is important to 
remember that climate scenarios make projections on 
hypothetical situations and, as such, come with a degree 
of uncertainty. While some of the information obtained 
from existing climate models have a high degree of 
accuracy, there is still a level of uncertainty. As a result, 
scenario analysis is only used as a guide for climate-
related risks and opportunities. 

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
69
The Group has considered climate-related impacts 
under three primary scenarios:
	î Proactive Scenario (Below 2°C by 2100): this scenario 
reflects a future where significant global action is taken 
to limit global warming to below 2°C by 2100, in line 
with the Paris Agreement. In this scenario, transition 
risks will become more prominent, and regulatory 
pressure will increase. As a business, we are committed 
to adapting to a low-carbon economy by investing in 
renewable energy sources, reducing emissions, and 
adopting sustainable practices. 
	î Reactive Scenario (2-3°C by 2100): this scenario is 
associated with a future where global climate action is 
inconsistent, leading to a moderate increase in global 
temperature. In this scenario, we will prioritise risk 
management and adaptation strategies. This includes 
assessing and managing potential climate-related 
threats, developing contingency plans to address 
disruptions, and diversifying supply chains to  
reduce vulnerability. 
 
	î Inactive Scenario (Above 3°C by 2100): this scenario 
reflects a future where global climate action is limited  
or delayed. It necessitates a proactive approach to  
risk management for long-term sustainability.  
We will prioritise crisis management, survival, and  
long-term viability.
We have adopted a three-tiered approach to our analysis, 
extending beyond standard business timelines to 
encompass a long-term perspective up to and beyond 
2050. This enables us to identify emerging future risks and 
opportunities. The time horizons we have selected align 
with the UK’s 2050 Net Zero target and beyond, ensuring 
our analysis is relevant to the long-term sustainability of 
our business.
	î Short Term (2024-2027): We will demonstrate a 
proactive approach to sustainability through public 
commitments and progress towards our targets. 
To ensure ongoing compliance, we will constantly 
assess the legal landscape and regularly review 
environmental regulations and permits.  
The Board will actively oversee risk management 
and compliance efforts. The short-term will help us 
prioritise immediate action and demonstrate early 
progress while ensuring compliance and building a 
foundation for long-term success.
	î Medium Term (2028-2037): As the physical 
impacts of climate change become more 
pronounced, we will focus on building resilience 
in our operations. By diversifying supply chains, 
investing in resilient infrastructure, and adopting 
sustainable practices, we will be better prepared 
for extreme weather events and resource scarcity. 
We will implement flood insurance, fire safety 
standards, and heat-resistant building materials 
to mitigate climate change risks. This timeframe 
will help focus on adapting to climate change and 
building operational resilience, engaging in long-
term planning, and continuously improving upon 
the foundation laid in the short term.
	î Long Term (2038-2050): In the long term, we 
will drive a transformative shift towards a low-
carbon economy. Key strategies include investing 
in renewable energy, adopting circular economy 
principles, building climate-resilient infrastructure, 
exploring carbon capture and storage technologies, 
and supporting innovation and research. This 
extended horizon allows for implementing 
ambitious, long-term strategies such as investing 
in renewable energy and building climate-resilient 
infrastructure. By embracing these long-term 
strategies, we will position ourselves as leaders in 
sustainable business practices and contribute to a 
more resilient and sustainable future.
Analysis of results
We have thoroughly assessed climate-related risks  
and opportunities aligned with the TCFD framework.  
A comprehensive climate risk register captured all 
identified climate-related risks and opportunities.  
We identified thirteen transition risks, six physical risks, 
with five opportunities across 26 key locations. Ten of 
these risks (eight transition and two physical risks) were 
deemed material to our business. The ESG Committee 
reviewed these findings and presented them to the  
Board for final approval in December 2024.
Each climate-related issue is classified using our Group-
level standardised rating system. We assess the likelihood 
and impact of each risk to determine an inherent risk 
score. This inherent risk score is calculated by multiplying 
the likelihood and impact ratings. We calculate an overall 
net risk score by considering the effectiveness of our 
mitigating controls. Risks with a significant (inherent risk 
between 9 and 15) or high (inherent risk between 16 and 
25) are deemed material to the business. Only short-term 
material climate-related risks will be integrated into the 
Group’s risk register, as these risks have a more immediate 
impact on the business. Medium- and long-term risks, 
while significant, will be monitored annually in the climate 
risk register but will not be actively managed within the 
Group Risk Register. 

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
70
Task Force on Climate-related Financial Disclosures (“TCFD”) | continued
Table 2: Climate-related transition risks and mitigations
Climate Risk 
Category
Climate-Related Risk
Description of Climate-related Risk
Timeline, Scenario  
and Risk Rating
Financial Impact
Mitigating Controls in Place
Policy & 
Legal
T1: Enhanced 
emissions-
reporting 
obligations
The UK’s commitment to Net Zero 
emissions by 2050 is driving increased 
regulatory pressure on businesses.  
This includes stricter emissions 
reporting requirements and higher 
energy efficiency standards for 
commercial properties. We are already 
impacted by increased emissions 
reporting regulations in the UK (e.g. 
TCFD, SECR, ESOS). To comply with 
these regulations, businesses must 
invest in energy efficiency measures, 
carbon reduction strategies, and 
potential carbon offsets. However, 
relying too heavily on offsets can hinder 
direct emissions reduction efforts. 
Therefore, a balanced approach is 
crucial to achieve Net Zero goals while 
managing potential risks and costs.
Short - Medium 
Term (2024-2037)
<2°C, 2-3°C
Gross Risk: 20,  
Increased 
operating costs 
(higher compliance 
costs)
We already consider both existing and emerging  
(e.g. Minimum Energy Efficiency Standard (MEES)) 
legislation when assessing climate-related risks. 
Through our existing risk management programme and 
evolving environmental activities, we have dedicated 
internal resources and commenced collaboration with 
our ESG advisors to ensure we remain compliant with 
current and emerging regulations.
Costs on the business to remain complaint will 
be relatively low as a proportion of our revenue. 
Additionally, we have allocated £12m toward ESG 
initiatives aimed at reducing energy consumption and 
emissions and improving EPC ratings with the aim to 
meet the UK Government’s 2030 EPC B or better target.
We plan to mitigate the risks associated with 
overreliance on offsets by prioritising emission 
reduction strategies and using carbon offsets 
judiciously. Additionally, engaging with industry and 
policymakers can help shape a regulatory environment 
that supports the responsible use of carbon offsets and 
accelerates the transition to a low-carbon economy.
Covering all emission scopes prepares us for future 
reporting requirements. Establishing near-term and 
long-term targets demonstrates a proactive approach 
to emissions reduction, mitigating compliance risks. 
Plans to align with SBTi ensures targets will provide 
credibility, align with best practices and reduce the risk 
of regulatory misalignment. Exploring internal carbon 
pricing will further prepare us for potential future carbon 
pricing regulations.
We have achieved carbon reductions in both Scope 
1 and Scope 2 emissions. Please see the metrics and 
targets section for a full report on our Targets, Scopes 1, 
2, and 3 emissions, and future plans. 
Transition risks
Transition risks arise from indirect impacts of climate change, including changes in government policy, technology, and market conditions. Climate-related transition risks refer to 
risks associated with transitioning to a low-carbon economy. Several climate-related transition risks are listed in Table 1, which were identified as having a significant and high gross 
risk potential at our sites. We are responding to these risks and will continue to develop our controls over the next two years.
Risk rating
  Significant     
  High

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
71
Climate Risk 
Category
Climate-Related Risk
Description of Climate-related Risk
Timeline, Scenario  
and Risk Rating
Financial Impact
Mitigating Controls in Place
Policy & 
Legal 
continued
T2: Mandates on 
and regulation of 
existing products 
and services
Mandates/regulations, such as the 
Building Safety Act and Building Safety 
Regulator, may become more difficult 
to adhere to/meet if climate change-
related events (e.g., supply chain issues) 
hinder the capacity of our operations.
The UK Government’s increasing focus 
on sustainability is driving stricter 
regulations and standards for the real 
estate industry. New regulations like 
Biodiversity Net Gain (BNG) mandate 
a 10% increase in biodiversity value 
for new developments. Failure to 
comply with such regulations can halt 
development projects. This highlights 
the importance of understanding and 
adapting to the evolving regulatory 
landscape to ensure project viability  
and environmental sustainability.
Sector-specific decarbonisation 
strategies (Heat and Buildings 
Strategy and Future Homes Standard) 
require us to meet the targets and 
recommendations outlined by the 
frameworks (e.g., EPC grading by 2030). 
Real Estate Investment Trusts (REITs) 
may be exposed to energy-related 
regulations even though energy costs 
are often the occupants’ responsibility.
.
Short - Medium 
Term (2024-2037)
<2°C, 2-3°C
Gross Risk: 12,  
 
Decreased revenue 
due to reduced 
demand for current 
products and 
services
We have identified several risks associated with 
compliance with regulatory mandates so that mitigation 
measures can be established (e.g., H&S, External Wall 
System (EWS), Electricity Safety Rules, etc.). The Group’s 
capital allocation plans incorporate remedial work to 
ensure compliance. Good progress continues to be 
made, and the Group’s lenders and insurers remain 
comfortable with the progress made.
Our 12.5 per cent reduction in Scope 1 emissions 
and 5.1 per cent reduction in Scope 2 emissions 
are directly linked to our strategy of mitigating 
regulatory compliance risks and proactively addressing 
decarbonisation mandates (Heat and Buildings,  
Future Homes Standard, EPC improvements). 
Achieving Net Zero targets (2033 for operational 
emissions, 2050 for all emissions) strengthens 
operational resilience against climate change-related 
disruptions (e.g., supply chain issues), making it easier  
to meet mandates like the Building Safety Act.
The 2033 Net Zero target for operational emissions 
(Scopes 1 and 2) directly addresses the requirements of 
sector-specific decarbonisation strategies like the Heat 
and Buildings Strategy and Future Homes Standard, 
including the push for improved EPC gradings by 
2030. This target directly mitigates the risk of non-
compliance. Our 2033 operational emissions target 
is particularly relevant for addressing energy-related 
regulations that may impact REITs, even if energy 
costs are typically passed on to occupants. Reducing 
operational emissions helps mitigate these regulations’ 
financial and reputational risks.

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
72
Climate Risk 
Category
Climate-Related Risk
Description of Climate-related Risk
Timeline, Scenario  
and Risk Rating
Financial Impact
Mitigating Controls in Place
Market
T5: Changing 
customer 
behaviour
We may be at risk of loss of revenue, reduced 
profitability and reduced growth if unable 
to keep pace with changing consumer 
behaviour. Consumers may choose 
accommodation that is more energy efficient 
(higher EPC rating) to save on utility costs. 
With sustainability growing in importance, 
customers may change sentiment 
towards other Purpose-built Student 
Accommodation (PBSA) operators who 
provide more sustainable alternatives or 
may decide that it is more environmentally 
friendly and cost-effective to study at home 
compared to student accommodation. 
We have identified the potential for 
geopolitical events to cause supply/demand 
issues, e.g., international students being 
unable to study in the UK can result in up to 
50% revenue loss. Increased living, travel and 
utility costs as a result of carbon pricing may 
also result in fewer international students 
choosing to study in the UK.
Medium Term 
(2028-2037)
<2°C, 2-3°C
Gross Risk: 9,  
 
Decreased revenue 
due to reduced 
demand for current 
products and 
services
Our sustainability commitments are set out in the 
sustainability section of our website and our 2023 
ESG Report. We have demonstrated resilience and 
adaptability to customers’ changing demands by 
differentiating within the PBSA market with a highly 
efficient, low-embodied carbon product and efforts 
to attract climate-conscious customers. We have 
invested in and committed to an extensive capital 
investment plan to improve technologies that 
lower the carbon intensity of our accommodation 
to ensure sites are more sustainable. We have 
introduced annual energy awareness campaigns  
for our customers.
The 2033 Net Zero target for operational emissions 
(Scopes 1 and 2), which will drive improvements 
in energy efficiency and EPC ratings. Strong ESG 
credentials are likely to become a point of difference 
to our customers. The overall commitment to Net 
Zero emissions, including the 2050 target for all 
emissions (Scope 3), signals a strong commitment 
to sustainability, which is crucial for attracting 
environmentally conscious customers.  
This addresses the risk of students choosing 
alternative PBSA providers or opting to study  
from home due to environmental concerns.  
It demonstrates that we are taking  
sustainability seriously. 
Risk rating
  Significant     
  High
Task Force on Climate-related Financial Disclosures (“TCFD”) | continued
Table 2: Climate-related transition risks and mitigations

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
73
Climate Risk 
Category
Climate-Related Risk
Description of Climate-related Risk
Timeline, Scenario  
and Risk Rating
Financial Impact
Mitigating Controls in Place
Market 
continued
T6: Uncertainty 
of market signals
The absence of robust sector transition 
plans to Net Zero poses a significant risk 
to accessing capital. New sectors and 
competitors may form, offering customers a 
range of companies to take their business to.
New financing from government schemes 
and green investment opportunities may 
be missed if we do not progress on our 
decarbonisation plans. Future financial 
planning and budgeting may become 
increasingly difficult as the market  
becomes more volatile and reactive to 
climate-driven events. 
We may need to become more adaptive 
and flexible to the changes in the market to 
ensure we can continue to generate revenue 
and profit.
Market behaviour can often be volatile 
but can also present the Group with 
opportunities if we can adequately align our 
business model. 
Short - Medium 
Term (2024-2037)
<2°C, 2-3°C
Gross Risk: 10,  
 
Decreased access 
to capital
The Group is already taking a proactive approach, 
evidenced by public commitments and progress 
towards targets. Our Net Zero targets, especially 
the near-term 2033 operational emissions target, 
demonstrate a proactive approach to the sector’s 
transition to Net Zero. This reduces the risk of 
being outpaced by new competitors offering 
more sustainable alternatives and helps maintain 
access to capital as investors increasingly prioritise 
companies with clear decarbonisation strategies.

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
74
Risk rating
  Significant     
  High
Task Force on Climate-related Financial Disclosures (“TCFD”) | continued
Table 2: Climate-related transition risks and mitigations
Climate Risk 
Category
Climate-Related Risk
Description of Climate-related Risk
Timeline, Scenario  
and Risk Rating
Financial Impact
Mitigating Controls in Place
Market 
continued
T7: Increased 
cost of energy 
and raw materials 
Energy: Risk of increased energy costs as 
carbon prices are introduced on oil and 
gas imports. The unit cost of renewable 
electricity is more constant than that of 
electricity from fossil fuel sources. However, 
it can be more expensive, resulting in an 
increased cost of energy for the Company. 
As more businesses switch to renewable 
energy contracts, energy costs could also 
increase (supply vs demand).
Raw Materials: The EU has identified plastic, 
steel, ceramics, hydrogen and fertilisers 
as high-impact materials. High-impact 
products will be forced to decarbonise –  
as a result, new processes and technology 
may be introduced, increasing the cost of 
the raw material. Increased costs of raw 
materials such as steel and plastic may have 
unforeseen impacts on products purchased 
through our supply chain. Increased costs 
of raw materials can also only be passed on 
so much before the consumer searches for 
cheaper alternatives. Material alternatives 
can be sourced; however, they may have 
fewer desirable qualities, making products 
inferior and risking reputational damage.
Supply Chain: Unpredictable climate 
change impacts could significantly affect 
supply chains, with increased pressure 
on operations and labour in the form of 
contractors and subcontractors. Reliance on 
an undiversified supply chain can result in 
significant damage to business operations 
and profitability. 
Medium - Long 
Term (2028-2050)
<2°C, 2-3°C 
Gross risk: 15,  
 
Increased indirect 
(operating) costs
One of the main measures taken to mitigate against 
the rising cost of energy is price fixing, which is 
already a part of our energy procurement strategy. 
There is recognition that sustainable materials and 
technology may lead to increased costs. However, 
wide spread Net Zero targets should drive demand 
toward these solutions, decreasing their cost over 
the longer term. 
The Group is actively transitioning a number of its 
sites to all-electric power, significantly increasing 
the proportion of energy derived from on-site 
renewable generation. In 2024, Summit House in 
Cardiff and Brunswick Apartments were successfully 
converted and now utilise both photovoltaic  
(PV) panels and air source heat pumps (ASHPs). 
Looking ahead, planned conversions include 
College House and College Green in Bristol,  
The Exchange in Bath, St Marks in Leeds, Brook 
Studios in Birmingham, Claremont House in 
Glasgow, and Foss Studios in York. These sites 
will also feature either PV panels or a combination 
of PV and ASHP technology, further driving our 
commitment to renewable energy and reducing its 
carbon footprint. Converting to all-electric and on-
site renewables directly reduces Scope 2 emissions 
(emissions from purchased electricity). Please see 
the overall energy consumption (kWh) and total 
Scope 2 emissions in Tables 5 and 6 in the Metrics 
and Targets section. 
As we continue our journey to become Net 
Zero, we will aim to substitute our materials with 
lower-emission alternatives wherever possible. 
We have sub-metered over 1,500 rooms again in 
2024, providing richer data to enable training and 
behavioural adjustment.

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
75
Climate Risk 
Category
Climate-Related Risk
Description of Climate-related Risk
Timeline, Scenario  
and Risk Rating
Financial Impact
Mitigating Controls in Place
Market 
continued
T7: Increased 
cost of energy 
and raw materials
Full LED and PIR upgrades have now been planned 
for >20 buildings, including plug-and-play fittings 
to help with future maintenance costs. Additional 
initiatives that progressed during 2023 and were 
advanced further in 2024 included: a feasibility 
study for the implementation of solar panels at 13 
sites; a full portfolio survey to determine which 
buildings will benefit from PV, and 14 sites which 
will undergo decarbonisation surveys, contributing 
to the planned design to remove all gas boilers. We 
have created action plans for 14 of our least energy-
efficient properties, including disposals and works 
undertaken. The percentage of our sites that have 
EPC ratings of B or better continues to increase  
and is comfortably ahead of our stated targets at  
64 per cent.

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
76
Climate Risk 
Category
Climate-Related Risk
Description of Climate-related Risk
Timeline, Scenario  
and Risk Rating
Financial Impact
Mitigating Controls in Place
Reputation
T9: Shifts in 
consumer 
preferences
Our business is sensitive to consumers’ 
changing climate perspective. A reduction 
in consumer numbers and spending could 
have an adverse effect on our revenue and 
profitability. With sustainability growing in 
importance, customers may change their 
market sentiment towards other PBSA 
operators as more sustainable alternatives. 
The potential loss of business to more 
sustainable competitors could be harmful 
to revenue. Capital spend on technologies 
that lower the carbon intensity of student 
accommodation could be increased to 
ensure sites are more sustainable.
Medium Term 
(2028-2037)
<2°C, 2-3°C
Gross risk: 15,  
 
Reduced Revenue 
and Profitability
Utilising green marketing strategies and 
collaborating with agencies specialising in 
sustainability can enhance brand image and 
improve public perception. These efforts can help 
communicate the Company’s commitment to 
environmental initiatives, align with stakeholder 
expectations, and potentially mitigate reputational 
risks. Implementing green marketing techniques 
can also differentiate the brand in a competitive 
marketplace by showcasing its proactive 
approach to environmental issues. By prioritising 
sustainability initiatives, implementing transparent 
communication, leveraging innovation and 
technology, fostering partnerships, investing in 
employee training, and conducting regular risk 
assessments, we can effectively mitigate the risk 
of losing business due to customer preference for 
sustainable PBSA operators.
Our Net Zero targets act as a driver for the 
necessary capital expenditure to remain 
competitive in a market increasingly driven by 
sustainability concerns. By investing in low-carbon 
technologies and demonstrating a commitment 
to emissions reduction, we can attract and retain 
customers who prioritise sustainability, ultimately 
protecting its revenue and profitability.
Risk rating
  Significant     
  High
Task Force on Climate-related Financial Disclosures (“TCFD”) | continued
Table 2: Climate-related transition risks and mitigations

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
77
Climate Risk 
Category
Climate-Related Risk
Description of Climate-related Risk
Timeline, Scenario  
and Risk Rating
Financial Impact
Mitigating Controls in Place
Reputation 
continued
T10: Increased 
stakeholder 
concern
As the world transitions to a decarbonised 
economy, stakeholders are likely to have an 
increased focus on environmental impacts, 
climate change and Net Zero targets.  
Failing to properly communicate the way we 
will proactively reduce our environmental 
impact is likely to then negatively impact 
investor sentiment/ratings, potentially 
limiting access to capital. 
Should the Company not meet its climate 
targets, shareholders may decide to sell their 
shares, lending partners may be less likely to 
provide financial services, and the Company 
may not be eligible for green loan deals or 
opportunities, leading to a decreased  
market share and lost revenue growth.  
If the Company were not able to access 
green debt issuance, this could also result 
in higher finance costs. Therefore, there is a 
reputational risk associated with not meeting 
publicly committed targets.
Short - Medium 
Term (2024-2037)
<2°C, 2-3°C 
Gross risk: 12,  
 
Decreased access 
to capital, reduced 
Company valuation
We have allocated internal resources through a Net 
Zero strategy and engagement programme. We have 
also engaged with a third-party advisor to ensure 
compliance with current and emerging regulations.
Our aptitude for engaging with climate change is 
outlined in the business’s ambitious climate-related 
goals/targets for both 2033 and 2050.
We have also published a standalone ESG Report to 
communicate our efforts to stakeholders, including 
customers. We intend to continue to publish an 
annual standalone ESG Report to communicate 
efforts to stakeholders, including customers.

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
78
Risk rating
  Significant     
  High
Task Force on Climate-related Financial Disclosures (“TCFD”) | continued
Table 2: Climate-related transition risks and mitigations
Climate Risk 
Category
Climate-Related Risk
Description of Climate-related Risk
Timeline, Scenario  
and Risk Rating
Financial Impact
Mitigating Controls in Place
Technology
T11: Substitute 
existing products 
and services with 
lower-emission 
alternatives
Products and Services: Customer 
preferences are changing as people are 
increasingly considering the environment 
when making purchasing decisions. 
Listed buildings may have restrictions on 
renovations and the installation of low-
carbon technologies, which could have an 
impact on the EPC ratings these buildings 
could achieve. For instance, replacing 
traditional windows with energy-efficient 
ones might require special permits or 
alterations that are not allowed. This could 
have an impact on the EPC ratings that they 
are able to achieve. There are also financial 
implications. The inability to modernise 
existing assets can lead to write-downs.
Financials: The costs needed to ensure our 
services are sustainable are likely to increase, 
as we may need to invest in more technology 
and resources. Sustainable materials 
and services currently have a higher cost 
compared with traditional alternatives.
Due to reduced demand for existing 
products/services, which are associated with 
high emissions, the shift to more efficient 
technology and sustainable products/
services may present future opportunities.
Short - Medium 
Term (2024-2037)
<2°C, 2-3°C
Gross risk: 12,  
 
Increased direct 
costs
Revenue – decrease 
in revenue 
opportunities as a 
result of reduced 
market share
We have been proactive in our efforts to incorporate 
sustainability into the core of our operations.  
This has included the establishment of our Net 
Zero strategy and emission reduction targets with 
specific KPIs. As we are on the journey to reducing 
our carbon emissions, we can position ourselves as 
being prepared for changing customer demands. 
This directly contributes to our commitment 
to achieving Net Zero across our operations, 
developments, property portfolio, and energy 
consumption (Scopes 1 and 2) by 2033. The KPIs 
provide measurable milestones that allow us to 
track progress and ensure we are on track to meet 
this near-term goal. Furthermore, this work lays 
the foundation for achieving our broader target of 
absolute Net Zero emissions (including Scope 3) by 
2050 or earlier. The reductions achieved through 
our current initiatives will reduce our overall carbon 
footprint, making the 2050 target more attainable.
Please refer to the overview of our progress and 
future plans for improving energy performance 
across our portfolio under the energy efficiency 
narrative in the Metrics and Targets section of  
the report.
We have good experience of working with listed 
buildings and heritage offices to maximise them. 
Heritage England are being more accepting of 
building upgrades to heritage sites.

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
79
Physical risks 
Physical risks can be categorised as either chronic or acute. One-off events, for example, storms or floods, are considered acute. Ongoing changes, such as higher annual mean 
temperatures or rising sea levels, are classified as chronic risks. There are five potential physical risks of differing magnitudes which may impact our sites. For example, flooding, rising 
mean temperatures, water stress, coastal flooding and wildfires. These physical risks were assessed using the same scoring methodology as transitional risks. In this report, we have 
listed only the risks that scored 9 or above on our inherent risk scoring methodology, which were classified as material. Non-material risks and their assessment can be found in our 
standalone TCFD report. 
Risk rating
  Significant     
  High
Table 3. Climate-related physical risks and mitigations.
Climate Risk 
Category
Climate-Related Risk
Description of Climate-related Risk
Timeline
Scenario
Mitigating Controls in Place
Acute
P3: Heatwaves/ 
Extreme heat
26 out of 26 sites will experience heatwaves in the 
short-long term in the Reactive and Inactive scenarios.
People: Extreme heat/heatwaves may adversely impact 
our employees, causing a decrease in productivity. 
Employees may subsequently want to work for other 
companies that provide cooling during extreme heat 
events. Students may also be impacted. Students may 
decide to reside in different housing with adequate 
air conditioning. To maintain optimal temperatures 
for students, there may be an increased demand for 
cooling through AC units, driving increased energy 
costs and Scope 1 & 2 emissions. Additional costs 
of cooling solutions could be passed onto students, 
leading to the site being less desirable/out of their 
price range.
Property & Infrastructure: Certain construction 
materials and their properties may change under 
extreme heat conditions. Changes to material 
properties, such as improved glazing and ventilation, 
may require additional refurbishment work and 
costs. However, if not changed, the building may 
be less valuable as refurbishments will be required. 
Extreme heat can cause power outages, equipment 
malfunctions and infrastructure failure, leading 
to business disruptions. Back-up power systems 
can enhance our resilience but require high costs. 
Electrical efficiency decreases as temperature  
rises, resulting in an increased demand for energy  
at potentially a higher cost – energy costs can  
rise by as much as ~400% during a heatwave.  
This could be passed on to students, reducing the 
property’s desirability. 
Short - Long 
Term (2024-
2050)
2-3˚C, >3˚C
Gross risk: 9,  
 
Increased direct 
costs
We will target the establishment of 
questionnaires for employees and students, 
to understand the level of comfort, the impact 
experienced and improvement suggestions.
Our summer occupancy rate is relatively low, 
which acts as mitigation against heatwave 
impacts on students using the accommodation 
during the highest risk periods.
A heat impact survey has been drafted and 
will be circulated to students in affected areas 
following the next extreme heat event.
The 2033 Net Zero target for operational 
emissions (Scopes 1 and 2) drives 
improvements in energy efficiency and building 
design. This can lead to better insulation, more 
efficient cooling systems, and potentially even 
on-site renewable energy generation.  
These improvements create more comfortable 
living and working environments for employees 
and students, reducing the negative impacts 
of heatwaves and making our properties more 
attractive. This helps with both employee 
retention and student occupancy rates.
The broader commitment to sustainability, 
including the 2050 target for Scope 3 
emissions, encourages us to work with 
our supply chain partners to improve their 
resilience to climate change impacts. 

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
80
Climate Risk 
Category
Climate-Related Risk
Description of Climate-related Risk
Timeline
Scenario
Mitigating Controls in Place
Acute 
continued
P3: Heatwaves/ 
Extreme heat
As roads melt and rails buckle under extreme heat, 
there is an increased risk of some supply chain 
disruption. Disruption to transportation could lead 
to students moving to housing in closer proximity to 
their place of study.
Short - Long 
Term (2024-
2050)
2-3˚C, >3˚C
Gross risk: 9,  
 
Chronic 
P4: Sea level rise
19 out of 26 of sites are in potential sea level rise  
risk zones
Direct Impacts: Sea level rise could directly 
impact operating sites through erosion, flooding 
or subsidence. Closure of sites would result in a 
loss of revenue. Sea water inundation can damage 
properties, leading to an increase in renovation, 
repair and maintenance costs. Damaged stock and/
or machinery may need to be replaced, leading to an 
increase in capital spend. Building structures may be 
compromised, resulting in higher repair costs and 
possible site closures. Loss of revenue could also 
result from all ground-floor students being put up  
in hotels while repairs occur in the event of  
coastal flooding.
Indirect Impacts: Insurance coverage may decrease 
for sites known to be at risk of sea level rise. Future 
building upgrades, renovations or extensions may  
not be covered by insurance premiums.
Research shows that sites near high flood-risk zones 
are expected to see around a 30% rise in insurance 
premiums by 2040 without climate action.
Long Term  
(2038 – 2050)
>3˚C
Gross risk: 10,  
 
Increased direct 
and indirect 
costs
Most of our sites are in close proximity to city 
centres and university campuses, meaning 
mitigation for our sites at risk of sea level rise 
will be directly dependent on the overall flood 
defences (both installed and planned) in the 
towns and cities they are located.
In the next two years, we are aiming to have 
case study calculations to evaluate the financial 
implications of flooding on one of our sites to 
estimate the loss per day. 
The Group’s insurance policy would currently 
respond to a flooding event.
The long-term nature of the 2050 Net Zero 
target is particularly relevant to the risk. By 
working towards decarbonisation, we are 
contributing to a future where the most 
severe impacts of climate change, including 
sea level rise, are less likely. This reduces the 
long-term risk of structural damage, transport 
disruptions, and other negative consequences. 
Furthermore, the focus on energy efficiency 
and renewable energy sources (underpinned by 
our targets) can help reduce the vulnerability of 
energy networks to climate-related disruptions.
Risk rating
  Significant     
  High
Task Force on Climate-related Financial Disclosures (“TCFD”) | continued
Table 3. Climate-related physical risks and mitigations.

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
81
Climate Risk 
Category
Climate-Related Risk
Description of Climate-related Risk
Timeline
Scenario
Mitigating Controls in Place
Chronic 
continued
P4: Sea level rise
Long-term effects could cause a building’s physical 
structure to be damaged, resulting in lengthy ongoing 
repairs. Transport networks around a site may be 
inundated, leading to supply disruptions. Employees 
and students may be unable to reach the site, leading 
to reduced productivity levels and reduced occupancy 
levels, respectively. Sea ports may be forced to build 
sea defence improvements or relocate, leading to 
increased handling fees for goods.
Energy networks connecting to a site may be 
compromised, resulting in business disruptions. 
Power and water outages from storm events and 
coastal flooding can lead to high revenue costs. 
Students may be reimbursed due to a lack of adequate 
living conditions. IT infrastructure – which is vital 
for students to study in their accommodation – 
may be impacted, leading to reduced connectivity, 
communication delays and possible disruption to 
online website services. Reduced availability of IT 
services could lead to student relocation should the 
problem persist.
Long Term  
(2038 – 2050)
>3˚C
Gross risk: 10,  
 

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
82
Climate Opportunity 
Category
Climate-Related 
Opportunity
Impact description
Timeline and Scenarios 
Financial Impact 
Opportunity response strategy
OP1: Energy 
Resources
Use and 
installation of 
low-emission 
energy 
technology
The TCFD and International Energy 
Association agree that a growing 
proportion of energy generation must 
come from low-emission alternatives to 
reach carbon targets. Using low-emission 
technology to power business operations 
also has reputational benefits and may 
lead to financial gain.
Short - Medium 
Term (2024-2037)
<2°C, 2-3°C
Self-generated 
electricity can be 
used in business 
operations, and 
excess sold to  
the grid
Possible options such as installing Solar PV would allow 
us to generate electricity on-site and transition away 
from grid reliance, helping to mitigate any potential 
carbon tax. On-site energy generation would reduce 
energy costs significantly, therefore reducing annual 
operational spend. On-site generation would also  
help to significantly reduce our direct emissions,  
which may help in mitigating any carbon price risks.  
We could also make use of several financing schemes 
and investment opportunities to help subsidise the 
upfront costs of low-emission technology. 
2033 Net Zero Target (Scopes 1 & 2): This target 
directly incentivises the adoption of low-emission 
energy technologies. The targets support the financial 
benefits of on-site energy generation.  
By reducing reliance on grid electricity, we can 
mitigate the impact of potential future carbon  
taxes and reduce overall energy costs. 
OP 2: 
Resource 
Efficiency
Use of energy-
efficient 
technology
The TCFD emphasises the need for a 
significant increase in low-emission 
energy generation to achieve 
carbon reduction goals. Whilst the 
implementation of energy-efficient 
technology may have a high capital cost, 
the technology will improve the efficiency 
of processes. As a result, less energy will 
be used to do the same work, reducing 
energy costs. The savings in energy will 
also lead to fast payback times for the 
technology, resulting in net financial gain 
over the technology’s lifetime. Installing 
energy-efficient assets poses higher 
commercial value, resulting in higher 
portfolio valuation.
Short - Medium 
Term (2024-2037)
<2°C, 2-3°C
Reduction in 
operating expenses 
because of 
increased efficiency 
(e.g., energy costs)
We are committed to decarbonising operational 
emissions, aiming to be Net Zero across 
operations, developments, property portfolio 
and energy consumption by 2033. Currently, we 
have decarbonised 25 per cent of our portfolio by 
area, representing 21 assets. While the initial 2025 
decarbonisation plan has been adjusted to prioritise 
end-of-life or failed plant replacements with more 
sustainable alternatives, the subsequent phase will 
focus on eliminating all gas-powered hot water 
systems from plant rooms. This strategic approach 
allows for a systematic transition to cleaner energy 
sources and demonstrates progress toward the 
ambitious 2033 Net Zero target.
We have also set a wider target of being Net Zero in all 
emissions (Scope 3) by 2050 or before. 
Task Force on Climate-related Financial Disclosures (“TCFD”) | continued
Table 4. Climate-related opportunities and response.
Climate-related opportunities
We are eager to seize the opportunities presented by the transition to a low-carbon economy. These opportunities, identified as material at our September 2024 climate risk 
workshop, were selected following a rigorous assessment of their potential impact, alignment with our strategic goals, and feasibility of implementation. By investing in lower-
emission technologies, we can reduce operational costs and enhance our market position. Furthermore, our proactive and transparent approach to environmental sustainability 
strengthens our reputation with stakeholders, providing a competitive edge.

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
83
Climate Opportunity 
Category
Climate-Related 
Opportunity
Impact description
Timeline and Scenarios 
Financial Impact 
Opportunity response strategy
OP 3: 
Products 
and Services
New low-
emission product 
and service lines
Organisations that innovate and develop 
new low-emission products and services 
may improve their competitive position 
and capitalise on shifting consumer and 
producer preferences.
Consumers are increasingly placing a 
greater emphasis on a product’s carbon 
footprint in its marketing and labelling.
Short - Medium 
Term (2024-2037)
<2°C, 2-3°C
New revenue 
streams
We recognise that customer preferences have 
not fully aligned yet and lower emissions are not 
currently the main reason for selecting our sites. 
However, over time, customer preferences are likely 
to shift towards services with greater importance 
placed on sustainability credentials alongside other 
aspects such as cost of living, location and quality 
of accommodation and service. We can, therefore, 
increase our market share by decarbonising our 
operations through new energy-efficient buildings 
and retrofitting obsolete buildings to highlight the 
reduction in emissions of our sites.
We anticipate that the upfront cost of sustainable 
products will outweigh the potential increase in 
revenue associated with demand for sustainable 
services in the short term. However, we expect that 
increased demand and long-term efficiencies will 
ultimately result in the revenue impact of inactivity 
exceeding associated cost.
We exceeded our 2024 target to have over 55% of our 
portfolio rated EPC B or higher, achieving 64 per cent 
by year-end. Building on this success, our 2025  
target is to have over 65% of the portfolio rated EPC B 
or higher.
Our Net Zero targets allow them to capitalise on the 
growing demand for sustainable accommodations, 
strengthening their competitive position. Also, our 
transparent emissions reporting enables us to credibly 
showcase reduced carbon footprint, appealing to 
environmentally conscious consumers.

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
84
Task Force on Climate-related Financial Disclosures (“TCFD”) | continued
Table 4. Climate-related opportunities and response.
Climate Opportunity 
Category
Climate-Related 
Opportunity
Impact description
Timeline and Scenarios 
Financial Impact 
Opportunity response strategy
OP 6: 
Reputation
Increased 
reputational 
profile and 
investment 
opportunities
Adhering to new sustainability 
standards and regulations can enhance 
our reputation as a responsible and 
forward-thinking Company. This can 
attract environmentally conscious 
stakeholders, differentiate the Company 
from competitors, and potentially open 
new business opportunities. Additionally, 
compliance with regulations can unlock 
access to green financing options, 
providing a competitive advantage.
Refined SBTi-aligned targets and 
submission within the next year could  
also enhance reputational benefits.
Short - Medium 
Term (2024-2037)
<2°C, 2-3°C
New revenue 
streams
Increased market 
share
Our transparency in communicating environmental 
values and strategy regarding climate change and Net 
Zero creates a strong market-leading reputation.
Our expertise in extensive refurbishment and 
repurposing of existing building stock continues 
to create high-quality PBSA operations with a low 
environmental impact and associated embodied 
carbon via the repurposing of existing buildings.
The 2033 and 2050 Net Zero targets significantly 
enhance our reputation as a responsible and forward-
thinking Company. This attracts environmentally 
conscious stakeholders, including investors, students, 
and employees. Demonstrating a commitment to 
science-based targets signals credibility and ambition.

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
85
Supply chain
The Group has comprehensively assessed the physical 
risks associated with its top ten suppliers. Key risks 
identified include:
	î Heatwaves and Rising Temperatures: All ten 
suppliers are exposed to the risk of heatwaves and 
rising temperatures, which can lead to operational 
disruptions, reduced productivity, and increased  
energy costs.
	î Flooding: Seven suppliers are in areas vulnerable 
to flooding, which can cause significant damage to 
facilities, equipment, and inventory.
	î Wildfires: Three suppliers are at risk from wildfires, 
which can result in supply chain disruptions, property 
damage, and potential loss of life.
	î Sea-level rise and Coastal Flooding: Three suppliers 
are situated in regions that may be affected by sea-level 
rise and coastal flooding, which can lead to increased 
insurance costs, operational challenges, and potential 
relocation expenses.
We will conduct regular vulnerability assessments and 
scenario planning exercises to assess the resilience of 
our current business processes. These assessments will 
analyse potential disruptions, such as climate change, 
pandemics, geopolitical instability, and supply chain 
bottlenecks. We will identify critical dependencies, assess 
the potential impact of disruptions on our operations, and 
develop mitigation strategies. This proactive approach 
will enhance our resilience and sustainability by enabling 
us to anticipate and respond effectively to unforeseen 
events, ensuring business continuity, and minimising the 
impact of disruptions on our operations and our students. 
Risk management
Effective risk management is paramount to our business 
success. We have established a robust process for 
identifying, assessing, documenting and mitigating 
potential risks, recognising the challenges that could 
hinder our strategic goals. The Board sets the Group’s 
risk management framework, and the Audit and Risk 
Committee oversees its implementation annually.  
Please refer to page 38 for a detailed overview of our  
risk management process.
With support from our third-party consultants, climate-
related risks were identified through climate-scenario 
modelling and reviewed and assessed at a Board-level 
workshop in August 2024. These risks were compiled into 
an internal climate-risk register, aligned with the Group’s 
risk register structure but with the appropriately modified 
risk timeframes used in the climate-scenario modelling. 
Please see the Strategy section for a detailed description 
of the timeframes used. 
Each climate-related issue is assessed and classified using 
our standardised Group-level rating system. We assess 
the likelihood and impact of each risk to determine an 
inherent risk score. This score is calculated by multiplying 
the likelihood and impact ratings. Specific individuals 
or teams are assigned ownership of climate-related 
risks to ensure effective risk management. This clear 
accountability structure facilitates the implementation  
of appropriate mitigation strategies.
Table 4 presents a risk assessment matrix that 
categorises risks based on their likelihood and impact. 
Impact of Risk: The impact of risk refers to the potential 
consequences or effects that a risk event could have on 
the Group. It assesses the severity of the outcomes if 
the risk materialised, which could include financial loss, 
reputational damage, operational disruptions, regulatory 
penalties, or strategic setbacks.
Likelihood of Risk: The likelihood of risk refers to the 
probability or chance that a specific risk event will occur. 
It evaluates how probable it is that the risk will materialise, 
ranging from highly unlikely to almost certain. This helps 
prioritise risks based on their potential frequency  
and significance.
Likelihood Factor
Rating
Impact Factor
Rating
Unlikely / Rare
1
Negligible / Insignificant
1
Possible / Seldom
2
Low / Marginal
2
Probable / Occasional
3
Medium / Serious
3
Very Likely / Moderate
4
Significant / Critical
4
Almost Certain / Very Frequent
5
High / Catastrophic
5
Net inherent risks factor
Negligible (Dark green) – Inherent risk is equal to or lower than 2.
Low (Light green) – Inherent risk is between 3 and 5.
Medium (Yellow) - Inherent risk is between 6 and 8.
Significant (Amber) – Inherent risk is between 9 and 15 and qualifies as material.
High (Red) – Inherent risk is between 16 and 25, qualifies as material.
Table 4: Risk Rating Criteria

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
86
The matrix assigns numerical values to these factors, 
ranging from 1 to 5, where 1 represents the lowest 
level and 5 is the highest. Risks are classified into five 
categories with corresponding colour codes: negligible, 
low, medium, significant, and high, depending on  
their inherent risk score. This categorisation aids in 
prioritising risks and allocating resources for effective  
risk management. By understanding and assessing risks 
in this manner, organisations can proactively mitigate 
potential threats and support business continuity.  
Risks with a significant (inherent risk between 9 and 15) 
or high (inherent risk between 16 and 25) are deemed 
material to the business.
We also consider various mitigation measures to reduce 
the impact of these risks. By evaluating the effectiveness 
of these controls, we calculate a net risk score. This net 
risk score reflects the residual risk after accounting for 
mitigation measures. It is important to note that while 
we assess the effectiveness of our mitigation measures, 
our materiality threshold is based solely on the inherent 
risk score. This ensures that we prioritise risks with the 
highest potential impact, irrespective of the strength of 
our current controls.
Metrics & targets
At the Group level, we are committed to ongoing annual 
reporting on environmental performance. Where possible, 
we strive to reduce greenhouse gas (GHG) emissions 
across all sites. We calculate and report on Scope 1, 2, 
and 3 GHG emissions to provide full transparency to 
stakeholders. The operational control approach is used to 
consolidate the Company’s organisational boundary. 
No progress against targets has been recorded yet, as we 
aim to align our targets with SBTi in the next two years. 
This approach allows us to gather sufficient data to ensure 
that targets subsequently set are both ambitious and 
feasible, grounded by comprehensive data analysis.  
We have compiled the data presented in this report 
based on internal records and calculations. While 
reasonable care has been taken to ensure the accuracy 
and completeness of the information, it has not been 
externally verified. Verification is currently under 
consideration by the ESG Committee.
Our targets
	î We are committed to decarbonising operational 
emissions, aiming to achieve Net Zero across our 
operations, developments, property portfolio, and 
energy consumption (absolute Scopes 1 and 2) 
by 2033. This ambitious near-term target reflects 
our commitment to rapid progress in emissions 
reduction.
	î We have set a broader target of being Net Zero 
 in all our emissions (including absolute Scope 3)  
by 2050 or sooner.
We are currently focused on refining our data collection 
and analysis methodologies for measuring progress 
against our targets. We will be aligning with the SBTi and 
its definition of Net Zero which is a minimum of a 90 per 
cent reduction in absolute emissions with a maximum of 
10 per cent abated through offsets. As part of the SBTi 
alignment process, we will assess our baseline year and 
re-baseline if needed to ensure consistency with SBTi 
criteria. Once this process is complete, we will be well-
positioned to report on our progress against our targets. 
Year-on-year comparisons are currently available in our 
SECR reporting, though not yet in the Carbon Balance 
Sheet. We expect to expand our reporting capabilities 
following the SBTi alignment.
The targets differ between scopes due to the difficulty 
compiling and calculating Scope 3 data. Data collection 
for Scope 3 emissions is complex, involving gathering 
information from numerous suppliers, customers, and 
other stakeholders. This complexity makes setting 
specific and quantifiable targets for Scope 3 emission 
reductions within the same timeframe as Scope 1 and 2 
more challenging. The 2033 target focuses on directly 
controllable emissions (Scopes 1 and 2) where data 
availability and control are more controllable. 
Our targets have been explicitly linked back to the 
identified risks detailed in Tables 1, 2, and 3, where 
relevant. Additionally, we will seek to incorporate an 
internal carbon price within the next two years.  
We will also consider purchasing credits representing 
removals of carbon emissions from external projects. 
Streamlined Energy and Carbon Reporting (SECR)
This report details our energy usage, emissions, energy 
efficiency measures, and performance in accordance 
with the UK government’s Streamlined Energy & Carbon 
Reporting (SECR) policy. SECR disclosures are mandatory 
for listed and large unlisted UK companies with reporting 
periods starting on or after 1 April 2019. This reporting 
obligation stems from the Companies (Directors’ 
Report) and Limited Liability Partnerships (Energy and 
Carbon Report) Regulations 2018. As a UK-incorporated 
and main market-listed Company, we are required to 
disclose our energy consumption, associated emissions, 
intensity metrics, and implemented energy efficiency 
improvements for all our UK operations. For the purposes 
of this report, an operational boundary has been defined. 
To ensure complete data coverage, 18.5 per cent of the 
consumption data used in this SECR report has been 
estimated. Scope 3 transport emissions have been 
calculated and included for the first time in 2024.
Scope 1 consumption and emissions include direct 
combustion of natural gas, and fuels utilised for 
transportation operations, such as Company vehicle 
fleets. Scope 2 consumption and emissions cover indirect 
emissions related to the consumption of purchased 
electricity in day-to-day business operations. Scope 3 
consumption and emissions cover emissions resulting 
from sources not directly owned by us i.e., grey fleet 
business travel undertaken in employee-owned vehicles.
	î Our Scope 1 direct and Scope 3 indirect emissions 
(combustion of natural gas and transportation fuels) for 
this reporting year are 2,859.24 tCO2e, resulting from 
the direct combustion of 15,608,664 kWh of fuel.  
This represents a carbon reduction of 12.5 per cent  
from 2023.
	î Scope 2 indirect emissions (purchased electricity, heat 
& steam) for this reporting year are 3,831.32 tCO2e, 
resulting from the consumption of 18,580,162 kWh of 
electricity purchased and consumed in day-to-day 
business operations. This represents a carbon reduction 
of 5.1 per cent from 2023.
	î Our operations have an intensity metric of 0.857 tCO2e 
per bed for this reporting year. This represents an 
increase in the operational carbon intensity of 6.5 per 
cent since 2023.
Task Force on Climate-related Financial Disclosures (“TCFD”) | continued

*Scope 3 transport emissions have been calculated and included for the first time in 2024.
*Scope 3 transport emissions have been calculated and included for the first time in 2024.
Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
87
Year-on-year changes
Building energy: Both electricity and gas consumption, 
and therefore emissions, have fallen between 2023 and 
2024. The number of beds in operation this year fell, 
meaning fewer students were occupying rooms. In turn, 
this will have reduced the demand for electricity and gas 
use, reducing overall consumption. 
Transport: While Scope 1 emissions remained at zero 
in 2024, this year was the first year that data had been 
collected for Scope 3 transport. This introduction has 
caused an apparent rise in transport emissions, however 
year-on-year comparisons will be much more normalised 
going forward. 
Intensity metric: Emissions per bed have increased this 
year. This is due to number of beds decreasing further 
than electricity consumption, increasing the electricity 
emissions per bed. The introduction of transport 
emissions have also contributed to the overall increase  
in emissions intensity.
Energy efficiency and consumption 
As a business we are resolute in decarbonising our 
operations. We aim to be Net Zero across our operations, 
developments, property portfolio, and energy 
consumption by 2033 (Scopes 1 and 2). A more extensive 
objective is set to attain Net Zero emissions across  
all scopes, including Scope 3, by 2050 or earlier.  
To meet this target, we have devised several initiatives.  
For example, the organisation currently sources 100 
per cent of our electricity requirements from renewable 
sources, achieved through requirements within energy 
contracts to procure 100 per cent from renewable 
sources. We have achieved our 2024 target to have over 
55 per cent of the portfolio awarded an EPC rating of B or 
higher, and plan to extend this to >65 per cent in 2025. 
This is achieved by improving the property’s energy 
performance as part of our refurbishment plans. This is 
complemented by ensuring ESG metrics are considered 
when deciding to acquire or develop new schemes. We 
have allocated internal resources through a Net Zero 
strategy and engagement programme, to meet these 
targets. Furthermore, we aim to validate our Net Zero 
target with the Science Based Targets initiative (SBTi) 
within the next two years. 
Utility and Scope
2024 Consumption kWh 
UK
2023 Consumption kWh 
UK
Scope 1 Total
15,498,346
17,860,825
Natural Gas (Scope 1)
15,498,346
17,860,825
Scope 2 Total
18,580,162
19,955,946
Grid-Supplied Electricity (Scope 2)
18,007,162
19,353,562
Heat, Steam & Cooling (Scope 2)
573,000
602,384
Scope 3 Total
110,318
n/a
Transportation (Scope 3)*
110,318
n/a
Total
34,188,826
37,816,771
Table 5: Total Energy Consumption (kWh)
Table 6: Total Location-based Emissions (tCO2e)
Utility and Scope
2024 Consumption tCO2e
UK
2023 Consumption tCO2e
UK
Year on year
% change
Scope 1 Total
2,834.65
3,267.00
-13.23%
Natural Gas (Scope 1)
2,834.65
3,267.00
-13.23%
Scope 2 Total
3,831.32
4,038.95
-5.14%
Grid-Supplied Electricity (Scope 2)
3,728.38
4,007.63
-7.00%
Heat, Steam & Cooling (Scope 2)
102.94
31.32
+228.67%
Scope 3 Total
24.59
n/a
n/a
Transportation (Scope 3)*
24.59
n/a
n/a
Total
6,690.56
7,305.95
-8.42
Table 7: Total Emissions Intensity Metric
Location-Based
Market based
2024
2023
2024
2023
Total Beds
7,808
9,078.00
7,808
9,078.00
All Scopes tCO2e per Bed
0.857
0.805
0.551
n/a
Percentage Change
+6.47%
N/A

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
88
Energy efficiency narrative
The following table provides an overview of our progress and future plans for improving energy performance across 
its portfolio. It highlights key initiatives undertaken in 2024, demonstrating progress towards established goals, 
and outlines strategic objectives for 2025, including targets for renewable energy procurement and building energy 
performance. This narrative demonstrates our commitment to energy efficiency and carbon reduction. Please also refer 
to our Key 2024 ESG-related highlights and key areas of progress in 2024 on page 54.
Table 8: Measures Undertaken
Measures Undertaken In 2024
Measures Planned for 2025
Energy Awareness Campaign:  
With the aim to educate students about energy saving 
in a fun and engaging way, the team hosted a Student 
Energy Awareness Week. This included providing 
student competitions, a social media awareness 
campaign, and an interactive learning space.
Renewable Energy Procurement:  
We source 100% of our electricity from renewable 
sources. This will continue to be achieved through 
requirements in energy contracts to procure 100% 
renewable energy during 2025.
2024 EPC Target Reached:  
We achieved our target to have over 55 per cent of the 
portfolio awarded an EPC rating of B or higher by the  
end of the year.
2025 EPC Target:  
In 2025, we target over 65 per cent of the portfolio  
to be awarded an EPC rating of B or higher.
Building Efficiency Projects:  
Brook Studios and Summit House have both recently 
been renovated to improve energy efficiency, with the 
addition of solar panels, air source heat pumps, and 
smart in-room heating systems.
SBTi Validation:  
We aim to align and validate our Net Zero strategy and 
targets to the Science Based Targets initiative over the 
next two years.
Also see page 29 for the Group’s ESG related Key 
Performance Indicators.
Our methodology
This report (including the Scope 1, 2 and 3 kWh 
consumption and CO2e emissions data) has been 
developed and calculated using the GHG Protocol –  
A Corporate Accounting and Reporting Standard 
(World Resources Institute and World Business Council 
for Sustainable Development, 2004); Greenhouse Gas 
Protocol – Scope 2 Guidance (World Resources Institute, 
2015); ISO 14064-1 and ISO 14064-2 (ISO, 2018; ISO, 
2019); Environmental Reporting Guidelines: Including 
Streamlined Energy and Carbon Reporting Guidance 
(HM Government, 2019). Government Emissions Factor 
Database 2024 version 1 has been used, utilising the 
published kWh gross calorific value (CV) and kgCO2e 
emissions factors relevant for the reporting period 
01/01/2024 – 31/12/2024. Estimations were undertaken  
to cover missing billing periods for properties.  
These were calculated on a kWh/day pro-rata basis at 
the meter level. These full-year estimations were applied 
to two electricity supplies and one gas supply. The 
December 2024 billing period has been estimated based 
on average consumption across the January to November 
2024 billing period. All estimations equated to 18.5 per 
cent of reported consumption. For the market-based 
emissions reporting methodology, an emissions factor of 
0 tCO2/kWh was applied to all electricity supplied from 
renewable energy contracts. Intensity metrics have been 
calculated using total tCO2e figures and the selected 
performance indicator for the relevant report period:  
Bed count for 2024 (2023) 7,808 (9,078).
Carbon balance sheet 2023
This Carbon Balance Sheet contains our full greenhouse 
gas (GHG) emissions inventory for 2023 (01/01/2023 
- 31/12/2023). Due to data availability and quality 
constraints, we are a year behind in reporting.  
However, we are actively working to improve data 
availability. Next year’s report will include Scope 3 
emissions for 2024 and 2025 to align our reporting with 
the current period. Our emissions are reported using a 
consolidation, operational control approach defined by 
the GHG Protocol. All emissions have been calculated 
following the GHG Protocol’s Corporate Accounting  
and Reporting Standard.
Emissions analysis
All fifteen Scope 3 categories were assessed for relevance 
to the business, and nine were found applicable and 
quantified. The remaining six categories were deemed 
non-applicable due to the nature of our operations. 
Category 9: Downstream Transportation and Distribution 
– The business does not engage in downstream 
transportation or distribution of goods, Category 10: 
Processing of Sold Products – Only finished properties 
are leased, with no further processing involved. Category 
11: Use of Sold Products – The Company leases properties 
rather than selling products that require further use-
phase emissions analysis, Category 13: Downstream 
Leased Assets – we do lease out properties, but they 
remain under our operational control so they are captured 
as part of Scope 1 &2, Category 14: Franchises –  
The business does not operate under a franchise model, 
and Category 15: Investments – Investments outside 
of operational activities are not material to Scope 3 
emissions reporting.
Emissions from Category 3 Fuel and Energy-related 
Activities and Category 1 Purchased Goods & Services 
account for nine per cent and six per cent of the total 
carbon footprint, respectively. The most significant 
Task Force on Climate-related Financial Disclosures (“TCFD”) | continued

Table 9: Carbon Balance Sheet
Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
89
source of Scope 3 emissions is from Category 2 Capital 
Goods. This category accounts for 44 per cent of our 
total carbon footprint. Due to the large proportion of 
emissions attributed to Category 2, it will become the 
primary focus of the emission reduction strategy going 
forward. The refurbishment of properties represents the 
majority of Category 2 spend, so strengthening upstream 
client relationships and working in partnership to reduce 
associated emissions will be our priority. 
Scope 1 emissions account for 16 per cent of total GHG 
emissions. Scope 1 includes direct emissions from 
sources controlled or owned by the reporting Company. 
100 per cent of our Scope 1 emissions are from natural gas 
consumption. Scope 2 (Location-based) emissions are 
also significant, accounting for 19 per cent of total GHG 
emissions. These emissions are predominantly attributed 
to the use of electricity, with 0.1 per cent attributed to the 
use of district heating. 
EPRA sustainability disclosures
The following tables provide a summary of the EPRA 
sustainability performance measures as defined by the 
EPRA Sustainability Best Practice Recommendations. 
These are a set of standard disclosures for the property 
industry designed to drive consistency in reporting.
EPRA Indicator
Page
Diversity-Emp Employee gender diversity
64
Diversity-Pay Gender pay ratio
64
Emp-Training Employee training  
and development
64
Emp-Dev Employee performance 
appraisals
64
Emp-Turnover New hires and turnover
64
H&S-Emp Employee health and safety
60
H&S-Asset Asset health and safety 
assessment
60
H&S-Comp Asset health and safety 
compliance
60
Comty-Eng Community engagement, 
impact assessments and development 
programmes
61
Gov-Board Composition of the highest 
governance body
53
Gov-Selec Process for nominating and 
selecting the highest governance body
53
Gov-COI. Process for managing conflicts  
of interest
53
Emissions Scope & Category
Greenhouse gas emissions inventory
Emissions tCO2e 
%
Scope 1
3,267
15.6%
Natural Gas
3,267
15.6%
Scope 2 (Location-based)
4,039
19.1%
Electricity
4,008
19.1%
Purchased Heat
31
0.1%
Scope 3
13,655
65.1%
1. Purchased Goods & Services
1,266
6.0%
2. Capital Goods
9,195
43.9%
3. Fuel- and Energy-related Activities
1,878
9.0%
4. Upstream Transportation and Distribution
14
0.1%
5. Waste Generated in Operations
886
4.2%
6. Business Travel
90
0.4%
7. Employee Commuting
229
1.4%
8. Upstream Leased Assets
27
0.1%
9. Downstream Transportation and Distribution
N/A
N/A
10. Processing of Sold Products
N/A
N/A
11. Use of Sold Products
N/A
N/A
12. End-of-life Treatment of Sold Products
0.1
0.0004%
13. Downstream Leased Assets
N/A
N/A
14. Franchises
N/A
N/A
15. Investments
N/A
N/A
Total Emissions (Location-based)
20,963
100%
All tCO2e (Location-based) per Bed
2.68

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
90
Energy-Abs, Energy - LfL Energy
Absolute (Total)
Like for like (LFL)
EPRA Indicator
Environmental Performance Measures
2023
2024
% Change
2023
2024
% Change
Elec-Abs Total energy consumption from electricity/
Elec-LFL Like for like total electricity consumption
Total energy consumption  
from electricity (kWh)
19,353,562
18,007,162
-7.0
17,496,466
16,798,323
-4.0
DH&C-Abs Total energy consumption from district 
heating & cooling/DH&C-LFL Like for like total 
district heating & cooling consumption
Total energy consumption  
from district heating &  
cooling (kWh)
602,384
573,000
-4.9
602,384
573,000
-4.9
Fuels-Abs Total energy consumption from fuels/
Fuels-LFL Like for like total fuel consumption
Total energy consumption  
from fuels (kWh)
17,860,825
15,498,346
-13.2
14,912,196
14,400,998
-3.4
Proportion of electricity consumption 
data estimated (%) 
0
19
19
0
19
19
Proportion of district heating  
& cooling consumption data  
estimated (%) 
0
0
0
0
0
0
Proportion of fuels consumption  
data estimated (%) 
0
18
18
0
18
18
Energy-Int Building energy intensity
Building energy intensity (kWh/Bed)
4,166
4,365
4.8
4,481
4,351
-2.9
GHG-Dir-Abs Total direct GHG emissions
Total direct GHG emissions (Scope 1) 
(tCO2e)
3,267
2,835
-13.2
2,728
2,634
-3.4
GHG-Indir-Abs Total indirect GHG emissions
Indirect GHG emissions (Scope 2) 
(tCO2e)
4,039
3,831
-5.1
3,654
3,582
-2.0
Indirect GHG emissions (Scope 3) 
(tCO2e)
13,656
Not 
Calculated
N/A
12,734
Not 
Calculated
N/A
GHG-Int Greenhouse gas intensity from  
building energy
Greenhouse gas intensity from building 
energy (tCO2e/Bed)
0.80
0.85
6.7
0.87
0.85
-2.2
Table 9: Consumption Data 2024
Task Force on Climate-related Financial Disclosures (“TCFD”) | continued

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
91
Water & wastewater management
Water stewardship efforts involved implementing low-
usage water taps and setting specific targets for each site. 
Transportation is environmentally conscious, with a fleet 
of electric vans being renewed and updated during the 
year. These vans provide green transport alternatives to 
our site teams who travel between our properties in the 
largest cities in which we operate. 
As part of our commitment to TCFD compliance, we have 
assessed physical risks that may impact our business, 
including water stress. To better understand our supply 
chain’s vulnerability to climate change, we conducted a 
climate scenario analysis of our supply chain and supply 
routes in 2024. In 2025, we aim to establish a water 
consumption baseline and set a water reduction target 
within the next two years. To mitigate water stress risks, 
our York site employs an independent water collection 
system. Furthermore, we are actively optimising water 
usage through the implementation of low-flow taps and 
efficient water management systems. Our St Mary’s site 
in Bristol serves as an exemplary model, demonstrating 
the lowest water consumption of any known comparable 
living wall system. More information of which can be 
found in our latest ESG Report.
We actively promote recycling within our properties, 
implementing waste segregation practices to ensure 
responsible disposal. By providing bins and educating 
our students, we contribute to a culture of environmental 
consciousness. Waste segregation at select sites 
is managed through collaboration with our waste 
management broker, facilitating efficient recycling 
processes and further enhancing our sustainability 
initiatives. We actively seek student feedback on 
recycling practices and initiatives, such as partnering 
with reputable waste management brokers to ensure 
responsible waste monitoring and disposal. The data 
available from private waste collections significantly 
increased in 2024, allowing for a more accurate 
representation of waste intensity.
In the tables below, during 2024, there was a transition 
to a new water data provider, resulting in a temporary 
decrease in data completeness as site information was 
transferred to the new system. A significant portion of 
private waste collections that were previously sent to 
landfill has been redirected to waste recovery facilities 
this year, with the amount of total waste sent to recovery 
increasing substantially.
Table 10: Waste data 2024
Waste-Abs, Waste - LfL Waste
Absolute (Total)
Like for like (LFL)
EPRA Indicator
Environmental Performance Measures
2023
2024
% Change
2023
2024
% Change
Waste-Abs Proportion of waste by disposal route/
Waste-LFL Proportion of waste by disposal route
Total weight of waste to landfill 
(tonnes)
1623
828
-49.0
1294
669
-48.3
Total weight of recycling waste 
(tonnes) 
822
594
-27.7
637
482
-24.3
Total weight of waste to energy 
recovery facility (ERF) (tonnes) 
121
531
338.8
111
501
351.4
Waste-Abs Total weight of waste by disposal route/
Waste-LFL Total weight of waste by disposal route
Total weight of waste (tonnes)
2566
1953
-23.9
2042
1652
-19.1
Proportion of waste consumption data 
estimated (%) 
N/A
787
N/A
N/A
63
N/A
Waste intensity (tonnes/Bed)
0.28
0.25
-10.7
0.28
0.23
-19.2

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
92
Table 11: Water data 2024
Water-Abs, Water - LfL Water
Absolute (Total)
Like for like (LFL)
EPRA Indicator
Environmental Performance Measures
2023
2024
% Change
2023
2024
% Change
Water-Abs Total water withdrawal by source/ 
Water-LFL Like for like total water consumption
Total water consumption (m3)
294,017
258,004
-12.2
252,418
218,023
-13.6
Proportion of water consumption 
data estimated (%) 
17
44
158.8
14
41
192.9
Water-Int Building water intensity 
Water intensity (m3/Bed)
32.39
33.04
2.0
34.26
29.86
-12.9
Task Force on Climate-related Financial Disclosures (“TCFD”) | continued

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
93
93
Governance 
report
Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Governance report

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Governance report
94
Chairman’s introduction to corporate governance
“The Company is focused on 
growth and this momentum 
is set to continue into 2025, 
with further acquisitions 
anticipated.”
Mark Pain  |  Non-executive Chairman
I am delighted to introduce the Corporate Governance 
section of this year’s Annual Report. This has been an 
exciting year for the Company, with a successful capital 
raise undertaken, our disposal programme completed, 
three well located properties acquired, planning 
applications approved and further refurbishments 
completed. The Company is focused on growth and this 
momentum is set to continue into 2025, with further 
acquisitions anticipated. 
The main focus for the Board this year has been exploring 
routes to growth. Given market conditions, a Joint 
Venture had initially been considered the best way 
to accelerate the roll out of our Postgraduate brand. 
However, with a change in market sentiment in the second 
half of the year, the Board recognised an opportunity 
to raise the equity ourselves and remove the inevitable 
complication a joint venture would bring. With a small 
agile Board, we were able to complete the equity raise 
in a swift, timely and cost-effective manner, successfully 
raising £56.1 million in October. 
Proceeds have been deployed in line with the Company’s 
strategy, focusing on cities where we can exploit the 
benefits of clustering, promoting the long-term success 
of the Company and generating sustainable value for our 
shareholders, with the Company’s performance resulting 
in an improved dividend of 3.7pps, a six per cent increase 
on 2023. 
To ensure we maintain an appropriate strategy, which 
delivers to all stakeholders, we need to have an effective 
Board with the right mix of skills supported by good 
systems and a strong governance structure. 
Corporate Governance Code 
The Board has adhered to the Corporate Governance 
Code 2018 throughout the year. From 1 January 2025, 
the Corporate Governance Code 2024 will apply to the 
Company, and its Committees have already discussed 
the new requirements, reviewing diversity and inclusion, 
culture, and Provision 29 (effective 1 January 2026).  
The terms of reference of the Committees have been 
updated accordingly and are available on the website  
https://www.empiric.co.uk/. Some of the 2024 Code 
additions have been introduced into this Annual Report, 
and the Company will seek to build on these so we are fully 
prepared when all the new provisions come into force. 
Board composition, diversity and inclusion 
There have been no changes to the Board during the year, 
which currently comprises two male executives, and four 
NEDs consisting of two women and two men. The Board 
performance review in 2023 and again in 2024, has shown 
that the Directors consider the Board to operate well 
with the NEDs providing a diverse mix of skills, age and 
experience, constructive challenge to management and 
contribute well to Board meetings. The relatively small  
size allows the Board to be opportunistic, as 
demonstrated by this year’s capital raise, quickly taking 
advantage of the change in market sentiment. However, 
the size of the Board has been prohibitive in addressing 
the diversity targets. 
Diversity on the Board had been the subject of 
correspondence with Shareholders and much discussion 
by the Nomination Committee, which aspires to meet 
the targets set by the Parker and FTSE Women Leaders 
Reviews. To address these targets, there are two options: 
(i) to increase the size of the Board or (ii) replace a 
Director by either removing them or waiting for normal 
rotation and seeking to select the very best candidate 
from a fully diverse list. Given Board performance, we 
do not wish to increase the number of Directors, as 
the current structure works extremely well. But with no 
Directors currently due to retire, we will only be able  
to address the matter of diversity once a Director  
steps down. 
Within the wider Group, we have looked at ways to 
improve diversity. Our Senior Leadership Team currently 
includes no members of ethnic origin, so the Company 
has sought to reach a 10 per cent ethnicity target by 2027 
and has partnered with DIAL Global, Business Disability 
Forum, Stonewall and Inspiring Diversity in Real Estate in 
order to achieve this. We are making progress, but with 
high retention rates, and a policy to promote talent from 
within, this will take time.

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Governance report
95
Culture
The boardroom culture is good natured and constructive. 
The Chairman and the Chief Executive Officer set a tone of 
openness and thoroughness, which is upheld by the Board 
with Directors holding themselves to high standards 
of integrity. The Chairman encourages debate and the 
views from all of the Directors to generate stimulating 
conversations concerning the Company’s operations. 
The culture of openness is promoted throughout the 
Group by the CEO, who is always keen to improve 
communication and make employees feel valued. With the 
Company celebrating its tenth anniversary this year, over 
240 team members joined events in London, Birmingham 
and Edinburgh to hear from the Executive team, and to 
work collaboratively to complete certain challenges. 
Feedback hailed the event a great success, enjoyed by 
all the attendees. In addition, the CEO holds quarterly 
meetings with the entire workforce to communicate the 
financial results and the progress against key performance 
indicators. The meetings are always well attended and 
offer the chance for employees to ask the CEO questions 
directly regarding all aspects of the Company. 
In preparation for reporting against the Corporate 
Governance Code 2024, the Nomination Committee has 
set the KPIs on page 28 to embed and monitor culture in 
the Group. Progress on these will be shared in the Annual 
Report going forward. 
Establishing a strategy for long term success
The annual strategy day was held in June, attended by all 
the Directors and members of the executive team.  
The meeting was carefully structured to achieve a balance 
between presentation, debate and discussion.
With a general election imminent, advisors were invited 
to present on the potential policy changes from the 
anticipated new Labour government and how these could 
affect the Company, the universities, the Company’s 
target market and the property portfolio. There was a 
focus structured towards providing in-depth analysis and 
diligence on the UK’s post-graduate market, including 
those universities that had the strongest fundamentals 
for post-graduates and identifying their priorities when 
selecting accommodation. 
In light of the political backdrop, executive Directors and 
the non-executive Directors reviewed the strengths and 
weaknesses of the Company’s current corporate strategy 
to ensure that the Company’s strategy to invest in areas of 
growth remained appropriate and to consider emerging 
opportunities. During the year the Company exited from 
four cities and now has 97 per cent of its portfolio aligned 
to prime and super prime locations. 
Engaging with stakeholders
The executive Directors and the Board as a whole make 
themselves available at various points during the year to 
provide a forum to understand the views of the Company’s 
key shareholders and ensure these are taken into account 
in strategic discussion and decision-making. Road shows 
were undertaken after the publication of both annual 
and interim results, property tours were conducted in 
Edinburgh, Glasgow & Bristol and management attended 
the corporate access days hosted by EPRA and Peel Hunt 
in June. 
The Board’s approach to corporate governance is also 
determined by, and takes account of, the interests of 
various other stakeholders, not least of all our customers, 
our people and the communities in which we operate. 
Surveys are sent to employees and customers, with 
appropriate actions taken to address any concerns 
expressed. Site visits were undertaken by the Board in 
York and Southampton during 2024, where Directors 
could meet employees and customers, and regular 
updates were provided from the property, operations and 
marketing departments to keep Directors up to date with 
developments and views from a wide stakeholder base. 
It was also decided, as part of our commitment to 
achieving Net Zero by 2033, to put our 2024 and 2025 
ESG targets to an advisory shareholder vote at our Annual 
General Meeting in May 2024. Although the resolution 
was passed, the result was somewhat disappointing, with 
25 per cent of responding shareholders voting against. 
In order to better understand the result, and inform 
future decision making, we sought engagement with 
shareholders. From those shareholders that provided 
feedback, it appeared in part that they required a clearer 
articulation between the cost and return that could be 
expected for each target. This will be addressed when 
next put to shareholders in 2026.
Further details of stakeholder engagement can be found 
on page 61.
Looking forward
The Company faces a number of challenges in 2025, 
many of which are outside of its control. Higher costs 
in National Insurance, a further material increase in 
minimum wage and ongoing energy price inflation 
present cost challenges for the business. But with the 
number of students increasing and the attractiveness 
of the UK’s top-quality universities continuing to appeal 
both internationally and domestically, there remains a 
positive outlook for the mid to long term future, with many 
opportunities open to PBSAs to grow their market share 
which we too will continue to pursue. 
Annual General Meeting 
The Board looks forward to welcoming you to the 
Annual General Meeting to be held on 4 June 2025 and 
recommends that you vote in favour of the proposed 
resolutions. 
All Directors intend to stand for re-election and their 
biographies are set out in the notice of meeting in the 
separate document accompanying this report. If you  
are unable to attend, but would like to ask your Board  
a question, please send your message to  
CoSec@Empiric.co.uk. 
Finally, on behalf of the Board I would like to thank the 
whole team for their hard work and dedication and our 
shareholders who have supported us throughout the year.
Mark Pain  |  Non-executive Chairman 
12 March 2025

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Governance report
96
Section 172(1) statement
The Board openly accepts its obligation to operate as a good corporate citizen and recognises that broader stakeholder recognition is integral to the long-term success of the 
Company. For the year under review, the Board has had due regard for the following:
Section 172 requirements
Disclosures
The likely 
consequences of any 
decision in the long 
term
The Board oversees the Company’s performance and gives guidance as to the long-term strategy of the Company. The day-to-day management and decision-
making is delegated by the Board to the Executive Committee which provides regular updates to the Board. This allows the Board to monitor the performance 
of the Company and ensure that the Company is progressing in line with the long-term strategy. The KPls reported on page 28 are the key metrics which the 
Board reviews, which are supplemented by further detailed reporting.
Also see details surrounding stakeholder engagement on page 61 and Board activities and principal decisions taken as set out on page 106.
The interests of 
the Company’s 
employees
Our people are crucial to the Company’s success; they provide our customers with exceptional service to ensure they feel at home.  
The Board recognises the relationship between employee happiness and customer satisfaction and has sought to monitor these through the eNPS and 
NPS scores, which are derived from surveys undertaken during the year. The wellbeing of our staff is paramount and as such all decisions taken by the Board 
consider the interests of the Group’s employees. The Company’s activities surrounding mental health & wellbeing are discussed on page 26.
The Board has designated Alice Avis (Senior Independent non-executive Director) to liaise with the One Team Collective as a representative body of our 
workforce. This allows a direct conduit between the Board and our people. This gives the Board insight into the views and concerns of our people and allows 
them to ensure their decisions are aligned with the interests of the Group’s employees. 
The CEO also holds quarterly meetings with the entire workforce to communicate the financial results and the progress against key performance indicators 
Should employees have a concern, this can be raised through a number of routes, directly with their manager or via the whistleblowing or grievance policy. 
The need to foster 
the Company’s 
business 
relationships with 
suppliers, customers 
and others
The Company has a few key suppliers and the Board reviews and approves any key contracts. As such the Board provides oversight and challenge to key 
suppliers. In order to assess the compliance of our supply chain, all of our key operational suppliers and contractors are SafeContractor accredited as part of 
the onboarding process. This scheme verifies that these contractors and suppliers have the required QHSE policies in place and meet the requirements of a UK 
leading SSIP standard. Day-to-day relationships with Company suppliers are delegated to the Senior Leadership Team to ensure a close relationship is fostered.
Without customers the Company could not exist, and as such the Board takes great interest in fostering relationships with customers. The Board reviews the 
results of the biannual customer survey, as well as receiving and reviewing other ad hoc reports on our customers’ preferences and wishes. The Board believes 
that fostering a close relationship and a deep understanding of our customers is key to the Company’s success and should be part of the Company’s culture. For 
this reason it has chosen to include the NPS score in its culture KPIs, indicating the level of customer satisfaction and providing a view on the customer journey.
Further information on the Company’s culture can be found on page 101 and details surrounding stakeholder engagement on page 61.
The impact of 
the Company’s 
operations on the 
community and the 
environment
The community and environment in which the Company operates is a key priority for the Board. The Board takes the impact of the Group’s operations on the 
community and environment into account in each decision. The decisions which the Board take can have widespread ramifications. Reviewing this impact is 
not a perfunctory exercise but one which the Board believes is a key responsibility, which includes robust challenge of all decisions. The decision has been 
taken this year to take part in the CDP ESG benchmarking platform with reporting to commence in 2026. 
The desirability of the 
Company maintaining 
a reputation for high 
standards of business 
conduct
The Board recognises the importance of maintaining a reputation for high standards of business conduct. The Board always seeks to make the best decision 
for the Company which, while taking into account the needs of all of our stakeholders, also reflects morally on our obligations as a Company.
The Board encourages this principle throughout the business through its policies and compulsory training, which support the Company’s purpose and values.
The need to act fairly 
between members  
of the Company
The Board believes transparency and accountability of the business is paramount to encourage shareholder confidence. The Board listens to and reviews the 
views across our shareholder base and encourages shareholders to attend the AGM. The need to act fairly between all of our shareholders underpins the Board’s 
decisions and the Board receives regular feedback from shareholders after our annual and interim results release. The Board also receives feedback from research 
analysts throughout the year which helps the Board identify key shareholder trends. The capital structure of the Company as a REIT, limits individual shareholdings 
to a maximum of 10 per cent of issued share capital and helps to ensure there are no dominant shareholders and all are treated equally.

Application of the Principles of the UK 
Corporate Governance Code 2018 can  
be found on the following pages
Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Governance report
97
Board compliance statements 
Diversity and Inclusion
In accordance with UKLR6.6.6R (9) the Company can 
confirm that as at 31 December 2024:
1.	
the Company has two women on the Board, equating 
to 33.3% representation; 
2.	 Alice Avis holds the position of Senior Independent 
Director, and is also the employee’s representative on 
the Board; and 
3.	 no Board Directors are from an ethnic background. 
Furthermore, pursuant to the Parker Review, as no 
members of the senior Leadership Team are currently from 
an ethnic background, a target 10 per cent ethnicity has 
been set to be achieved by the end of 2027. 
Further information can be found on page 114.
Compliance with UK Corporate Governance Code 2018
During the financial year the Company has complied with 
the Principles of the UK Corporate Governance Code 2018 
published by the Financial Reporting Council (“FRC”), a 
copy of which can be found on their website www.frc.org.
uk. The application and reporting on the Code’s Principles, 
and the supporting provisions, are set out in the table 
opposite. 
Going Concern
The Group is well placed to manage its financing and 
other business risks. The Board is therefore of the opinion 
that it is appropriate to adopt the going concern basis of 
accounting in preparing the Annual Report and Accounts 
(see page 159 for more information). 
Viability Statement
Taking into account the Group’s current position and the 
impact of the principal risks documented in the Strategic 
Report, the Directors have a reasonable expectation that 
the Company will remain viable and continue to operate 
and meet its liabilities as they fall due, over the period 
to 31 December 2027. Further details are set out in the 
Viability Statement on page 43, and in the Principal Risks 
and Uncertainties section on page 38. 
Principal Risks and Uncertainties
The Directors have carried out a robust assessment of the 
principal risks facing the Company, including those that 
would threaten its business model, future performance, 
solvency or liquidity. The principal risks, and the 
procedures for managing or mitigating them, are set out 
on pages 38 to 42. 
Audit, risk and internal control
Grant Thornton LLP was appointed as the Internal 
Auditor in 2023. Internal controls include the systems 
of operational and compliance controls maintained by 
our finance team. Regular reports from both the Internal 
Auditor and management are provided and reviewed by 
the Boards Audit and Risk Committee and reported on to 
the Board. Further details can be found in their report on 
pages 118 to 122.
Fair, Balanced and Understandable 
The Annual Report and Accounts, taken as a whole, is 
fair, balanced and understandable and provides the 
information necessary for shareholders to assess the 
Group’s position, performance, prospects, business 
model and strategy.
1. Board Leadership and Company Purpose
Page
A	 Effective Board
98 & 112
B 	 Purpose, Values and Culture
101
C 	 Governance Framework
102
D 	 Stakeholder Engagement
61
E 	 Workforce policies and practices
64 & 65
2. Division of Responsibilities 
Page
F 	 Board roles and operations 
103 & 104
G 	Independence
111
H 	External Appointments and 
Conflicts of Interests
98 & 111
 I 	 Key Activities of the Board in 2024
105
3. Composition, succession and evaluation 
Page
J 	 Appointment and Succession
111
K 	 Board Skills, experience  
and knowledge
98–100
L 	 Annual Board Evaluation 
112
4. Audit, Risk and Internal Control
Page
M 	Financial Reporting, External 
Auditor and Internal Audit
118–122
N 	Review of 2024 Annual Report  
and Accounts
122
O Internal Financial controls and  
Risk Management
120
5. Remuneration 
Page
P 	 Linking Remuneration with  
purpose and strategy
127
Q 	Remuneration Policy
127
R 	 Performance outcome in 2024 
131

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Governance report
98
Board of directors 
  Mark Pain
  Duncan Garrood
  Donald Grant
  Non-executive Chairman
  Chief Executive Officer
  Chief Financial and Sustainability Officer
Appointed
1 September 2018
28 September 2020
12 September 2022
Independent
Yes
No
No
Committee  
Memberships
N  
E  
R
E
E
Relevant Skills  
and Experience
	î Chartered accountant
	î Strong financial, customer and shareholder focus
	î Extensive experience of executive and  
non-executive roles in the real estate, financial 
services and consumer/leisure sectors
	î Strong operational, sales and marketing skills
	î Extensive experience of executive roles in the 
consumer/leisure sectors
	î Significant expertise in the consumer/leisure 
sectors
	î Chartered accountant
	î Over 20 years’ experience in the listed real estate  
and financial services sectors, covering finance,  
tax, regulatory compliance, HR, IT and  
company secretarial
Principal External 
Appointments
	î Chairman – AXA UK plc
	î Senior Independent Director  
– Close Brothers Group plc
	î Non-executive Director  
– The Brighton Pier Group PLC
	î None
Significant  
Previous External  
Experience
	î Group Finance Director – Abbey National PLC
	î Group Finance Director – Barratt Developments PLC
	î Non-executive Directorships – Ladbroke Coral 
Group PLC, Aviva Insurance Limited, Spirit Pub 
Group PLC, Johnston Press PLC, Northern Rock,  
LSL Property Services and Punch Taverns PLC 
	î Vice Chairman and Senior Independent Director  
– Yorkshire Building Society
	î CEO – Ten Entertainment Group Plc
	î CEO – Bills Restaurants
	î CEO – Punch Taverns plc
	î President – M.H. Alshaya
	î Commercial Director – BAA plc
	î Chief Financial Officer – RDI REIT P.L.C
	î Group Financial Controller  
– Capital & Counties Properties PLC
	î Head of Finance – Liberty International PLC
	î Head of Financial & Regulatory Control (EMEA) 
– BCG Partners / Cantor Fitzgerald
Committees
N  Nomination
A  Audit and Risk
R  Remuneration
E  ESG
 Chair

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Governance report
99
R  
N  
E  
A
  Alice Avis MBE
  Martin Ratchford
  Clair Preston-Beer
  Senior Independent non‑executive Director
  Non-executive Director
  Non‑executive Director
1 March 2019
1 October 2021
1 July 2022
Yes
Yes
Yes
 A  
R  
N  
E  
A  
R  
N  
E  
A  
R  
N  
E
	î Extensive experience in marketing, e-commerce, 
strategy and operations in the consumer  
goods/retail sectors 
	î Executive and non-executive expertise in FTSE 100/
UK and international entrepreneurial organisations
	î Chartered accountant
	î Over 20 years’ experience in executive and 
leadership roles in the UK/international listed real 
estate, funds and student accommodation sectors
	î Expertise in structured real estate debt and equity 
financing and systems and control environments
	î Significant expertise in large hospitality/ 
retail businesses
	î Extensive experience in international franchising/
business transformation
	î Non-executive Director – BGF Group plc
	î Non-executive Director – iPulse Limited
	î Director – Knoops Holdings Limited
	î Chief Finance Officer at Frasers Property (UK) 
Limited, a Frasers Property group company
	î Chief Operating Officer – Greene King Limited
	î Executive chairman – Lumene Oy 
	î CEO – Sanctuary Spa Group
	î Marketing and E-Commerce Director  
– Marks and Spencer PLC
	î Global brand Director, Johnnie Walker – Diageo PLC
	î Non-executive Director – The Edrington Group 
Limited
	î 	Finance Director, Real Estate and Funds  
– Thomas Cook plc
	î 	Head of Europe, Finance – British Land PLC
	î 	Finance Director – The Unite Group PLC
	î 	Managing Director – Costa Coffee,  
Middle East & Asia
	î Chief Operating Officer – Costa Coffee, UK
	î Franchise Director – Costa Coffee, UK

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Governance report
100
Board overview 
Board Attendance
AGM (1)
Scheduled Board 
meetings, update calls 
and strategy day (8)
Ad Hoc Board and 
Committee Meetings
(meetings eligible to attend 
 in brackets) 
Director 
Attendance
100%
100%
98%
Mark Pain
1
8
8 (8) 
Duncan Garrood
1
8
21 (21)
Donald Grant
1
8
21(21)
Alice Avis*
1
8
4* (5)
Martin Ratchford
1
8
5 (5)
Clair Preston-Beer 
1
8
5 (5) 
*	
Alice Avis was unable to attend an ad hoc Board meeting due to holiday commitments. 
She however reviewed the papers in advance and passed on her comments and 
questions to the Chairman. 
Board Attendance
Main Focus for the year
£45.2m
Disposals
£35.0m
Acquisitions
£56.1m
Capital raise
3.7p
Dividends
Industry (PBSA) knowledge
Technology/digital media expertise
Cyber/Data experience 
Risk management expertise
Financial expertise/ literacy
Banking/private equity/venture capital
Marketing expertise
Legal expertise
Cross-border expertise
Human resources expertise
Property expertise
Hospitality and customer service expertise
Operational expertise
Sustainability
Regulatory expertise
 Male   
 Female 
Board Composition
67%
33%
 Independent   
 Executive 
Board Independence
67%
33%
 <3yrs   
 <4yrs   
 <5yrs 
 <6yrs   
 <7yrs
Board Tenure
2
1
1
1
1
 40-50   
 50-60  
 60-65   
 65+
Board Ages
2
2
1
1
Skills Matrix
83%
100%
50%
100%
100%
67%
67%
0%
100%
100%
67%
83%
100%
100%
100%
Results of Internal Board Evaluation (More information on page 112)
Performance during 2024
Composition of the Board
Meetings and Board Packs
Board Objectives 
Strategy and Strategic Foresight
Decision Process
100%
87%
90%
81%
87%
78%
 Male roles – Chair, CEO, CFSO
 Female roles – SID and employee 
representative
Board roles
60%
40%

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Governance report
101
Our Purpose, Strategy, Values and Culture
Embedding and monitoring culture are critical for 
ensuring alignment across the organisation and 
supporting the delivery of the organisation’s purpose  
and strategy and our ways of working are underpinned  
by our values.
Purpose: To help students make the most of their 
university life by creating and managing some of 
the highest quality and most thoughtfully designed 
accommodation, which is secure, modern and homely. 
Our refurbishment programme continued during 2024, 
and further works are planned for 2025/26 to upgrade 
current rooms on offer. 
Strategy: In order to achieve our Purpose, we aim to grow 
a portfolio of high-quality buildings in top-tier University 
locations where student accommodation remains acutely 
undersupplied. Acquisitions this year have been made in 
Bristol, Glasgow and Manchester.
Values: Our values (“Respectful”, “Supportive”, 
“Collaborative”, “Responsive” and “Fun”) are key to 
delivering the brand experience for our customers.  
As an employer, our goal is to create a “great place to 
work” where our people can grow and excel. 
Culture: Our people are key to delivering a high quality, 
personalised service to our customers. We work tirelessly 
to create a team who are diverse and inclusive, agile, 
proactive, thoughtful and responsive. The culture in 
the Group is largely driven by the CEO and, as part of 
his short-term remuneration targets, he has been set 
an objective to develop workplace engagement and 
culture, which relates to the results for the employee 
survey, internal promotions and community and charity 
initiatives. Details of these targets are set out on  
page 133. In order to further understand how our culture 
is being embedded across the organisation, the Board 
reviewed a number of metrics that could be used to 
measure and monitor culture within the Group.  
The following metrics were considered the most 
appropriate for our business. 
Employee net promoter score (eNPS): To deliver a high-quality service to 
our customers, we must look after our employees. The eNPS and NPS scores were 
therefore considered the most appropriate method of measuring our culture. 
The eNPS score is derived from the employee survey undertaken during the year. 
This provided the level of happiness and satisfaction of our employees, and the 
likelihood of them staying and promoting our Company to others. Recent research 
found that, companies with a highly engaged workforce are 21 per cent more 
profitable and 17 per cent more productive than those with disengaged peers. 
+44
UK Median eNPS Score (+7)
Net Promoter Score (NPS): is regarded as the gold standard of measuring  
and tracking how a company is perceived by their customers and provides 
a snapshot of overall customer experience; indicating the level of customer 
satisfaction and a positive customer journey. This KPI therefore helps us not only 
monitor culture but how we are fulfilling our purpose and maintaining our values. 
The Board believes that a happy workforce will lead to a better experience for  
our customers and therefore the eNPS and NPS should be correlated. 
+32
All Private Halls (+19)
Female Representation and Ethnic Diversity  
in Senior Leadership Team:  
The Company wishes to improve its culture by promoting a diverse and  
inclusive culture. A number of initiatives are currently being undertaken  
to increase diversity, and these metrics will allow the Company to monitor  
its progress. 
Female Representation
32%
Target: 50%
Leadership Ethnic Diversity 
0%
Target: 10%
Internal progression: We value our people and work hard to retain,  
train and promote people from within the Company. We currently  
have a retention score of 78 per cent.
61%
Target: +55%
Training: The Company’s policies are all available via an intranet portal and 
employees must confirm that they have read and understood these documents.  
To complement and embed these policies, training must be undertaken by all  
the staff during their probationary period and on an annual basis thereafter.  
Training covers such matters as health and safety, diversity and inclusion,  
duty to prevent sexual harassment and a range of compliance matters. 
98%
Target: 100%

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Governance report
102
Corporate governance framework 
The Board
The Board is responsible for the long-term success of the Company
To assist in the effectiveness of the Board, committees have been established which operate within terms of reference set by the Board.
These outline their role to review appropriate matters and make recommendations back to the Board.
The terms of reference are reviewed every two years, or as necessary, and are available on our website. 
Senior Leadership Team (“SLT”)
Reporting directly to the Executive Committee, the SLT ensure that Company policies  
are embedded into the business and its operations and that strategic decisions are executed appropriately.
The Senior Leadership Team comprises 25 members, excluding the Executive Committee and meet four times a year  
with the Executive Committee to share information and raise and discuss issues within the Group. 
ESG Working Group
Chaired by the CFSO, invited members of the senior leadership team meet 
monthly and ensure the ESG strategy is embedded throughout the business. 
The Group comprises representatives from Operations, Property, Finance, 
People team, Facilities Management, and Sales and Marketing. 
One Team Collective (“OTC”) 
Attended by Alice Avis, Chaired by a member of the Senior Leadership Team, 
and comprising representatives from each UK region of the business, the 
OTC meets on a quarterly basis. They discuss matters that have been raised 
by their ‘constituents’ and bring issues to the attention of the SLT.
Executive Committee
The Board leads and provides direction for the Executive Committee, by setting our Company strategy and objectives  
and overseeing the implementation of key operational policies throughout the business.
Day-to-day operations are carried out by the Executive Committee, who must adhere to policies and authorities set by the Board. 
The Executive Committee comprises the CEO, CFSO, Chief Investment Officer, Chief Operating Officer and Chief Customer Officer.
Nomination Committee
Considers the composition, 
skills, diversity and succession 
planning of the Board and 
evaluates its effectiveness.  
Audit and Risk Committee
Ensures the Group’s financial 
reporting and risk management 
is properly monitored, 
controlled and reported.
Remuneration Committee
Reviews remuneration of 
the executives and senior 
leadership team in accordance 
with shareholder approved 
policy.
ESG Committee
Safegaurds the interests of,  
and monitors engagement with, 
stakeholders to ensure the 
Company demonstrates sound 
social and environmental risk 
management.
Read more on | page 110
Read more on | page 118
Read more on | page 123
Read more on | page 116

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Governance report
103
Roles and responsibilities 
The Board comprises the Chairman, two executive Directors and three non-executive Directors, supported by the Company Secretary. The Directors biographies are set out  
on page 98.
There is a clear division of responsibilities between the Chairman and Chief Executive Officer. Their roles are clearly set out and agreed by the Board. The primary responsibilities of 
the Directors are as follows:
Board position
Primary Responsibilities
Chairman
•	 Leading the Board, ensuring its effectiveness and that Board members actively engage, challenge and contribute to discussions. 
•	 Upholding the highest standards of integrity and Corporate Governance; 
•	 Reviewing the Company’s general progress and long-term sustainability; and 
•	 Ensuring the Company is meeting its responsibilities to all stakeholders. 
Senior Independent non-executive 
Director and employee representative 
Director 
•	 Acting as a sounding board for the Chairman and intermediary for other Directors when required; 
•	 Leading the evaluation of the Chairman on behalf of the other Directors; and 
•	 Being available to shareholders to raise their concerns if they cannot be resolved through other channels. 
•	 To engage and understand the views of the workforce through the One Team Collective 
Non-executive Directors
•	 Providing constructive challenge and independent oversight; 
•	 Determining the appropriate levels of remuneration of executives; 
•	 Overseeing the Senior Leadership Team’s progress on implementing strategy and meeting objectives; and 
•	 Monitoring the reporting of performance. 
Chief Executive Officer
•	 Leading and developing the Company’s strategy, profitable operation and development; 
•	 Overseeing all activities of the business and leading the sales, marketing and operations functions; 
•	 Developing workplace engagement and culture
•	 Ensuring the objectives are in line with operational activities; and 
•	 Creating shareholder value over the long term. 
Chief Financial and Sustainability Officer
•	 Overseeing sustainability across the business; 
•	 Leading the finance and IT functions; 
•	 Producing timely and accurate financial information and analysis; 
•	 Raising and managing debt; 
•	 Ensuring tax and regulatory compliance; and 
•	 Maintaining financial control and managing the Company’s risk profile. 

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Governance report
104
Board meetings
Day-to-day management and decision-making is 
delegated to the Executive Committee which report on 
their activities to the Directors at the Board meetings and 
calls. KPIs are provided to enable the Directors to easily 
identify where targets have been met, or where there are 
areas of underperformance. This allows the independent 
non-executive Directors to ensure that the Company 
is progressing in line with the long-term strategy, hold 
management to account, but also provide guidance  
and advice. 
Board meeting schedule
The 2024 Board schedule included four Board meetings, 
each aligned to the Company’s financial calendar and 
a strategy day held in June, attended by advisers and 
management, to scrutinise the current strategy and 
to ensure that it remained appropriate. Three update 
calls were scheduled between Board meetings to keep 
Directors abreast of operational matters and to prevent 
Directors becoming overloaded with information.
There was 100% attendance by Directors of all scheduled 
Board meetings, Board calls and the strategy day in 2024. 
Details can be found on page 100.
Additional Board meetings were called on short notice 
to approve or discuss such matters as re-financing, the 
joint venture or the capital raise. Committees of the Board 
were appointed to approve any final details or to approve 
certain matters, such as SAYE share issues, in accordance 
with the delegated authority. 
At least once a year, the non-executives hold informal 
meetings without the executives present.
Board operations
Board meetings operate under a formal quarterly calendar 
to ensure that the Company’s strategy, objectives, risks, 
operations, controls and policies are all addressed or 
reviewed by the Board throughout the year. 
The agenda for the scheduled meetings and calls is 
typically agreed by the Chairman, with assistance from  
the Company Secretary and executive Directors.  
The agenda, along with the Board papers, is usually sent a 
week in advance allowing sufficient time for the Directors 
to digest and consider the content, thereby enabling 
discussion and effective decision making within meetings. 
Any decisions and actions arising from the meetings 
are recorded and actioned by the executive Directors 
with progress monitored by the Company Secretary. 
Management and advisers may be invited to attend 
meetings to provide further information or guidance 
on specific matters. PWC advised on the joint venture 
negotiations, and our brokers and lawyers advised on the 
capital raise in October. 
Meetings are minuted, with discussions, challenges and 
concerns recorded to demonstrate due consideration has 
been given by the Directors on each matter discussed.
Quarterly Board agenda items
The formal agenda for regular Board meetings includes, 
amongst other matters:
	î sales and marketing activities, including  
pricing strategy
	î Health and Safety, and insurance claims
	î Operational risk 
	î Wellbeing of customers and employees
	î People team report
	î Operations
	î review of the Property portfolio – sales, acquisitions, 
capital expenditure, refurbishments 
	î macro and sectorial update;
	î an assessment of our progress with new investment 
opportunities (the detailed proposals are prepared by 
the executive Directors and reviewed and approved by 
the Board, as appropriate); 
	î consideration of strategy and strategic opportunities; 
	î review of financial performance, financial and liquidity 
forecasts, debt management and IT; 
	î an update on investor relations and shareholder 
analysis; 
	î a report on shareholder feedback and engagement; 
	î reports from the Committees; 
	î updates on regulatory, compliance or governance 
matters advised by the Company Secretary or other 
advisers; and 
	î a report on public relations and press commentary. 
Corporate governance framework | continued

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Governance report
105
Month
Board activity
February 
• Remuneration Committee considers the outcome of the 
Executives’ Remuneration and reviews Senior Leadership 
Team rewards
• Acquisition of College House Bristol for £5.6m
• SID attends employee action group: One Team Collective
March
• Aareal £124.9m Refinance
• Review of prospective joint venture partners
• 2023 Full Year Results announced
• 2023 Q4 Dividend of 0.9375 pence per ordinary share
• Road shows undertaken with over 45 investor meetings held
• Remuneration Chair contacts major shareholders and proxy 
agencies to discuss Remuneration in advance of the AGM
April
• Road shows continue
• New Company Secretary appointed
May
• Trading Update published
• Correspondence with proxy agencies regarding the AGM 
resolutions
• Annual General Meeting including approval of ESG targets for 
next two years. 
• SID attends employee action group: One Team Collective 
June
• Board Strategy Day
• Board visit sites in York 
• 2024 Q1 Dividend of 0.875 pence per ordinary share
• EPRA Investor Day 
• Peel Hunt Conference 
• Bristol and Glasgow property tours with selected shareholders 
and analysts
Month
Board activity
July
• Acquisition of Claremont House, Glasgow for £9.7m
August
• 2024 Interim Results announced 
• Road show undertaken with over 40 investor meetings held
• SID attends employee action group: One Team Collective
• Review of students feedback from GSLI survey 
September
• 2024 Q2 Dividend of 0.875 pence per ordinary share
• Road show continued
October 
• Joint venture discussions terminated
• Wall crossing meetings with major shareholders 
• Capital raise completed, raising £56.1m 
November
• SID attends employee action group: One Team Collective
December 
• Board site visit to newly refurbished Brunswick Apartments, 
Southampton
• Acquisition of Tatton House, Manchester for £19.75m
• Remuneration Committee review Executive objectives for 2025
• 2024 Q3 Dividend 0.875 pence per ordinary share
• Cushman & Wakefield appointed as Valuer
• Company policies reviewed 
• Review of Employee survey results
2024 Board activity

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Governance report
106
Board decision making
A formal schedule of “Matters Reserved for the Board” provides clarity as to which matters must be considered and approved by the Board and cannot be undertaken by management. 
These include strategy setting, budget approval, investment transactions over £10 million, and raising new capital. In reaching decisions, the Board must consider the balance of 
interests between shareholder, employees, customers and wider stakeholders. 
A delegated authority policy, approved by the Board, allows executives and senior staff to approve certain matters, within specified limits, such as issuing shares for SAYE share plans. 
To ensure conflicts are avoided, Directors are asked to disclose their interests before each meeting. The Articles of Association permit a Director who has disclosed an interest in a 
transaction to vote and count in the quorum in relation to any resolution of the Board concerning the related transaction, subject to certain conditions and providing that the Board 
so approves.
Principal Decisions  
taken by the Board  
in 2024 
Termination of Joint Venture 
Capital raise of £56.1m 
Acquisition of Claremont House, Glasgow and  
Tatton House, Manchester
Link to Strategy
The Group could pursue its postgraduate 
accommodation refurbishments independently  
and in line with the Company's business plan.
Provided the Group with additional funds to invest 
and accelerate growth.
Located close to Russell Group Universities.
Clustered within short walking distance of other  
ESP properties. 
Long term success 
of the Company
Discussions were terminated as the timing of 
implementation was placing wider strategic plans  
at risk. 
Change in market sentiment presented opportunity 
to pursue an independent path.
Providing investors with stable and long-term 
returns driven by increasing scale and trading 
margins in cities serving top-tier universities. 
The acquisition of well-priced, near-term investment 
opportunities, as well as the unlocking of potential 
refurbishment gains, are expected to be earnings 
accretive within the calendar year 2025.
Greater scale in key cities and improved quality 
of accommodation within the Group’s existing 
portfolio, enhancing the strength of the Group’s 
operating brand.
Shareholders
The associated disruption to the Group’s business 
plans was not considered to be in the best interest  
of the Company’s shareholders.
Increased market capitalisation should make  
the Company more attractive to a wider base  
of investors and improve market liquidity in  
ordinary shares.
The planned acquisitions and refurbishments  
works will enhance shareholder returns and  
therefore be accretive to EPRA NTA per share  
over the medium term.
Provide the Group with valuable economies of scale, 
both on a local level by growing clusters in key cities 
which will help to increase operational margins, 
but also at the corporate level where the existing 
structure is capable of supporting a growing  
asset base.
Customers
The capital raise allowed shareholders to capture 
the full benefit of projected returns in a more timely 
manner with refurbishment plans completed earlier 
than would be anticipated.
The Company has identified approximately £10 
million of refurbishment works at three properties 
that can commence in early 2025.
Clustering allows the Group to share amenities 
across properties offering the customer a wider 
choice of facilities.
Employees 
Certain employees had been secured in anticipation 
of the joint venture causing decisions to be revisited 
with related communication and engagement.
Deployment will grow the operational base of the 
company, providing greater opportunity for current 
and prospective new employees.
Grows the operational base of the Company, 
providing greater opportunity for current and 
prospective new employees.
Corporate governance framework | continued

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Governance report
107
Other Board activities and stakeholder impact
Strategic topic
Area of focus
Key decisions taken and key stakeholders impact
Customer
Ensure the continued safety, wellbeing and 
satisfaction of our customers;
2024 Global Student Living results and customer 
feedback.
NPS score
Decision taken
Refurbishment and EWS programme, related timing and impact on customers.
Internal Auditor review of Health & Safety practices.
Upgrade of IT services. 
Mental Health First Aid programme rolled out. 
Stakeholder impact considerations
Customers: Communication plan and tenancy length. 
Consideration of feedback received, overall satisfaction and available support.
Lenders: The impact on covenants and income security offered.
Shareholders: The speed of implementation and potential impact on revenues and distributions.
Employees: Redeployment of our people to ensure they remain motivated and engaged.
People
Engagement survey and eNPS score
Improve employee retention through  
inhouse training. 
Protection of information and data
Diversity and Inclusion 
Decisions taken
2024 eNPS engagement survey providing feedback and points to be addressed.
Launch of Hello Future Stars apprenticeship scheme. 
Internal Auditor review of GDPR. 
Appointment of partners to assist with diversity improvements.
Stakeholder impact considerations
Employees: Ensuring our people feel valued and addressing any issues quickly.  
Encouraging internal progression. 
Customers: Quality and continuity of service.
Shareholders: Impact on returns and distributions.

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Governance report
108
Strategic topic
Area of focus
Key decisions taken and key stakeholders impact
Strategy
Residual non-core disposal programme, including 
consideration of offers received.
Acquisitions and refurbishments.
Validation of Post-Graduate strategy including 
related due diligence and financial modelling.
Decisions taken
£45.2m disposal of non-core assets in 2024.
Acquisition of College House, Bristol, Claremont House, Glasgow and Tatton House in Manchester. 
Approval of refurbishment programmes. 
Planning permission at Victoria Point, Manchester.
Stakeholder impact considerations
Shareholders: Growth and total return enhancement, coupled with a compelling equity story. 
Customers: Communication and continuity of service provision, improving amenities on offer. 
Community: Developmental impacts; engagement with local residents.
Employees: TUPE transfer considerations, communication and engagement.
Capital allocation
Refinancing and capital allocation to ensure ongoing 
liquidity and covenant headroom.
Investor engagement.
Deployment of funds raised.
Decisions taken
Consolidation of debt facilities and refinancing short dated facilities.
Capital raise of £56.1m. 
Dividend payments. 
Stakeholder impact considerations
Lenders: Maintaining prudent covenant compliance and management of refinancing risk.
Shareholders: Ensuring appropriate deployment of funds in line with expectations.
Agents/consultants: Long-term liquidity planning providing for prompt and fair payment terms.
Other Board activities and stakeholder impact continued
Corporate governance framework | continued

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Governance report
109
Strategic topic
Area of focus
Key decisions taken and key stakeholders impact
Marketing  
and sales
Review of pricing approach for launch of academic 
year 2025/26.
In-depth review of customer feedback.
Decision taken
Pricing strategy approved with the aim of achieving balance between inflationary pressure and 
affordability, informed by lessons learnt from previous years data and customer feedback.
Upgrade of customer website improving interface with customers.
Continued roll-out of Hello Student branding and new sharing proposition. 
Stakeholder impact considerations
Customers: Affordability; cost of living pressures; engagement.
Shareholders: Impact on sustainable returns and related earnings and distribution guidance.
ESG
Implementation of Net Zero strategy, target setting 
and stakeholder engagement.
Capital allocation to green initiatives.
Wellbeing of our customers and our people.
Improved transparency. 
Decision taken
Interim targets agreed and two year plan put to shareholder vote at AGM. 
Commitment to enhance capital allocation to green initiatives to accelerate implementation.
Benchmarking commitment agreed.
Reporting on Scope 3 emissions. 
Stakeholder impact considerations
Environment: Becoming a sustainable business and contributing to the communities in which we operate.
Shareholders and Lenders: Responding to requests to participate in annual CDP benchmarking.
Customers/employees: Impact of implementation plans on wellbeing.

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Governance report
110
Nomination committee report
Committee composition and operations
Led by the Chairman, the Board is responsible for the 
overall effectiveness in directing the Company. It is 
therefore appropriate that the Nomination Committee, 
which is responsible for the composition of the Board, 
is led by the Company’s Chairman, Mark Pain. He is 
assisted by three independent Directors, all of whom have 
significant experience as Directors of listed companies.
The Committee met three times during the year and was 
attended by all relevant Committee members, the COO, 
the Head of the People team and the Company Secretary. 
The Committee’s primary objectives are to review the 
current Board capability and structure, lead the process 
for appointments, ensure plans are in place for the orderly 
succession of both the Board and the Group’s Senior 
Leadership Team, to promote diversity and inclusion and 
to evaluate the performance of the Board. In addition, the 
Board reviewed culture and the results of the Employee 
survey. No appointments were made to the Board or to 
the Executive Committee this year, but all other matters 
were addressed. 
Current Board structure
The current Board comprises the Chair, two executives 
and three independent Directors. Appointment terms for 
Directors are shown overleaf. The 2024 Board evaluation 
considered the size of the Board to be an appropriate 
size for the business, being focused and effective. A skills 
assessment conducted during the year confirmed that 
there was a good range of experience provided by the 
Directors, as seen in the skills matrix, found on page 100, 
which align with the critical risks of the Company. It was 
noted that AI and Legal were skills lacking on the Board, 
but Directors were comfortable that they had access to 
advisers should they require additional guidance to assist 
them in their duties. Furthermore, the Chief Investment, 
Chief Operating, Chief Customer and IT Directors, 
although not appointed to the Board, share their 
knowledge through regular updates and presentations 
and attend by invitation to present reports such as 
valuation summaries, operational strategies, pricing 
proposals, AI opportunities and IT strategy documents. 
The annual Board evaluation raised two areas of concern 
for the Committee, these being succession planning and 
diversity. Although succession plans have been drawn up, 
the size of the business was thought to restrict the ability 
to have a full plan in place for the Executive Committee, 
as there is not always sufficient depth of expertise. The 
size of the Board was considered to restrict the ability 
to improve diversity amongst the Directors, albeit that 
the Company has made strides to improve diversity 
throughout the business including target setting for 
senior management.
Succession planning 
The table overleaf shows the tenure of the Board 
members. Although the independence of non-executives 
is compromised after nine years, it cannot be assumed 
that all non-executives will remain on the Board for the 
maximum tenure and that there will not be an orderly 
succession plan implemented earlier. Therefore, before 
standing for re-election at the AGM, Directors confirm 
their commitment to the Company for the year ahead. 
If a Director indicates a preference to step down in the 
near future, this potential vacancy is reviewed against 
the context of the Company’s strategy, the Board and 
the Committee requirements, to ensure stability and 
continuation, refresh skills and experience, and any 
necessary qualification requirements. The process for 
appointments, shown overleaf, is then followed. 
Succession plans for the executive Directors and 
Executive Committee have been prepared on both a short 
and long-term basis, identifying roles with perspective 
internal candidates, or where there are currently gaps, 
when external applicants might need to be considered. 
With a policy of encouraging promotions from within, 
and a strong, gender diverse, Senior Leadership Team 
in place, the Committee acknowledged that there is a 
pool of internal candidates who could, in time, present 
succession opportunities for the Executive Committee 
members. A bespoke leadership development programme 
was therefore introduced during 2024 for those 
employees one compensation band below the Executive 
and the succession plans are regularly reviewed to identify 
and develop ‘rising stars’.
“The Board evaluation concluded 
that, overall, the Board 
continued to operate effectively 
throughout 2024.”
Mark Pain  |  Nomination Committee Chairman
Committee membership and meetings
Meetings
Mark Pain 
3 (3)
Alice Avis
3 (3)
Martin Ratchford
3 (3)
Clair Preston-Beer
3 (3)

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Governance report
111
Tenure
Directors
Tenure
To step down by
Independent non-executive
Mark Pain
6 years
September 2027
Alice Avis 
5 years
March 2028
Martin Ratchford
3 years
October 2030
Clair Preston-Beer
2 years
July 2031
Executive
Duncan Garrood
4 years
n/a
Donald Grant
2 years
n/a
Appointments to the Board
When considering the appointment of new Board 
members, the Nomination Committee will develop  
a specification brief of the required attributes.  
An external agency, who have adopted the Voluntary 
Code of Conduct for Director Search Firms, is engaged 
to assist in compiling a diverse list of candidates with the 
appropriate requirements. This long list is reviewed by 
the Nomination Committee, and a shortlist of candidates 
invited for a formal interview. Such candidates will have 
the most appropriate experience, who can offer additional 
skills to those already on the Board, bring diversity 
and independence of thought, whilst being aligned to 
our values and culture. After being interviewed by the 
Nomination Committee, the preferred candidates will 
meet with the other Directors, references sought, and 
conflicts assessed before a decision is taken. 
Terms of Appointment of Directors
The executive Directors have contracts with the  
Company which include a six-month notice period and 
restrictive covenants. 
The non-executive Directors have letters of appointment, 
which can be terminated in accordance with the Articles 
of Association and do not specify a notice period.  
The terms and conditions of appointment for the  
non-executive Directors are available for inspection at  
the Company’s registered office and at each Annual 
General Meeting.
Directors who are appointed to the Board during the 
year are required to be elected by shareholders at the 
next Annual General Meeting. Thereafter, all Directors are 
submitted for annual re-election at each Annual General 
Meeting, subject to continued satisfactory performance 
assessed by the Board at the end of each year and 
confirmation of their commitment. 
Board induction and training
All Directors receive a thorough formal induction upon 
appointment. This includes meeting members of the 
Board, the Senior Leadership Team, and key advisers.  
The Chairman reviews and discusses each Director’s 
individual training and development needs. The Board as 
a whole also receives briefings and training on relevant 
topics. The Company benefits from the non-executive 
Directors’ membership of other boards. This provides 
experience that can be applied to our business.  
In addition, the Board receives regular publications on  
key topics from our advisers and other professional 
services firms. Regulatory and corporate governance 
updates are provided by the Company Secretary at each 
Board meeting. Opportunities are also provided for 
Directors to meet and discuss projects with members 
of the senior management team and property tours are 
undertaken to enable Directors to view the Company’s 
assets, to hold discussions with the responsible asset 
managers and meet some of our customers. 
Director independence
The Board reviews the independence of the Chairman  
and non-executive Directors on an annual basis.  
For the financial year ending 31 December 2024, all of 
the non-executive Directors, including the Chairman, are 
considered to be independent in line with the provisions 
set out in the Code.
Advice for Directors and D&O Insurance
If circumstances arise where it is necessary for a Director 
to seek legal or professional advice in the furtherance 
of their duties, they are encouraged to consult with the 
Company’s advisers or the Company Secretary. Should 
they deem it necessary to take independent professional 
advice, agreed procedures must be followed. 
The Company maintains liability insurance which covers 
Directors and Officers of the Company and all subsidiaries 
of the Empiric Student Property plc Group. Should 
Directors leave the Company, insurance cover is provided 
for a period of 12 years from the date of termination. 
Time commitment of Directors
Directors are required to devote sufficient time to fulfil 
their responsibilities to the Group, to attend and prepare 
for Board, Committee and Annual General meetings, 
and to regularly refresh and update their skills and 
knowledge. The Chairman has reviewed the availability 
of the Directors and is satisfied that each Director is able 
to, and in practice does, devote the necessary amount 
of time to the Group’s business. The Senior Independent 
Director has reviewed the availability of the Chairman and 
considers that he is able to, and in practice does, devote 
the necessary amount of time to the Group’s business.
External appointments
On appointment, and before each Board meeting 
thereafter, all Directors are asked to disclose any 
directorships, relevant shareholdings or any other 
potential conflict of interest. Directors may not, without 
the prior consent of the Board, accept any other non-
executive appointment or a consultative role to any 
investment business with materially similar investment 
objectives to the Company. Prior to accepting an external 
appointment, the Committee will consider the demands 
that are likely to affect the Director, and the expected time 
commitment involved, ensuring that it will not be to the 
detriment of the Company. No Directors are considered 
to be over boarded, and all devote sufficient time. 
During the year Duncan Garrood, CEO, was invited to 
join the board of the Brighton Pier Group PLC as a non-
executive Director. Following confirmation that this new 
role would not impact on his position at Empiric Student 
Property plc, the appointment was approved by the Board. 

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Governance report
112
Board Evaluation
The annual Board review provides an opportunity to consider ways of identifying 
efficiencies, strengths and areas of further development to enable the Board and its 
Committees to continuously improve their own performance and the performance of  
the Group. 
In line with Corporate Governance recommendations, an external evaluation is 
conducted every three years and is due to be performed again in 2025. 
The 2024 internal Board evaluation was established by the Chairman and the Company 
Secretary, incorporating questions from the internal evaluation held in 2023. The 
evaluation assessed the effectiveness of the Board in the delivery of the 2024 Board 
objectives and also reviewed the Committees, and individual Directors. The software 
used provided an effectiveness score for the Board and Committees, which are shown 
below along with the key topics covered. Any matters requiring attention are indicated 
with a ‘*’
100%	 Overall performance of the Board
87%	
Composition of the Board (size, skills, culture, leaderships, succession planning* 
and diversity*)
90%	
Meetings and Board Packs (structure and content of Board packs, meetings, 
teamwork, contributions, challenges and relations between Directors)
81% 	
Board objectives (purpose and vision, strategy, customer service*, workforce 
engagement, culture, diversity, ESG* and shareholder value creation*) 
87% 	
Strategy (appropriateness, implementation, measurement, exploring 
opportunities* and emerging issues)
78% 	
Decision Process (information provided, risks, consideration of stakeholders, 
conflicts, advice received*, review of past decisions*)
The Board evaluation concluded that, overall, the Board continued to operate effectively 
throughout 2024. Directors agreed that a huge amount of work had been conducted, the 
Board had performed well and had navigated some complex issues in challenging market 
conditions. Following the review, further enhancements were proposed for 2025 which 
are set out in the table opposite.
It was disappointing that succession planning and ESG were raised as issues in the 2023 
and 2024 evaluations, although these had already been flagged by the Committees as 
matters they wished to explore further in 2025 and are due to be discussed at the next 
Committee meetings in quarter one. 
Actions arising from the 2024 Board evaluation 
The table below outlines the improvement areas identified following the Board Evaluation 
in 2024, together with the proposed action plan.
2024 Key findings
2025 action plan
More focus on succession planning and 
reviewing diversity on the Board and in  
the workforce.
Further succession plans to be reviewed by 
the Committee and diversity targets to be 
monitored on a regular basis . 
Female Representation and Ethnic Diversity 
in Senior Leadership Team has been set as  
a Culture related KPI to be monitored  
and tracked. 
Improvement of our NPS score to further 
widen the gap with our competitors. 
The eNPS and NPS scores have been 
chosen as culture related KPIs and, 
although the scores are above benchmarks, 
the Board would like to have an increased 
focus on raising employee and customer 
satisfaction levels.
Raise Importance and clarity of our ESG 
agenda to all of our stakeholders.
The Company intends to participate in 
an ESG benchmarking study from 2026 
which should improve transparency for 
stakeholders and create enhanced focus 
and comparability. 
Unlocking longer term value creation. 
Ensure that our growth strategy accelerates 
value creation. 
Exploring new opportunities. 
To be addressed at the annual strategy day 
in June.
Review of past decisions. 
Discussion to be held to reflect on the 
impact of passed decisions made and 
lessons that could be learnt, in particular 
with regards to the joint venture 
proposition undertaken in 2024.
Additional external advice for Committees. Committees to receive additional advice on 
specific topics requested. 
Nomination committee report | continued

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Governance report
113
Update on actions arising from the 2023 Board evaluation
The table below outlines the improvement areas identified following the Board evaluation 
in 2023, together with the progress made on these during 2024.
2023 Key findings
2024 action taken
Increased focus on delivering ESG strategy 
with further development, and validation of 
ESG key performance indicators.
Net zero strategy KPIs were assessed 
throughout the year to ensure the Company 
remained on track to achieve the targets set. 
The ESG targets were put to a shareholder 
advisory vote at the AGM in May 2024. 
Review succession plans to cover Board 
succession and talent management of the 
executive team.
Succession plans were reviewed by the 
Committee during the year, and a similar 
exercise is to be undertaken for the Senior 
Leadership team. 
Further time to be allocated to discussing 
the Group’s organisational culture.
KPIs have been set to enable the 
Committee to track culture. These are 
reported on page 101.
Committee Evaluation
Committee effectiveness scores are shown below. The matters evaluated covered 
leadership, information provided, advisers, and committee specific topics
97% 	
The Audit and Risk Committee was regarded as being well managed, but more 
focus was needed on addressing risks. 
92%	
The Remuneration Committee’s leadership was deemed to be first class, but more 
support was requested from the external adviser. 
84%	
The Nomination Committee review highlighted the need to spend more time 
addressing diversity and succession, as shown in the 2025 action plan. 
77% 	
The ESG Committee was regarded as less effective, with greater clarity of strategy 
and implementation required. 
Directors Evaluation
The performance of the individual Directors was reviewed by the Chairman, and by each 
of the other Directors as part of the Board evaluation. 
The non-executive Directors understanding of the business, their integrity and time 
commitment all scored highly. 
The CEO was regarded as setting an excellent example to employees, upholding the 
Company’s values and setting its culture, with communication being open and honest 
and stakeholder management being strong.
The CFSO was regarded as dedicated to his role and a true business steward delivering 
high quality information to the Board and shareholders. 
The Chair’s performance was reviewed by the SID, with questionnaires completed 
by each of the other Board Directors. The SID then discussed responses received in 
private meetings with each Director providing them the opportunity to elaborate on 
their answers and to offer any further comments. The review concluded that the Board 
was highly supportive of the Chairman and believed his leadership to be clear, inclusive 
and extremely effective, investing quality time to build his relationship with his fellow 
Board members. A strong ‘tone from the top’ promoted effective decision making 
and constructive debate, with the Chair proactively seeking out the views of the non-
executive Directors and encouraging contributions from all. Mark Pain’s expert guidance 
and decisive leadership during the JV termination and equity raise were highlighted and 
greatly appreciated. Good progress had been made against all areas of opportunity for 
improvement which were identified during the prior year review. 
Independence and re-election
All Directors are subject to annual re-election at the Annual General Meeting, and the 
Board will recommend reappointment as part of the Notice of Meeting.
Prior to recommending the reappointment of any Director to the Board, the Committee 
assesses their continued independence, the time commitment required, any over 
boarding concerns and whether their reappointment would be in the best interests 
of the Group. The Board is satisfied that each of the four non-executive Directors 
remain independent in both character and judgement and that they comply with the 
independence criteria of the Code.
Biographies for each Director can be found on pages 98 to 99 and are included in the 
Notice of the Annual General Meeting to be held on 4 June 2025. 

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Governance report
114
Employee Survey and Culture
The Committee reviewed the outcome of the employee engagement survey, comprising 
54 questions, which had been conducted using the Culture Amp platform. This allowed 
the results to be benchmarked against other organisations with an aim of being in the top 
25% of organisations in the UK with 200 – 500 employees. The survey resulted in a 78% 
engagement score, against a benchmark rate of 75%, and the outcome was very positive 
with 90% of people proud to work at ESP. The platform also provided an Employee Net 
Promoter Score (eNPS) of +44, which was +18 above the comparator group benchmark 
and +37 above the median UK eNPS score. The Committee requested that the survey be 
conducted again in 2025 which would track any trends and show any progress made. 
In preparation for the 2024 Corporate Governance Code, the Committee considered 
how it would monitor and embed culture throughout the business. It was noted that the 
student survey produced an NPS score, measuring the customer service received, which 
the Committee considered to be a reflection of the Company’s culture and happiness 
score. The Committee therefore recommended to the Board that, as the eNPS and  
NPS scores were correlated and underpinned the Company’s values, they be used to 
monitor culture. 
The Committee also recognises the benefits of diversity on the Company’s culture and 
is currently looking at ways of improving this throughout the Group. The Committee 
therefore recommended that two diversity KPIs be used to provide focus and allow  
the Company to monitor its progress. Further information on culture can be found on 
page 101.
Diversity and inclusion 
The Nomination Committee review the composition of the Board and diversity of the 
Group at least annually. A summary of the Company’s Diversity Policy can be found on 
page 97 and has been applied throughout the year. When considering diversity across 
the Group, the Committee mainly focus on gender and ethnicity, but the strategy also 
considers sexual orientation, disability, neurodiversity, age and generation and the 
Company has partnered with a number of organisations to help address these areas. 
With regards to diversity of the Board, and in accordance with UKLR 6.6.6R (9), the 
Company can confirm that as at 31 December 2024:
1.	
the Company has two women on the Board, equating to 33.3% representation; 
2.	 Alice Avis holds the position of Senior Independent Director, and is also the 
employee’s representative on the Board; and 
3.	 no Board Directors are from an ethnic background. 
Nomination committee report | continued
The Committee is aware that it has not met the targets for Board diversity for (1) and (3) 
above and, in order to address these targets, the Nomination Committee considered 
two options: (a) to increase the size of the Board or (b) to replace a Director by either 
removing an existing Director or upon normal rotation. 
The internal Board evaluation outlined above showed that the Directors considered the 
Board to be the right size with a good range and diversity of age, skills and experience 
allowing the Board to operate effectively. The relatively small size allows the Board to be 
agile and take advantage of situations such as the successful capital raise completed in 
October. The Chairman is therefore reluctant to add any further Directors, and further 
cost, to the Board, or to remove any current Directors, in order to meet diversity targets. 
Therefore, as vacancies arise, we will seek to select the very best candidate from a fully 
diverse list. This is not expected to occur in the near term due to the length of the current 
Board member’s individual tenures and should therefore be appreciated that  
this may take time.
The table below shows representation on the Board, within Executive Management and 
across the Group as at 31 December 2024. There have been no changes to the Board or 
to the executive team during the year or since the date on which this Annual Report was 
approved. The executive management team comprises the CEO, CFSO, Chief Investment 
Officer, Chief Operating Officer and Chief Customer Officer.
Gender representation on the Board and across the Group
Number 
of Board 
members
Percentage 
of the Board
Number 
of Senior 
positions on 
the Board 
(CEO, CFO, 
SID and 
Chair) 
Number in 
Executive 
Management 
Percentage 
of Executive 
Management 
Numbers 
across the 
Group 
Men 
4
66.6
3
3
60
204 
Women
2
33.3
1
2
40
163
Other
–
–
–
–
–
Not specific
–
–
–
–
–
2
Below the Board, 32 per cent (FY23: 29 per cent) of the senior leadership team, are 
female, with females representing 44 per cent (FY23: 42 per cent) of all employees, which 
has increased year on year. Furthermore, the gender Pay Gap data reported in April 2024 
showed that females were paid higher than males in the business for pay and bonus.  
This continues to illustrate the level of female representation in the upper middle and 
upper quartiles, with increases of four per cent and five per cent respectively with a six 
per cent reduction in female representation in the lower quartile.

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Governance report
115
Gender representation on the Board Committees
The level of gender diversity is exceeded on all the Board Committees, except on the ESG 
Committee, which is attended by all Directors.
Nominations 
Committee
Audit and Risk 
Committee
Remuneration 
Committee
ESG 
Committee 
Men 
2 (Chair) 
1 (Chair) 
2
4 (Chair)
Women
2
2
2 (Chair) 
2
The Chairs are chosen according to appropriate qualification or experience.  
The Chairman leads the Nomination Committee, to ensure an effective Board, and also 
chairs the ESG Committee, to highlight his commitment and that of the Company to this 
matter. Martin Ratchford as a chartered accountant, chairs the Audit and Risk Committee, 
and Alice Avis, having the requisite experience, chairs the Remuneration Committee.  
No changes to the membership of the Committees have occurred during the year. 
Ethnicity representation on the Board and across the Group
Number 
of Board 
members
Percentage 
of the Board
Number 
of Senior 
positions on 
the Board 
(CEO, CFO, 
SID and 
Chair)
Number in 
Executive 
Management 
Percentage 
of Executive 
Management 
Numbers 
across the 
Group* 
White British  
or other White
6
100
4
5
100
158
Mixed/multiple 
ethnic groups
–
–
–
–
–
12
Asian Black/
Africa
–
–
–
–
–
21
Caribbean/
Black British
–
–
–
–
–
7
Other
–
–
–
–
–
1
Not specified 
–
–
–
–
–
190
*	
It should be noted that the reference date for the Group ethnicity data is 31 August 2024 and therefore does not 
align with the gender figures which were taken at 31 December 2024. All gender and ethnicity data is collected 
from each employee by the People team during the onboarding period, on an optional basis. In order to improve 
the quality of data, a survey is to be undertaken in 2025, with an explanation provided to the employees as to 
why the data is required. All employees are based in the UK.
Across the Group, there is currently 21 per cent (FY23: 21 per cent) of responding 
employees identified as being from an ethnic minority. When the data is reviewed by 
remuneration band, it shows that we have representation across all ethnicity groups in 
Bands 2 (housekeeper, maintenance operative) to Band 4 (deputy multisite manager) 
groups, which are typically customer facing roles. This data also highlights that there is 
no representation of ethnic minorities on the Board or Senior Leadership Team, although 
a target has been set for the latter, to achieve at least 10 per cent ethnic membership by 
the end of 2027. In order to achieve this, and improve diversity in general throughout the 
Company, we are working with DIAL Global, Stonewall and Inspiring Diversity in  
Real Estate to ensure our policies and recruitment procedures are more inclusive.  
An assessment has also been completed with the Business Disability Forum and their 
suggested action points are being implemented.
In addition, the Company has invested in support and career pathways to increase 
diversity in the workforce by launching an accredited Institute of Leadership and 
Management (ILM) qualification, 60 of those who completed the qualification were 
female. The organisation has since launched an inhouse pathway to management 
programme which is supported by an externally accredited apprenticeship with  
the first cohort comprising 75 per cent female aspiring future leaders from across  
the organisation. 
We value the benefits of diversity and intend to maintain an appropriately diverse Board 
and Senior Leadership Team and we will continue to actively seek diversity amongst 
candidates where vacancies arise. We are also confident that our new partnerships will 
assist in improving our diversity, but with an 80% retention rate, and a policy to promote 
talent from within, we are aware that this will take time.
The Board Evaluation highlighted the Board’s desire to improve diversity across the 
Company, with two diversity KPIs set to monitor culture and track the Company’s 
progress to achieve a more diverse workforce. Diversity is therefore very much on the 
Board’s and Committee’s agenda for 2025. 
Mark Pain  |  Nomination Committee Chairman
12 March 2025

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Governance report
116
Environmental social governance committee report
ESG Committee Chair’s overview
I am pleased to present the report of the ESG committee, 
which was established in 2021, to ensure good 
governance and management of climate-related risks 
and opportunities in a responsible and transparent 
manner. The ESG strategy is aligned with our overall 
business strategy and reinforced by the Committee and 
management team, although we believe that we need the 
collaboration of all our people to successfully deliver our 
ESG strategy. 
The Board considers climate change when reviewing 
business strategy and when setting annual budgets. The 
remuneration policy, which was updated in 2023, created 
a clear linkage to the Executive performance and the ESG 
key performance indicators, with both Executives having 
personal ESG targets within their bonus objectives. 
All objectives remain subject to the discretion of the 
Remuneration Committee.
Committee composition and operations
All Board Directors are members of the ESG committee 
which met three times during the year (March, August and 
December). Meetings were attended by all members and 
when applicable, our ESG advisers, Inspired PLC. 
The Chief Financial and Sustainability Officer oversees the 
day-to-day responsibilities of climate-related projects 
and ensures that climate-related risks and opportunities 
are identified, and the potential impacts are accurately 
and formally reported to the ESG Committee, Audit & Risk 
Committee and the Board.
An ESG Working Group, led by the Chief Financial and 
Sustainability Officer, comprises representatives from 
numerous departments throughout the business. The 
Group meets on a regular basis and has established a 
well-developed ESG Management Framework that has 
embedded the management of climate change issues 
within our business.
“The Group is making good 
progress against its targets, 
with 64 per cent of the portfolio 
already rated at EPC B or above.”
Mark Pain  |  Environmental, Social Governance 
Committee Chairman
Committee membership and meetings
Meetings
Mark Pain
3 (3)
Alice Avis
3 (3)
Martin Ratchford
3 (3)
Clair Preston-Beer
3 (3)
Duncan Garrood
3 (3)
Donald Grant
3 (3)
ESG Management Framework
The Board
Has overall responsibility for the Group’s ESG strategy  
and its direction.
ESG Committee
Chaired by the Company’s Chairman, the Committee 
oversees the creation of the overall ESG strategy for  
the Group, ensuring that there is Board level discussion  
and input.
Our People
The successful delivery of our ESG strategy across the 
business, requires the collaboration and support of  
all our people.
ESG Working Group
Chaired by the CFSO, invited members of the senior 
leadership team meet monthly and ensures the ESG  
strategy is embedded throughout the business.
E
S
G
 
C
o
m
m
i
t
t
e
e
E
S
G
 
C
o
m
m
i
t
t
e
e
The Board
O
u
r 
P
e
o
p
l
e
E
S
G
 
W
o
r
k
i
n
g
 
G
r
o
u
p
O
u
r 
P
e
o
p
l
e
E
S
G
 
W
o
r
k
i
n
g
 
G
r
o
u
p

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Governance report
117
Responsibilities of the Committee 
The Committee operates within terms of reference 
approved by the Board, which outline the responsibilities 
of the Committee, these being:
	î To assist the Board in defining and regularly reviewing 
the Group’s strategy relating to ESG matters and in 
setting relevant KPIs;
	î To develop and review regularly the policies, 
programmes, practices, targets and initiatives of the 
Group relating to ESG matters ensuing they remain 
effective and up to date and consistent with good 
industry practice;
	î To provide oversight of the Group’s management of 
ESG matters and compliance with relevant legal and 
regulatory requirements, including applicable rules and 
principles of corporate governance, and applicable 
industry standards;
	î To report on these matters to the Board and, where 
appropriate, make recommendations to the Board; and
	î To report as required to the shareholders of the 
Company on the activities and remit of the Committee.
Activities and matters discussed during 2024 
The March meeting primarily focused on the draft 
disclosures for the Annual Report and the more detailed 
ESG Report which was published separately on the 
Company’s website. It was also decided, as part of our 
commitment to achieving Net Zero by 2033, to put our 
shorter-term targets for 2024 and 2025 to an advisory 
shareholder vote at our Annual General Meeting in May 
2024. Although the resolution was passed, the result was 
somewhat disappointing, with 25 per cent of responding 
shareholders voting against. In order to better understand 
the result, and inform future decision making, we sought 
engagement with shareholders. From those shareholders 
that provided feedback, it appeared in part that they 
required a clearer articulation between the cost and 
return that could be expected for each of target. This will 
be addressed when next put to shareholders in 2026. 
I am pleased to report that we are making good progress 
on most of our targets. The portfolio’s EPC ratings are 
comfortably ahead of the target having 64 per cent of  
the portfolio already rated at EPC B or above.  
Over 2,000 smart heating controls have been installed 
and the decarbonisation of our sites continues, with one 
of our larger sites completed this year. Our decarbonised 
portfolio currently stands at 25 per cent by area, which is 
a little behind where we would have hoped to be given our 
interim target of 40 per cent by the end of 2025. Greater 
focus will be given to this important target in 2025, 
however it is very pleasing to see our initiatives continuing 
to drive our energy consumption per bed lower year on 
year, with a further five per cent consumption saving 
achieved in 2024. 
The Committee recognises the importance of education 
to influence behavioural change. Energy awareness 
campaigns were held in the summer and winter across all 
sites for both employees and students. Impact analysis is 
being conducted to measure the effect of our training on 
behaviour in light of greater awareness. More details on 
our progress made against targets can be found on  
page 54.
Our advisers provided an overview of Climate Change to 
help build the Committee’s capacity and understanding. 
The presentation explained the pillars of TCFD, the three 
approaches to Climate Scenarios, and the actions that 
could be taken to offset climate change and achieve  
Net Zero. 
The ESG risk register was reviewed and subsequently, 
the Board approved the inclusion of significant climate-
related risks into the Group’s comprehensive risk 
register. Climate-related investment thresholds, linked to 
improved investment decision making, will be considered 
further in the next reporting cycle.
In response to requests from shareholders the Committee 
considered six benchmarking platforms, looking at 
the disclosure requirements for each, the benefits that 
would be gained and whether other PBSA companies 
participated. It was noted that CDP appeared to be 
increasing in popularity and was well respected  
amongst our shareholders base. CDP was therefore 
recommended as the Company’s benchmark for  
reporting its ESG credentials. The aim is to start reporting 
against these requirements in 2026 for the year ended  
31 December 2025.
The Board evaluation considered the ESG Committee 
required greater clarity of strategy and implementation. 
I believe that participation in the CDP benchmark will go 
someway to improving transparency for stakeholders 
and create enhanced focus and comparability for the 
Committee going forward.
Mark Pain  |  ESG Committee Chairman
12 March 2025

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Governance report
118
Audit and risk committee report
Audit and Risk Committee Chair’s overview
The Committee has continued its role of governance 
and oversight of the Group’s financial reporting, risk 
management, internal controls, assurance processes 
and external audit. This is conducted on behalf of the 
Board, as set out in the Committee’s terms of reference, 
serving to protect the interests of shareholders. Following 
the Company’s promotion to the FTSE 250 in 2023, the 
Committee revisited the Financial Reporting Council’s 
Minimum Standard for Audit Committees and the External 
Audit and was satisfied that its activities and operations 
throughout the year complied.
The Committee oversaw a formal tender process, 
conducted in late 2024, for the external property valuation 
contract. In line with the requirements of the Royal 
Institution of Chartered Surveyors, valuation houses are 
no longer able to conduct valuations for regulated entities 
for more than ten consecutive years. The Committee has 
unanimously agreed with management’s recommendation 
to appoint Cushman & Wakefield as the Company’s Valuer 
from 2025. A summary of the process followed is set  
out below.
In preparation for the year ahead, the Committee’s terms 
of reference were updated in line with the 2024 Corporate 
Governance Code and can be found on the Company’s 
website www.empiric.co.uk. With the implementation 
date of Provision 29 of the new Code approaching, 
the Committee spent time with management planning 
how the Group would identify, monitor and test the 
effectiveness of material controls, and the related 
attestations that would be required from 2026.
Committee composition and operations
The Committee comprises three independent non-
executive Directors. The Board continues to be satisfied 
that Martin Ratchford has the recent and relevant financial 
experience required to chair the Committee and the 
Committee as a whole has the competence relevant to the 
sector in which the Group operates. 
The Committee met three times during the year, in March, 
August and December. Meetings were attended by all 
relevant members and were aligned to the Company’s 
financial reporting and risk management cycles.  
All meetings were attended by the Company’s Chairman,  
the CEO, the CFSO, the Financial Controller and the 
Company Secretary. In March and August the External 
Auditor and Valuer were invited to attend and present 
their respective reports and valuations to the Committee, 
which the committee reviewed and challenged.  
The Committee holds private meetings with the external 
and Internal Auditor without management being present, 
in order to ensure open and direct feedback is possible, 
and to ensure the auditor has had sufficient access to 
management and to confirm how they have exercised 
professional scepticism. 
The Internal Auditor also attended to present reports 
and findings from their work throughout the year and in 
December, following the conclusion of the Group’s risk 
management review, which the Committee reviewed and 
challenged. They presented their internal audit plan for 
the forthcoming year for the Committee’s consideration 
and approval.
Responsibilities of the Committee
The Committee has delegated responsibility from the 
Board and is primarily responsible for discharging 
governance responsibilities in respect to oversight of 
financial reporting, audit, risk and the internal control 
environment and to report to the Board as appropriate. 
Specifically the Committee:
	î reviews the work of both the External and Internal 
Auditor and the Group’s independent Valuer;
	î monitors the integrity of the Group’s annual and interim 
financial statements and any formal announcements 
or correspondence in respect of the Group’s financial 
information;
	î considers significant financial reporting issues, 
judgments and estimates exercised by management in 
the preparation of financial information; 
	î advises the Board on various statements made in the 
Annual Report, including those on viability, going 
concern, risk and internal controls and whether, when 
read as a whole, the Annual Report can be considered 
fair, balanced and understandable and is considered to 
provide the information necessary for shareholders to 
“The Committee continues to 
monitor quality and integrity, 
providing stakeholders with 
responsible and transparent 
oversight of the Group’s 
financial reporting, internal 
control and risk management 
procedures.”
Martin Ratchford  |  Audit and Risk Committee 
Chairman
Committee membership and meetings
Meetings
Martin Ratchford
3 (3)
Alice Avis
3 (3)
Clair Preston-Beer
3 (3)

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Governance report
119
assess the Group’s performance, its business model  
and strategy;
	î considers and approves the remuneration of the 
External Auditor, assessing effectiveness and making 
recommendations to the Board on the appointment of, 
and the policy for, non-audit services provided by the 
External Auditor;
	î oversees the tender process for auditors and the  
Valuer and recommend appointments;
	î considers and approves audit plans; 
	î reviews the risk management framework and ensures 
that risks are carefully considered, ranked and that a 
system of risk management and mitigating controls  
are in place and operating effectively; and
	î reviews whistleblowing arrangements and any  
matters arising.
The Board delegates these duties to the Committee so 
they can receive suitably focused attention, however the 
Committee acts on behalf of the Board, and the matters 
reviewed and managed by the Committee remain the 
responsibility of the Directors as a whole.
Activities and matters addressed during 2024
During the year the following matters were considered:
	î reports from the Company’s Valuer, CBRE;
	î the impact of the abolition of Multi Dwelling Relief; 
	î reports from the Company’s External Auditor, BDO LLP, 
regarding the 2023 full year results, the 2024 interim 
results and the 2024 year end audit plan;
	î reports from the Company’s Internal Auditor, Grant 
Thornton LLP, including the 2025 internal audit plan;
	î reports from the Financial Controller;
	î risk management process, outcome and related 
disclosures;
	î financial stress testing and covenant compliance;
	î viability and going concerns assessment and  
related disclosures;
	î 2023 report and accounts;
	î 2024 interim statement;
	î recommendation of dividend payments; 
	î effectiveness of internal controls and the process for 
defining and testing material controls;
	î independence, effectiveness and quality of the external 
and Internal Auditor;
	î significant areas of estimation and judgement;
	î review of accounting policies;
	î REIT compliance;
	î consideration of parental guarantee to facilitate audit 
exemption of 104 subsidiary entities;
	î review of whistleblowing policy and procedures;
	î review of Company’s policy in respect of non-audit fees;
	î review of the related parties register; 
	î review of terms of reference; and
	î tenders for valuation services from Knight Frank and 
Cushman & Wakefield. 
External Auditor independence and non-audit services
The Committee considered BDO LLP’s engagement, 
compensation and independence during the year.  
The Committee met with key members of the audit team, 
including the lead audit engagement partner. As part of 
the annual reporting process, BDO LLP formally confirmed 
its independence, through its compliance with the FRC’s 
Ethical Standard and the IESBA Code of Ethics, and 
further assurances obtained from independent auditors 
and external audit experts. Confirmation was also given 
that the necessary safeguards were in place to limit the 
amount of non-audit services they can provide, and a 
policy of gradual rotation covering the senior audit team 
members, further protecting their independence. 
The Committee and management regularly liaise with  
the lead audit partner to discuss any issues arising from 
the audit in a timely manner to aid cost effectiveness.  
I continue to have dialogue with the external audit partner 
throughout the year, outside the formal schedule of 
Committee meetings.
The Group’s policy in regard to non-audit services is 
reviewed by the Committee annually and continues to 
align to the Financial Reporting Council’s ethical guidance 
which sets out acceptable services which are sufficiently 
related to the audit and caps total fees for such services 
to be limited to no more than 70 per cent of the average 
audit fees paid in the last three financial years.  
During the year, other than the review of the Group’s 
interim statement, (being an activity required for 
regulatory purposes), BDO LLP did not provide any  
non-audit services.
The following fees were paid to the External Auditor 
during the year and are included within administrative 
expenses in the Group’s Statement of Comprehensive 
Income.
£m
Year ended 
31 December 
2024
Year ended
31 December 
2023
Audit and related fees1
0.4
0.5
Non-audit fees2
0.1
0.1
Total
0.5
0.6
1 	
Audit and related fees for the year ended 31 December 2023 included 
£0.1 million arising in respect of the audit for the year ended 31 
December 2022
2 	
Non-audit fees of £56,000 relate to the review of the Group’s interim 
statement (2023: £53,500)
KPMG LLP continues to support the Group with the 
provision of tax compliance and advisory services.
Effectiveness and quality of the External Auditor
The Committee reviewed the effectiveness and quality of 
the new External Auditor. In doing so, consideration was 
given to the following: 
	î review of the auditors Audit Quality Plan, and 
assurances from BDO LLP of their ongoing 
independence, in line with the Financial Reporting 
Council’s ethical standards;
	î review of, and discussion with, the External Auditor in 
respect of the Financial Reporting Council’s Annual 
Review of Audit Quality and Audit Quality Inspection 
and Supervision report;
	î quality of written reports submitted to the Committee, 
were considered clear and concise with presentations 
at meetings being considered balanced, clear and 
understandable;
	î consultation with management that demonstrated the 
auditor’s competency and experience necessary to 
perform their role effectively; 

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Governance report
120
	î audit queries that demonstrated professional scepticism were raised and dealt with in 
a proactive and timely manner and there was sufficient challenge with regard to areas 
of judgement, estimate, internal controls and areas of heightened risk; 
	î challenge management’s judgements. The Committee specifically requested BDO to 
challenge management’s assumptions on valuations, and demonstrate professional 
scepticism. BDO held meetings with management and the external Valuer on this topic 
and reported the findings back to the Committee; and
	î publications were provided to management throughout the year on emerging issues 
and financial reporting updates.
After due consideration the Committee concluded that the External Auditor had 
continued to provide a high quality and effective audit during a year in which there had 
been a change in audit partner which followed retender in 2023. The Committee was 
therefore satisfied that a recommendation to reappoint BDO LLP as External Auditor 
could be made to the Board.
Internal Auditor and the control environment
The Group is committed to a process of continual improvement of its internal control 
environment. The Internal Auditor acknowledged that the quality of the Group’s finance 
function had improved and confirmed that critical controls were now well embedded 
throughout the business. Although some areas of weakness were identified, none 
were considered to materially impact the overall control environment with adequate 
segregation of duties and controls with appropriate fraud detection measures in place. 
The Committee reviewed the effectiveness of the internal control environment 
throughout the year through reports prepared by the Internal Auditor, the Financial 
Controller and the CFSO. The Committee also met with the lead partner at Grant 
Thornton LLP without management to provide the opportunity for open and  
transparent feedback.
The Committee was satisfied that no significant weakness was identified and concluded 
that the Internal Auditor and the control environment were effective and that the internal 
control environment was appropriate for a Group of our size and complexity. 
During the financial year the Company’s Internal Auditor, Grant Thornton LLP, reported on 
the following internal audits: 
Audit area
Key risk considered
Summary of scope
Data 
protection
Compliance with GDPR 
regulation
•	 Collection and use of personal data;
•	 Policies and procedures in place to maintain 
DPIAs and ROPAs;
•	 Governance and training; and
•	 Record and breach management.
Payroll
Protect against 
inappropriate payments 
and fraud
•	 Controls surrounding changes to standing 
data, adding and removing employees; and
•	 Segregation of roles.
Council Tax Compliance with 
framework 
•	 Recognition of liabilities and appropriate use 
of exemption status; and
•	 Identification and processing of refunds.
All audits received a low to medium risk grade. In all cases appropriate management 
responses were provided to findings and the status of outstanding actions monitored 
and reported to the Committee. At the end of the year all actions had either been 
completed or were in progress in line with agreed plans.
The Internal Auditor’s plan for 2025 was reviewed and agreed in late 2024.  
The Committee was satisfied that the plan was designed to provide external assurance 
on the control environment pertinent to key risk areas in the context of the Group’s 
overall risk management system, including the operational effectiveness of critical  
mitigating controls. 
Audit and risk committee report | continued

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Governance report
121
Significant accounting estimates and judgements. 
The Committee reviews significant judgements and estimates exercised in the 
production of the Group’s financial information and related disclosures.
Consistent with the prior year, the valuation of investment property remains one of 
the most significant judgments in the Group’s financial statements. The valuations are 
scrutinised by both the Committee and the External Auditor. The External Auditor’s 
specialist valuation adviser considers the appropriateness of the procedures undertaken 
and whether the valuations can be considered to fall within an acceptable range. In each 
case, no issues were raised. 
The Valuers have confirmed, and have demonstrated, that they are appropriately qualified 
to carry out the valuations and that fees received are not a material part of their overall 
fee income. The Committee monitors the objectivity and independence of the Valuer 
through both formal Committee and informal one to one meetings. The Committee is 
satisfied that the Valuer remains objective and independent. 
The treatment of operating lease contracts remains a key judgement. Student leases do 
not exceed a term of 51 weeks in length and the Committee remains satisfied, following 
an evaluation of the Group’s commercial lease contracts, that these can continue to be 
accounted for as operating leases as the Group continues to retains all significant risks 
and rewards of ownership.
Tender process for the external Valuer
In 2024 CBRE valued a number of the Group’s properties for the tenth consecutive year. 
In line with the requirements of the Royal Institution of Chartered Surveyors, mandatory 
rotation of the Valuer is required for regulated entities after ten years. A competitive 
tender process was therefore carried out during 2024. The Committee met with two 
valuation houses recommended by management. Particular attention was paid to the 
depth of experience, quality of research and reporting, alignment of approach with the 
outgoing Valuer and approach to fees. 
After due challenge and consideration, the Committee concurred with management’s 
recommendation to appoint Cushman & Wakefield as the Company’s external Valuer  
from 2025 and recommended their appointment to the Board.
Going concern and viability
The appropriateness of preparing the Group’s financial statements on a going concern 
basis remains a significant area of judgement. The Committee reviews and considers 
whether management’s assessment of the Group’s long-term viability appropriately 
reflects the prospects of the Group and covers an appropriate period of time.
Specifically, the Committee considered whether the assessment reflected the Group’s 
low risk appetite, its principal risks, strategy and the current operating environment.  
The Committee then reviewed the assumptions and sensitivities applied in stress 
testing the Group’s base case plan and whether these represented severe but plausible 
downside scenarios. The Committee had particular regard for the status of refinancing 
activities and the related assumptions inherent in the Group’s model.
In conclusion, the Committee concurred with management’s assessment and 
recommended the adoption of the going concern basis of preparation and the viability 
statement to the Board. The viability statement, together with details on the assessment 
undertaken and stress tests applied, are set out on page 43.
Changes in accounting policies and standards
The Committee is responsible for reviewing any proposed changes in accounting 
policies and the implementation of new accounting standards. 
After due consideration, no changes were proposed to the Group’s accounting 
policies which have been consistently applied throughout the year to 31 December 
2024. Following discussions with management and the External Auditor, no new 
accounting standards or annual updates were expected to have a material impact on the 
consolidated financial statements for the year ended 31 December 2024. The Auditor 
confirmed that the Company has complied with all policies during the year. 
Risk management
A process for identifying and recording risks has been established and is embedding 
within the business. A Group risk register is compiled from the reports of the various 
divisions and corporate functions. Prior to its submission to the Committee, review 
meetings are held with departmental heads, and the identified risks and associated 
ratings are challenged where appropriate. Guidelines ensure a commonality of approach 
with thresholds set from a financial, reputational and timeframe perspective. Risks were 
assessed based on a ‘gross’ and ‘net’ exposure basis, with ‘net’ exposure determined after 
considering the impact of mitigating actions or controls which are currently in place. 

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Governance report
122
Results are analysed to identify the Group’s principal risks which are then compared to 
the previous review and proposed disclosures then highlight any significant change or 
new and emerging risks. Further potential mitigation strategies are then considered for 
all principal risks.
The most notable changes this year were:
	î failure to meet equity raise commitments and related impact on reputation and future 
fund raising potential;
	î uncertainty in government policy given the relatively new government and other 
geopolitical factors;
	î ongoing inflationary pressure on administrative, operational and refurbishment 
related costs, together with the longer term impact of the autumn 2024 budget and its 
consequence to strategic plans;
	î concerns regarding utility costs which are widely expected to remain higher for longer; 
and
	î heightened risk of disruption to occupancy caused by alternative accommodation 
providers.
Full disclosure of the Group’s principal risks are set out on pages 38 to 42.
Whistleblowing
The Committee is responsible for reviewing the arrangements by which staff can raise 
concerns, in confidence, about any possible improprieties relating to financial reporting 
or other matters. During the year we have reviewed the Whistleblowing Policy and 
ensured it has been widely published throughout the Group and on the website.  
The policy encourages disclosure internally to the line manager or the Company 
Secretary. If staff wish to raise their concerns externally details of the External Auditor 
and Citizens advice are provided. 
The Committee has concluded that the Group has suitable arrangements for 
proportionately and independently investigating such matters and for appropriate 
follow-up action.
Conclusions in Respect of the Company’s Annual Report
The production and audit of the Annual Report is a comprehensive process, requiring 
input from several different contributors and teams from across the business with input 
from the Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial and Sustainability Officer. There are 
early opportunities for the Board to review and comment on the Annual Report during 
its evolution. To reach a conclusion on whether the Annual Report taken as a whole is fair, 
balanced and understandable, as required by the Code, the Board has requested that the 
Committee considers whether the Annual Report fulfils these requirements.
In forming its conclusion, the Committee considered information provided to it 
throughout the year, together with the following:
	î the controls in place for the production of the Annual Report, including the verification 
processes to confirm its factual accuracy; 
	î the detailed reviews undertaken at various stages of the production process by 
the executive Directors, Company Secretary, legal adviser, brokers, auditor and the 
Committee, which are intended to ensure consistency and overall balance; 
	î a cross check between Board minutes and the Annual Report is undertaken to ensure 
that reporting is balanced and complete; and
	î whether information is presented in a clear and concise manner to facilitate users 
access and understanding of relevant information. 
As a result of this work, the Committee has concluded and reported to the Board 
that the Annual Report for the year ended 31 December 2024, taken as a whole, is fair, 
balanced and understandable and provides the information necessary for shareholders 
to assess the Group’s position, performance, business model, strategy and principal 
risks. The Board’s conclusions in this respect are set out in the Directors’ Responsibilities 
Statement on page 145.
Should any stakeholders wish to contact me, I can be reached via the ‘Contact us’ link on 
the Company’s website and would be happy to address any questions shareholders may 
have in respect to the Committee’s activities.
Martin Ratchford  |  Audit and Risk Committee Chairman
12 March 2025
Audit and risk committee report | continued

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Governance report
123
Remuneration committee report
Statement from the Chair of  
the Remuneration Committee
Committee composition and operations
The Committee is comprised of three non-executive 
Directors and the Company’s non-executive Chairman. 
The three non-executive Directors are also members 
of the Audit and Risk and ESG Committees, which 
ensures they have a wide appreciation of the work, 
achievements or improvements required of the executive 
Directors, which aids in establishing their objectives 
and determining their performance in line with the 
Remuneration Policy. Alice Avis was appointed Chair 
of the Committee in April 2022 having had previous 
experience as Chair of Remuneration committees.
The Committee is responsible for reviewing and 
making recommendations to the Board regarding the 
Remuneration Policy and for reviewing compliance 
with Policy. The Committee met three times during the 
year, with meetings attended by all relevant members, 
including the Company Secretary. Deloitte are retained  
to provide advice to the Committee, where required.
Key activities during 2024
	î Alignment of the Company’s strategy and executive 
objectives with shareholders’ interests
	î Reward decisions relative to personal and Group 
performance
	î Employee engagement
	î Benchmarking executive compensation
	î Reviewing the Chairman’s remuneration
	î Remuneration and benefits of wider workforce
	î Gender pay report
	î CEO pay ratio, internal proportionality and LTIP vesting
Dear Shareholder,
On behalf of the Board, I am pleased to present the 
Directors’ Remuneration Report for the year ended  
31 December 2024.
The report is divided into three parts:.
	î The Annual Statement which summarises the 
remuneration outcomes in 2024, the key decisions 
taken and how the Remuneration Policy (“Policy”)  
will be applied in the current financial year;
	î A summary of the Remuneration Policy which was 
approved by shareholders at the Annual General 
Meeting on 24 May 2023; and
	î The Annual Report on Remuneration which sets out full 
details of all remuneration matters.
We greatly value engagement with our shareholders and 
the constructive feedback we receive on remuneration 
issues. I look forward to your continued support at the 
forthcoming Annual General Meeting, and will be available 
to address any questions you might have in respect to the 
Committee’s activities.
ALICE AVIS MBE  |  Remuneration Committee Chair
“Our remuneration Policy, and 
its application, is designed to 
provide alignment with the 
Group’s performance, strategic 
progress and stakeholder 
interests, to ensure rewards are 
performance-based and fair.”
Alice Avis MBE  |  Remuneration Committee 
Chair
Committee membership and meetings
Meetings
Alice Avis 
3 (3)
Mark Pain
3 (3)
Martin Ratchford
3 (3)
Clair Preston-Beer 
3 (3)

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Governance report
124
Annual Statement 
2024 performance and reward
The Group delivered another strong operational performance in 2024, with like for like 
rental growth across the financial year in excess of nine per cent, strong occupancy and 
improved customer service scores. Market conditions have however been challenging, 
in particular with respect to continued inflationary cost pressure and changes in 
government policy.
In October, the Company made the decision to terminate its prospective joint venture 
discussions in favour of an equity raise, which was successfully concluded. Although 
a little later than envisaged, the Group has now begun to make good progress on its 
growth agenda with three new acquisitions added to the Group’s portfolio and funding  
in place to roll out our postgraduate exclusive product independently.
With the Company’s growth strategy secured and its delivery in sharp focus, the Board 
has confirmed its intention to increase its dividend for the 2024 financial year by six per 
cent, from a target of 3.5 pence per share to 3.7 pence per share.
The Group’s philosophy is to provide students with a ‘Home from Home’. Our customer-
first philosophy, coupled with a boutique, personalised experience in a safe and 
welcoming environment enables them to make the most of their time at university. 
During the year the Group succeeded in achieving further improvement in overall 
customer satisfaction scores. This is reflected in the results from the latest annual 
GSLI survey which shows our Net Promoter Score continuing to improve from +30.5 to 
+32, significantly outperforming the benchmark score for All Private Halls score which 
received +19. During the year, GSLI awarded our operating brand, Hello Student, with 
the accolade for best student wellbeing, in recognition of the work undertaken in recent 
years to address this increasingly important aspect of our service proposition.
Despite this performance and the good progress made in respect of personal strategic 
objectives, inflationary challenges particularly in respect of utility and employment 
related costs have resulted in a significant reduction in the formulaic outcome for 
Duncan Garrood and Donald Grant’s annual bonus award to 28.9 per cent and 26.5 per 
cent of maximum respectively. 
The availability of the maximum Group-wide bonus opportunity for 2024 was linked 
to the delivery of a targeted gross margin of 70 per cent and delivery of an inflation-
adjusted increase in underlying overhead costs. As these targets were not met in full, 
the available Group-wide bonus pool was reduced and, accordingly, a discretionary 
reduction was applied to the formulaic outcome of all employees’ annual bonuses. In 
respect of the Executive Directors, post application of discretion by the Committee, 
Duncan Garrood was awarded 13.9 per cent of his maximum annual bonus opportunity, 
with Donald Grant achieving 12.7 per cent.
The three-year performance period for the LTIP award granted to Duncan Garrood on 
24 March 2022 ended during 2024. The award was subject to two equally weighted 
performance conditions, relative Total Shareholder Return and Total Return (being 
growth in NAV per shares plus dividend paid). Taking both performance measures 
collectively, overall vesting of 67.7 per cent was achieved. In line with the Remuneration 
Policy, vested awards remain subject to a further two-year holding period before they 
become exercisable. The Committee believes that the LTIP continues to promote the 
right behaviours to support the Company’s strategy, performance and values. 
Full details of the 2024 reward outcomes are set out on pages 131 to 136.
Workplace Engagement and Remuneration
Our employees play a critical role in delivering an outstanding service experience which 
is central to our brand proposition. To ensure that we continue to attract and retain 
talent, the Group strives to reward its employees with a compensation package that 
ensures we remain competitive. We are proud to compensate our employees in line with 
the Real Living Wage Foundations recommendations.
During 2024, the Committee reviewed pay and benefits across the wider workforce, 
with particular consideration given to the ongoing impact of the rate of inflation and the 
impact of the Real Living Wage increase. The 2024 annual pay review for the workforce 
resulted in an average salary increase of 4.4 per cent. The annual review will be moved 
from 1 January to 1 April from 2025 and will result in an average salary increase of 4.1 
per cent, with our lowest paid employees continuing to receive increases in line with 
the Real Living Wage, which for 2024 was above the rate of inflation at five per cent. 
Acknowledging of the change in the effective date for annual pay reviews, we have 
awarded each employee an additional day’s annual leave in 2025.
Remuneration committee report | continued

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Governance report
125
The Company launched a three year Sharesave scheme in July 2021, allowing employees 
the opportunity to buy into the success of the Company. The 2021 intake vested this year, 
with 18 employees exercising their vested awards in 2024, with another 30 employees 
electing into the scheme in 2024. Of all eligible employees, 18 per cent now participate in 
the scheme. 
Having reviewed employee compensation arrangements, the Committee is satisfied that 
employee pay and conditions remain fair and proportionate.
The One Team Collective is the Group workforce advisory panel consisting of eleven 
representatives from across the Group. Its focus is to support and facilitate two-way 
communication and feedback between the workforce and senior leaders on topics 
raised by employees. As the Company’s Senior Independent Director and Remuneration 
Committee Chair, I was appointed to lead workforce engagement on behalf of the 
Board. In 2024 I met with the OTC at all four meetings held to discuss key topics arising. 
Relevant issues and insights from these sessions were then shared with the executive 
team and Board to inform discussions. 
Separately in 2024, the executive committee travelled to three locations across the UK 
to facilitate one to one interaction with all Group’s employees. Last undertaken in 2022, 
the format of these sessions was well received, providing an opportunity for employees 
to better understand strategic plans and priorities and to provide a forum for everyone to 
ask questions and engage with the executive team for a day in an informal environment.
Our new team member engagement survey launched in 2024 and delivered a three 
percentage point above benchmark engagement score of 78 per cent, putting us in the 
top 25 per cent of companies with 200 – 500 employees across the UK. 90 per cent of 
people stated they were “proud to work for the Group” and 90 per cent stated that they 
recommend the Group as a “great place to work”. Our eNPS (employee net promoter 
score) was 37 points above the UK median.
Throughout the year we maintained strong retention across the Group and achieved 
retention rate of 78 per cent for the year to 31 December 2024. We have invested in 
leadership development opportunities for a group of senior leaders identified as 
brightest stars demonstrating potential to be successors to the executive committee. 
Our ‘Hello Future Stars’ programme, supported by external apprenticeship programmes, 
supports the development of these aspiring leaders. Investing and supporting 
development has helped us to fill 61 per cent of vacancies internally.
Gender Pay
The Group believes that creating a diverse and gender balanced workforce enhances the 
customer experience and improves the experience employees have at work. We provide 
learning and development opportunities for all team members and champion internal 
progression for all. 
We are required to report upon the gender pay gap within our subsidiary, Hello Student 
Management Limited. Analysis based on data to 5 April 2024 demonstrates that the 
mean gender pay gap is -0.9 per cent (with females paid more than males) and the mean 
gender bonus gap is -13.1 per cent (females paid higher bonuses than males). 
This represents a marginal improvement in favour of females in respect to the gender pay 
gap, and in favour of males in respect of the bonus pay gap. This continues to illustrate 
the level of female representation in the upper middle and upper quartiles, with increases 
of four per cent and five per cent respectively with a six per cent reduction in female 
representation in the lower quartile.
We are pleased with the progress made to date and remain committed to improving 
our position to attract a diverse selection pool for vacancies and ensure we recruit the 
most suitable candidate for a role regardless of gender. The Committee is satisfied that 
equivalent roles attract equivalent remuneration, regardless of gender. 
Full details with a supporting narrative are published on our Hello Student website,  
www hellostudent.co.uk, and are prepared in line with the UK Equality Act 2010  
(Gender Pay Gap Information) Regulations Act 2017.
CEO Pay Ratio and Internal Proportionality
Under the requirements introduced by The Companies (Miscellaneous Reporting) 
Regulations 2018 we have calculated the CEO to employee pay ratio for the Group.
Using the methodology, the CEO pay ratio, when compared against the median  
employee, is 36:1 with full details set out on page 138, the Remuneration Committee 
believes in reward packages that are externally competitive and internally proportionate, 
meaning the CEO is the employee with the highest proportion of variable pay as he has 
the highest level of responsibility. The ratio includes the value of vested LTIP awards 
that were granted to Duncan Garrood in March 2022, as is required by the reporting 
regulations and so is higher than the years 2019-2022 when no LTIP awards vested to the 
in-post CEO.
Excluding the value of vesting LTIP awards, which are subject to a further two-year 
holding period before they become exercisable, the pay ratio remains below 2019 pre-
Pandemic median, 25th and 75th percentiles, demonstrating our continued investment in 
the pay and reward of our workforce. 

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Governance report
126
Remuneration committee report | continued
2025 reward decisions
The Committee commissioned a benchmarking exercise to review the CEO and 
CFSO’s base salary. As part of this review the Committee took advice from Deloitte, 
our independent remuneration consultant. It was concluded, on the basis of Group 
performance and a recommendation from management that the highest workforce pay 
band receive a nil increase in salaries in 2025, that it would be inappropriate to increase 
executive Director salaries in 2025. The average annual salary increase awarded to the 
workforce as a whole was 4.1 per cent and will take effect from 1 April 2025. 
The executive bonus plan arrangements for 2025 will follow the same structure as in 
2024, with a maximum annual opportunity restricted to 110 per cent of salary. There are 
three equally weighted financial measures, which when combined, account for two thirds 
of the maximum opportunity. These financial measures, as in 2024, are based on revenue, 
EBITDA and dividend. One third of the maximum opportunity is linked to specific 
individual objectives based on strategic key performance indicators and will continue to 
include ESG related objectives. 
Both executive Directors will receive LTIP awards in 2025, as was the case in 2024, over 
shares worth 150 per cent of salary. As in 2024, the vesting of the LTIP award will be 
subject to two performance measures, relative Total Shareholder Return and Total Return, 
each representing 50 per cent of the award for the performance period 1 January 2025 to 
31 December 2027. 
Strategic and Shareholder alignment
In setting executive remuneration in 2025, the Committee has continued to seek 
alignment with the Company’s strategic priorities and shareholder interests. In particular:
	î annual bonus performance measures continue to be focused on objectives critical to 
delivering the improvement in corporate performance, optimising revenue, EBITDA and 
dividends, together with individual specific strategic objectives;
	î executives are aligned with the principle of shareholder value creation through 
participation in the long-term incentive plan that rewards growth in Net Asset Value 
plus dividends and relative shareholder returns; 
	î the executive Directors are required to build up and retain significant holdings in the 
Company’s shares equivalent to 200 per cent of salary which directly align them with 
other shareholders; and 
	î the Remuneration Committee is acutely aware of the need to align executive 
remuneration, and that of the rest of the workforce, with shareholder returns while fully 
recognising that remuneration should motivate and reward continued performance, 
hard work and commitment. 
Full details of how the Remuneration Policy will be applied during 2025, as well as how 
Directors were paid in 2024, are set out on pages 131 to 136. There will be an advisory 
shareholder vote on this section of the Remuneration Report at our 2025 Annual General 
Meeting. During the coming year, we will review our Remuneration Policy ahead of the 
standard triennial shareholder approval in 2026 and we will, as usual, consult in advance 
with shareholders to discuss changes proposed.
Alice Avis MBE  |  Remuneration Committee Chair
12 March 2025

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Governance report
127
Summary of the Remuneration Policy
There is no shareholder vote on the Remuneration Policy at the 2025 Annual General Meeting, but for shareholders’ reference, a summary of the policy containing the Policy Tables for 
the executive Directors, the Chairman and non-executive Directors has been included below. The full Policy can be found on pages 87 to 94 of the Annual Report and Accounts 2022, 
which is available on our website at www.empiric.co.uk.
It is currently envisaged that the Policy will next be presented to Shareholders for approval at the 2026 Annual General Meeting.
Remuneration Policy Table for executive Directors
Fixed pay
Component
Purpose and link to strategy
Operation
Maximum
Performance framework
Base salary
Core element of 
remuneration set 
at a level to attract 
and retain executive 
Directors of the 
required calibre to 
deliver the Company’s 
investment objectives 
successfully.
Fixed cash paid monthly, generally 
reviewed annually. The review takes 
into consideration a number of factors, 
including but not limited to:
•	 the individual Director’s role, 
experience and performance;
•	 business performance;
•	 relevant data on remuneration levels 
paid for comparable roles; and
•	 pay and conditions elsewhere in  
the Group.
To avoid setting the expectations 
of executive Directors and other 
employees, there is no overall maximum 
salary for executive Directors under 
the Remuneration Policy. Any increase 
in salaries will be determined by the 
Remuneration Committee, taking into 
account the factors stated in this table 
and the following principles:
•	 salary increases for executive Directors 
will typically not exceed the average 
salary increase (in percentage of salary 
terms) for other permanent employees. 
•	 increases may be made above this in 
certain circumstances, such as: 
•	 progression within the role; 
•	 increase in scope and responsibility of 
the role; 
•	 increase in experience where an 
individual has been recruited on a lower 
salary initially; and 
•	 increase in size and complexity of the 
Company.
None
Benefits
To provide market-
competitive benefits.
Benefits are role specific and take into 
account local market practice.
Benefits currently include (but are not 
limited to) reimbursed travel expenses, 
medical insurance, disability and life 
insurance and a car allowance. 
There is no overall maximum level, but 
benefits are set at an appropriate level 
for the specific nature of the role and 
depend on the annual cost of providing 
individual benefits.
None

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Governance report
128
Component
Purpose and link to strategy
Operation
Maximum
Performance framework
Pension
To provide market-
competitive retirement 
benefits.
The Company either contributes 
to the Directors’ personal pension 
arrangements or direct to their  
pension plans. 
Alternatively, Directors may receive a 
cash allowance in lieu of pension.
All Directors’ pension provision capped 
in line with provision available to the 
majority of the workforce, currently 7.5% 
of salary.
None.
Variable Remuneration
Annual and 
deferred annual 
bonus
To link reward to the 
achievement of key 
business objectives for 
the year.
To provide additional 
alignment with 
shareholders’ interests 
through the operation 
of bonus deferral.
The executive Directors are participants 
in the annual bonus plan which is 
reviewed annually to ensure bonus 
opportunity, performance measures and 
targets and objectives are appropriate 
and support the business strategy.
The Committee will determine the level of 
bonus to be awarded, taking into account 
the extent to which the targets have been 
met and overall business and personal 
performance.
Up to 60% of an executive Director’s 
annual bonus will usually be paid in cash 
following the release of the audited 
results of the business.
At least 40% of any bonus is usually 
deferred into an award over Company 
shares issued as a nil-cost option 
pursuant to the terms of the LTIP, which 
will usually be deferred for three years.
Dividend equivalents will be paid usually 
in additional shares when the deferred 
shares are released.
Malus and clawback may be applied to a 
cash or deferred bonus award up to three 
years from the date of determination of 
the bonus or award.
The maximum annual bonus opportunity 
is 150% of base salary per annum.
Each year the Remuneration Committee 
will determine the maximum annual 
bonus opportunity for each individual 
executive Director within this limit.
The bonus is based on performance 
assessed over one year using appropriate 
financial, strategic, ESG and personal 
performance measures.
The selected measures for the next financial 
year will be set out in the Remuneration 
section of the Annual Report for that year.
Remuneration committee report | continued

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Governance report
129
Component
Purpose and link to strategy
Operation
Maximum
Performance framework
Long Term 
Incentive Plan 
(“LTIP”)
To link reward for the 
Executive Directors 
to the achievement of 
long-term performance 
objectives of the 
Company which are 
aligned to the strategic 
goals and to retain 
executives.
Awards under the LTIP will usually be 
made in the form of a contingent award 
of shares or grant of nil-cost options or 
nominal value options.
Vesting of the award is dependent on 
the achievement of performance targets, 
typically measured over a three-year period.
Vested awards will be subject to an 
additional two-year holding period.
Dividend equivalents will be paid usually 
in additional shares when the LTIP awards 
are released.
Malus and clawback can be applied to  
LTIP awards up to five years from the date 
of grant.
The maximum LTIP award that may be 
made is up to 150% of base salary per 
annum as provided for in plan rules, but 
for the avoidance of doubt this excludes 
any nil -cost options issued pursuant to 
an award under the annual bonus scheme.
Vesting of LTIP awards is dependent on the 
achievement of performance measures 
determined by the Committee ahead of 
each award. These details will be disclosed 
in the Annual Report on Remuneration 
section of the Remuneration Report.
Performance will usually be measured 
over a three-year performance period. 
For achieving a “threshold” level of 
performance against a performance 
measure, no more than 25% of the award 
will vest.
Vesting then increases on a sliding scale to 
100% for achieving a stretching maximum 
performance target.
Employee Share 
Option Plan (“ESOP”) 
Executive Directors 
will only be granted 
share options 
under the ESOP 
in exceptional 
circumstances.
To reward employees 
for the delivery of long-
term shareholder value.
The ESOP permits the grant of share 
options with an exercise price of not 
less than the market value of a share (as 
determined by the Committee) at the 
time of grant. Options will usually be 
exercisable between three and ten years 
following the grant.
Share options may be granted under an 
HMRC approved Company Share Option 
Plan to the extent possible.
If ESOP awards were, in exceptional 
circumstances, granted to an executive 
Director, they would be subject to an 
appropriate performance condition as 
determined by the Committee.
All-employee  
share plans
To reward employees 
for the delivery of long-
term shareholder value.
Executive Directors may participate on 
the same basis as other employees.
Participants may contribute up to the 
relevant limits set out in the plan.
Remuneration Policy Table for the Chairman and non-executive Directors
Purpose and link  
to strategy
Operation
Opportunity
To attract and 
retain non-
executive 
Directors of 
the required 
calibre by 
offering market-
competitive fees.
The Chairman of the Board receives an all-inclusive fee. Non-executive Directors receive a basic Board fee.
Additional fees may be payable for additional Board responsibilities such as acting as the Senior Independent 
Director, chairmanship or membership of a Board Committee.
The Committee reviews the fees paid to the Chairman and the Board reviews the fees paid to the Non-executive 
Directors periodically.
Additional fees may be paid to non-executive Directors on a per diem basis to reflect increased time 
commitment in certain limited circumstances.
Expenses incurred in the performance of non-executive duties for the Company may be reimbursed or paid 
directly by the Company, as appropriate, including any tax and social security contributions due on the expenses.
Non-executive Directors may be provided with benefits to enable them to undertake their duties.
Fees are set at an appropriate level that is 
market competitive and reflective of the 
responsibilities and time commitment 
associated with specific roles.
The total aggregate fees payable to the 
Chairman and non-executive Directors 
will not exceed the £400,000 limit stated 
in the Company’s Articles of Association.
Non-executive remuneration does not 
include performance related pay.

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Governance report
130
Annual Report on Remuneration
The Annual Report on Remuneration will be subject to an advisory shareholder vote at the 
2025 Annual General Meeting.
Implementation of the Remuneration Policy in 2025
This section provides an overview of how the Committee intends to implement the 
Remuneration Policy during 2025.
Base salary
The executives’ salaries were reviewed in December 2024. It was concluded that annual 
pay reviews would be revised to take effect from 1 April 2025. The Committee reviewed 
a recommendation from management that the highest workforce pay band (Band 
Nine) receive a nil increase in salaries in 2025. After due consideration, it was therefore 
considered appropriate that Executive Director salary adjustments be aligned to those 
in Band Nine with no increase applied in April 2025. The average annual salary increase 
awarded to the workforce will be 4.1 per cent. 
Executive Director salaries alongside current salaries, are set out below. For information, 
an annual salary increase of 3.0 per cent was awarded to both executive Directors  
in 2024.
Executive Director
Prior salary
Current salary
Duncan Garrood
£439,192 fixed  
1 January 2024
£439,192 with effect from  
1 April 2025
Donald Grant
£310,648 fixed  
1 January 2024
£310,648 with effect from  
1 April 2025
Pension and benefits
Executive Directors will be provided with a standard benefits package including pension 
provision of 7.5 per cent of salary, medical insurance, life insurance, and car allowance of 
£15,000 for the CEO and £9,662 for the CFSO.
The pension provision of 7.5 per cent is aligned to that provided to the majority of  
the workforce.
Annual and deferred annual bonus
The maximum pay out under the annual bonus scheme is unchanged at 110 per cent of 
salary, with at least 40 per cent of any bonus satisfied by the issue of nil-cost options, 
which will be deferred for three years.
The annual bonus will be determined by three equally weighted financial performance 
measures, accounting for two thirds of the bonus opportunity. In 2025 these will 
continue to be linked to revenue, EBITDA and dividend payment. The balance, being 
one third of the bonus opportunity, is linked to the achievement of specific individual 
objectives derived from strategic key performance indicators, including ESG-related 
objectives. Notwithstanding the formulaic outcome against these measures, the 
Committee will continue to consider carefully overall business performance at the  
year-end and determine whether the exercise of discretion is warranted.
The targets and out turn against these measures will be disclosed in the Remuneration 
Report for the year ending 31 December 2025. Any bonus pay out will be subject to the 
Committee confirming that, in its assessment, the financial out turns which determined 
the bonus were achieved within an acceptable risk profile. Malus and clawback may be 
applied to a cash or deferred bonus up to three years from the date of determination of 
the bonus or award. 
LTIP
Duncan Garrood and Donald Grant will receive LTIP awards for 2025 equivalent to 150 
per cent of salary, with the number of shares usually determined by the average share 
price in the 12 months preceding the date of grant, or in exceptional circumstances such 
other share price deemed appropriate by the Committee. As in 2024, the vesting of the 
LTIP award is subject to two performance measures each representing 50 per cent of the 
award. 
Firstly, Total Accounting Return (“TAR”) relative to threshold and maximum targets for 
the period 1 January 2025 to 31 December 2027, with TAR being the combined growth in 
net asset value and dividends paid during the period. 25 per cent of the award will vest 
for meeting a threshold TAR target of 6 per cent per annum, increasing to 100 per cent 
vesting for meeting a maximum target of 10 per cent per annum, with straight line vesting 
between threshold and maximum performance.
Secondly, Total Shareholder Return (“TSR”) relative to the FTSE All Share Real Estate 
Companies peer group, with 25 per cent of the award for median performance and 100 
per cent for achieving performance within the 75th percentile, with straight line vesting 
between threshold and maximum performance, for the period 1 January 2025 to 31 
December 2027.
Any LTIP vesting will again be subject to the Committee confirming that, in its 
assessment, the vesting out turn was achieved within an acceptable risk profile. The 
Committee will continue to have discretion to override formulaic outcomes. 
Malus and clawback may be applied to LTIP awards up to five years from the date of grant, 
which is in line with the UK Corporate Governance Code. Vested awards will be subject to 
an additional two-year holding period.
Remuneration committee report | continued

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Governance report
131
Non-executive Director remuneration
The fee structure for the remuneration of non-executive Directors from 1 April 2025 is outlined in the table below. This fee structure had, until 1 April 2024, remained unchanged  
since 1 July 2016. 
Non-executive Director fees are determined by the Board, except for the fee for the Chairman of the Board, which is determined by the Remuneration Committee.
Annual fee (£)
(applied from  
1 April 2024)
Annual fee (£)
(to apply from  
1 April 2025) 
Base fee
£41,200
£41,200 
Audit Committee Chairman
£49,440
£49,440 
Remuneration Committee Chairman
£49,440
£49,440 
Senior Independent Director
£50,470
£50,470 
Senior Independent Director & Committee Chair
£54,075
£54,075 
Chairman of the Board
£135,000
£135,000 
Non-executive Directors, other than the Chairman, received a three per cent increase in fee during 2024, in line with the executive Directors. No fee adjustment has been awarded  
for 2025.
During 2024, the Remuneration Committee undertook a review of the fee paid to the Company Chairman. His fee had not been increased since 2016 and, as a result, was considered 
one of the lowest in the FTSE All-Share. The Committee’s view was that this was not consistent with the Company’s development into a FTSE 250 constituent or the enhanced level of 
time commitment associated with the Chairman’s role as the Company has grown in recent years. In order to address this issue, the Committee had intended to align the fee to a more 
market competitive level in a phased manner with an initial increase in fee of 17.4 per cent to £135,000 awarded from 1 April 2024. In light of executive and non-executive Director pay 
decisions for 2025, it was considered appropriate to pause the phased increase of the Chairman’s fee in 2025 and to revisit in 2026.
Remuneration outcome in 2024
Single total figure of remuneration (audited)
The following table sets out the total remuneration for executive Directors and non-executive Directors for the year ended 31 December 2024 alongside the equivalent data for the 
previous year.
Year ended 31 December 2024
Salary
and fees
(£)
Benefits
(£)
Pension
(£)
Total Fixed
(£)
Annual
bonus (£)
Long-term
incentives
(£)
Total
Variable
(£)
Total
(£)
Executive Directors
Duncan Garrood
439,192
18,601 
32,939 
490,732
67,070
427,506
494,576
985,308
Donald Grant 
310,648
14,418
23,299
348,365
43,500
–
43,500
391,865
Non-executive Directors
 
Mark Pain
130,000
–
–
130,000
–
–
–
130,000
Alice Avis 
53,681
–
–
53,681
–
–
–
53,681
Martin Ratchford
49,080
–
–
49,080
–
–
–
49,080
Clair Preston-Beer 
40,900
–
–
40,900
–
–
–
40,900

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Governance report
132
Year ended 31 December 2023
Salary
and fees
(£)
Benefits
(£)
Pension
(£)
Total Fixed
(£)
Annual
bonus (£)
Long-term
incentives1
(£)
Total
Variable
(£)
Total
(£)
Executive Directors
Duncan Garrood
426,400
18,138 
31,980 
476,518
308,628
730,503
1,039,131
1,515,649
Donald Grant
301,600
13,490
22,620
337,710
218,298
–
218,298
556,008
Non-executive Directors
 
 
 
 
 
Mark Pain
115,000
–
–
115,000
–
–
–
115,000
Alice Avis
52,500
–
–
52,500
–
–
–
52,500
Martin Ratchford
48,000
–
–
48,000
–
–
–
48,000
Clair Preston-Beer
40,000
–
–
40,000
–
–
–
40,000
1	
Restated to reflect the share price on date of vesting of the April 2021 award of 90.8 pence per share.
Notes to the single figure table
Salary and fees: This represents the cash paid or receivable in respect of the relevant financial year.
Benefits: This represents the taxable value of all benefits paid or receivable in respect of the relevant financial year. Executive Directors receive a standard benefits package including 
medical insurance, life insurance and car allowance.
Annual bonus: Total bonus payable for the relevant financial year, whether payable in cash or as a deferred share award.
Long-term incentives: This relates to the value of long-term awards where the applicable three-year performance period ends in the year under review. The Committee determined 
that the performance conditions for the awards granted in March 2022 had been met in part. The March 2022 awards have been valued at 90.0 pence (average share price for the 
fourth quarter of 2024) and £11,258 of the value shown for Duncan Garrood relates to share price appreciation during the vesting period.
Pension: Duncan Garrood and Donald Grant have received a Company contribution worth 7.5 per cent of base salary in both 2024 and 2023. Both executive Directors elected to 
receive a cash allowance in lieu of pension.
Additional disclosures in respect of the single figure table (audited)
2024 annual bonus
Duncan Garrood and Donald Grant participated in the 2024 annual bonus scheme with a maximum annual bonus opportunity restricted to 110 per cent of salary, based on the 
performance targets set out below.
The maximum potential annual bonus that could be paid to the executive Directors in respect of the year ended 31 December 2024 was determined by three equally weighted financial 
measures, which when combined account for two thirds of the maximum opportunity. These financial measures are based on revenue, EBITDA and dividend. One third of the maximum 
opportunity is linked to specific individual objectives based on strategic key performance indicators, including ESG related objectives.
Remuneration committee report | continued

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Governance report
133
Achievement against financial performance targets for both Duncan Garrood and Donald Grant are set out below:
Financial performance measure
Proportion of bonus
determined by measure
Threshold
Performance
0% payable
Maximum
performance
100% payable
Actual
performance
% of maximum
bonus payable
Absolute revenue 
22.2%
£83.7m
£88.4m
£84.2m
2.4%
EBITDA 
22.2%
£44.9m
£47.5m
£43.9m
0.0%
Dividends paid, declared and fully covered
22.2%
3.4 pence
4.0 pence
3.7 pence
11.1%
Total out turn on financial performance measures
66.6%
13.5%
Achievement against individual performance objectives are set out below:
Duncan Garrood
Objective
Out turn
Outcome
The delivery of the corporate strategy, including:
a)	 Deliver a value creating joint venture; 
b)	 Like for like rental growth above six per cent;
c)	 Deliver an accelerated implementation of green capex investments with IRR 
above five per cent;
d)	Recycle at least £20.0 million of residual non-core properties by year.
Progressed delivery of corporate strategy with like for like rental growth of 9.3 per 
cent for the 2024 financial year (10.5 per cent and 7.0 per cent for the academic 
years 2023/24 and 2024/25, respectively). 
Green capex of £2.4 million invested delivering returns in line with target.
Non-core disposals totalling £45.2 million achieved, with over £20.0 million 
reinvested in top-tier acquisitions during the year.
Joint venture terminated in favour of pursuing growth strategy independently, 
with successful equity placement concluded.

Develop workplace engagement and culture to bring an improved performance on 
community and charitable support, internal talent development and health & safety 
compliance, in particular:
a)	 Employee survey to deliver an employee engagement score of 85 per cent  
or above; 
b)	 Internal promotions to rise to 55 per cent and voluntary turnover to remain at  
20 per cent of below;
c)	 Team members to allocate a minimum of 300 days to Community and 
Charitable support.
Maintained strong workplace engagement, but fell short of target at 78 per cent.
Of all eligible vacancies in 2024, 61 per cent were filled by means of internal 
promotion. Voluntary turnover was 22 per cent during the year.
The Group invested 344 days in support of community and charitable support 
during 2024.

Develop and deliver tangible customer service improvements, including:
a)	 Year-end NPS +33 or more measured by GSLI; 
b)	 Year end Student Crowd ranking at seven or better;
c)	 Drive utility consumption below 4,250 kWh per bed;
d)	Resolve 70% of service requests from the customer app within 72 hours.
Further progress made on improving the customer service focus with Net 
Promoter Score rising again to +32.
Hello Student achieved a December 2024 Student Crowd rating of eight.
Utility consumption per bed reduced to 4,351 kWh in 2024.
Over 17,800 maintenance requests were resolved during 2024, 68.6 per cent of 
which within 72 hours.


Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Governance report
134
Remuneration committee report | continued
Donald Grant
Objective
Out turn
Outcome
Delivery of corporate strategy, including:
a)	 Overhead costs not to exceed 16.5 per cent of revenue (excluding depreciation);
b)	 Deliver £125 million refinancing on terms approved by the Board;
c)	 Deliver a value creating joint venture.
Administrative overheads, adjusted for depreciation charges represent 17.0 per 
cent of revenue for 2024.
Refinancing concluded on terms approved by the Board removing near term 
refinancing risk.
Joint venture terminated in favour of pursuing growth strategy independently, 
with successful equity placement concluded.

Execute Net Zero implementation plan to deliver Net Zero by 2033, through:
a)	 Deliver an accelerated implementation of green capex investments with IRR 
above five per cent;
b)	 Manage EPC risk achieving >55 per cent of the portfolio rated EPC B or better;
c)	 Drive energy consumption down to 4,250 kWh per bed, or better.
Green capex of £2.4 million invested delivering returns in line with target.
Significant improvement in EPC ratings with 64 per cent now rated EPC B or better. 
Utility consumption per bed reduced to 4,351 kWh in 2024.

Develop finance and IT to become best-in-class functions, by:
a)	 Improved structure, capability and diversity of the finance function to be 
measured by an improved internal service score, with less than ten per cent 
responding that improvement is required;
b)	 Improved structure, capabilities and engagement of the IT function to be 
measured by an improved internal service score, with less than ten per cent 
responding that improvement is required and with 95 per cent of support calls 
resolved within SLA;
c)	 Deliver new ERP system ensuring milestones achieved for go-live for 2025. 
Delivery to be achieved within three per cent of budget.
Structure, capability and diversity of finance function improved. Service and 
engagement target missed.
Structure and capability improvement targets for the IT function achieved. 
Support calls resolved within SLA marginally below target at 92 per cent.
Implementation of new ERP system delayed until July 2025.

Key: 
	
Some progress
	
Good progress
	 Excellent progress
The tables below summarise the annual bonus awards made in respect of the 2024 financial year. Although Policy maximum is set at 150 per cent, the Committee had committed to an 
annual maximum in respect of 2024 of 110 per cent.
Duncan Garrood
Proportion of bonus
determined by measure
% of maximum
bonus payable
Total out turn on financial performance measures
66.6%
13.5%
Individual specific objectives1
33.4%
15.4%
Total before application of Committee discretion
28.9%
Total after application of Committee discretion
13.9%

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Governance report
135
Donald Grant
Proportion of bonus
determined by 
measure
% of maximum
bonus payable
Total out turn on financial performance measures
66.6%
13.5%
Individual specific objectives1
33.4%
13.0%
Total before application of Committee discretion
26.5%
Total after application of Committee discretion
12.7%
1 	
Individual objectives were subject to a dividend related unlock. This element of the annual bonus would not unlock unless a minimum 3.5 pence per share fully covered dividend had been paid or declared to shareholders in respect to 
the financial year. This unlock was achieved.
The availability of the maximum Group-wide bonus opportunity for 2024 was linked to the delivery of a targeted gross margin of 70 per cent and delivery of an inflation-adjusted 
increase in underlying overhead costs. As these targets were not met in full, the available Group-wide bonus pool was reduced and, accordingly, a discretionary reduction was applied 
to the formulaic outcome of all employees’ annual bonuses. In respect of the executive Directors, post application of discretion by the Committee, Duncan Garrood was awarded  
13.9 per cent of his maximum annual bonus opportunity, with Donald Grant achieving 12.7 per cent.
Bonus award 
percentage
of 2024 maximum
Bonus paid in cash
Bonus awarded in
deferred shares1
Total bonus
Duncan Garrood
13.9%
£40,242
£26,828
£67,070
Donald Grant
12.7%
£26,100
£17,400
£43,500
1	
To be settled in shares following a three year vesting period from date of grant.
LTIP vesting
During 2024, the performance period for the 2022 LTIP award date ended. The Committee determined that the performance conditions for awards granted on 24 March 2022 had 
been partially met, as illustrated below.
Weighting
0%  
vesting
25%  
vesting
100%  
vesting
Performance  
achieved
Vesting level (% of 
maximum)
TSR relative to FTSE All-Share Real Estate peer group
3 years to 31 December 2024
50%
Below median
Median
Upper quartile
Above upper quartile
100%
Total Return (CAGR)
3 years to 31 December 2024
50%
Less than 6%
6%
10%
6.55%
35.4%
Overall vesting
67.7%
In line with the Remuneration Policy, vested awards remain subject to a further two year holding period before they become exercisable, however the value of the vested award is 
included within the single figure remuneration table for the year ended 31 December 2024.
Scheme interests awarded during the financial year (audited)
Long-term incentive plan awards
Long-term incentive plan awards are granted over the Company’s shares with the number of shares under award determined by reference to a percentage of base salary. Vesting of 
the awards is conditional upon satisfaction of performance conditions and is usually also conditional upon continued employment until the awards vest on the third anniversary of 
grant. Vesting is subject to an additional two-year holding period.

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Governance report
136
The following table provides details of the LTIP award granted to Duncan Garrood and Donald Grant on 12 April 2024
Type of award
Maximum
number
of shares
Face value
£
Threshold
vesting
End of
performance
period
Duncan Garrood
LTIP
728,294
658,788
25% of award
31 December 2026
Donald Grant
LTIP
515,135
465,972
25% of award
31 December 2026
Both executive Directors were entitled to an LTIP award over shares worth 150 per cent of their annual salary at the start of the year. The maximum number of shares awarded (and their 
face value in the above table) was calculated using a Company share price of 90.46 pence, representing the average of the daily closing prices of the Company’s ordinary shares on the 
London Stock Exchange for the 12-month period ended 31 March 2024. 
Vesting of these awards is subject to two performance measures each being 50 per cent of the award. Firstly, Total Accounting Return (“TAR”) relative to threshold and maximum 
targets for the periods 1 January 2024 to 31 December 2026, with TAR being the combined net asset value growth and dividends paid. 25 per cent of the award will vest for meeting a 
threshold TAR target of 6 per cent per annum, increasing to 100 per cent vesting for meeting a maximum target of 10 per cent per annum. Secondly, Total Shareholder Return (“TSR”) 
relative to the FTSE All Share Real Estate Companies peer group, with 25 per cent of the award for median performance and 100 per cent for 75th percentile performance  
(with straight-line vesting between) for the period 1 January 2024 to 31 December 2026.
Payments to past directors (audited)
There were no payments to past Directors during 2024.
Payments for loss of office (audited)
There were no payments for loss of office to past Directors during 2024.
Statement of Directors’ shareholdings and share interests (audited)
The table below shows the Directors’ share ownership as at 31 December 2024.
The standard shareholding guideline is that executive Directors are expected to build up and retain a shareholding worth at least 200 per cent of salary. Subject to the incentive 
plans delivering at least an on target level of award, the guideline is expected to be satisfied within a five-year period of their appointment to the Board. To date these shareholding 
requirements have not been met as both executive Directors have less than five years’ service on the Board and are therefore currently in the build-up phase against this guideline.
Executive Directors are required to maintain their shareholding in accordance with this guideline for two years post-employment (unless the Committee considers a lower limit to be 
appropriate in a particular participant’s circumstances). 
Dividends received 
during the year ended  
31 December 2024
Beneficially  
owned shares at  
31 December 2024
(number of shares)
% of salary1
Vested LTIP awards not yet 
exercisable2
(number of shares)
Outstanding LTIP awards subject 
to performance and employment 
conditions as at  
31 December 20243
(number of shares)
Outstanding annual bonus awards 
subject to employment conditions 
as at 31 December 20244
(number of shares)
Mark Pain
£3,738
120,000
n/a
–
–
–
Duncan Garrood5
£3,819
150,438
28.6%
1,276,881
1,450,527
282,043
Donald Grant
£1,365
54,053
14.5%
–
1,025,983
96,532
Alice Avis
£1,962
59,600
n/a
–
–
–
Martin Ratchford
–
–
n/a
–
–
–
Clair Preston-Beer
–
–
n/a
–
–
–
Remuneration committee report | continued

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Governance report
137
1 	
Value-based on salary effective from 1 January 2024 and the closing share price on 31 December 2024 of 83.5 pence.
2 	
Vested awards subject to two-year holding period. 200,000 shares will become exercisable from 10 November 2025, 601,875  
shares becoming exercisable from 22 April 2026 and a further 475,006 shares exercisable from 24 March 2027.
3 	
These are outstanding LTIP awards subject to the performance conditions disclosed in this or previous Remuneration Reports.
4 	 These are outstanding deferred awards granted pursuant to the annual bonus plan. 
5 	
Included within the beneficially owned shares of Duncan Garrood at 31 December 2024 are 25,316 shares acquired through exercise of 
options awarded under the 2021 employee SAYE option plan.
Between 31 December 2024 and the date of this Report, there were no changes in the shareholdings outlined in the above table.
Performance graph and CEO remuneration table
The chart below compares the TSR performance over the past ten financial years of the Company (i.e. since 1 July 2015) to the FTSE All- Share Index and the FTSE All-Share REIT Index. 
These indices have been chosen because they are recognised equity market indices of which the Company is a member. 
Company Total Shareholder Return performance relative to FTSE All-Share and FTSE All-Share REIT indices
Jul-22
Jul-23
Jul-21
Jul-20
Jul-19
Jul-18
Jul-17
Jul-16
Jul-15
Empiric Student Property
FTSE 350 Real Estate Index
FTSE All Share Index
60
80
100
120
140
160
180
200
Jul-24

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Governance report
138
Chief Executive Officer remuneration outcomes
The table below shows the total remuneration payable to the CEO for the last ten financial periods, and variable pay out turns as a percentage of the maximum opportunity.
12 months
ended
30 June
2016
6 months
ended
31 December
2016
12 months
ended
31 December
2017
12 months
ended
31 December
20181
12 months
ended
31 December
2019
12 months
ended
31 December
20202
12 months
ended
31 December
2021
12 months
ended
31 December
2022
12 months
ended
31 December
2023
12 months
ended
31 December
2024
CEO single figure of remuneration
£748,160
£314,455
£731,442
£539,500
£670,557
£361,041
£491,829
£736,453
£1,515,649
£985,308
Annual bonus pay out (% of maximum)
100%
50%
0%
25.1%
42%
0%
10%
 61.6%
 65.8%
 13.9%
LTIP vesting
n/a
n/a
63.7%
0%
0%
0%
0%
 0%
 60.7%3
 67.7%
1 	
Includes Acting CEO for period 1 January 2018 to 31 October 2018. 
2 	
Combination of Tim Attlee as CEO from 1 January 2020 to 30 June 2020 and Duncan Garrood as CEO from 28 September 2020 to 31 December 2020.
3 	
The performance period of two LTIP awards ended during the financial year to 31 December 2023. The first, an award of 400,000 nil-cost options, awarded on 10 November 2020, shortly after Duncan Garrood’s appointment, 
achieved 50 per cent vesting. The second, an award of 800,000 nil-cost options was the standard annual grant awarded on 22 April 2021 achieved 75.2 per cent vesting. Both vesting awards are subject to a further two-year holding 
period before they become exercisable, but as the performance period has ended, the value of the vesting awards are included with the single figure remuneration table for the year ended 31 December 2023. The figure shown here is 
the weighted average of the two vesting percentages.
CEO Pay Ratio
The UK Companies (Miscellaneous Reporting) Regulations 2018 introduced a requirement for certain UK listed companies to publish the ratio of CEO pay it its UK employees.  
The regulation uses the full year total pay and benefits for all employees and therefore the same methodology that is used to calculate the CEO’s single figure of remuneration on  
page 131. The Committee assesses whether the year on year movement in the ratio is consistent with the Group’s performance and employee reward decisions. 
Year
Method
25th percentile pay 
Median pay
75th percentile pay
2024
Option A
39:1
36:1
26:1
2023
Option A
60:1
55:1
42:1
2022
Option A
32:1
30:1
23:1
2021 
Option A
25:1
22:1
17:1
2020 
Option A
14:1
17:1
18:1
2019
Option A
33:1
31:1
25:1
Lower quartile
Median quartile
Upper quartile
Method
Total pay and benefits
Salary
Total pay and benefits
Salary
Total pay and benefits
Salary
2024
Option A
£25,263
£24,336
£27,510
£25,006
£37,493
£34,000
We have used Option A as we assess it to be the statistically preferred method for calculating the pay ratio.
Figures are calculated based on a reference date of 31 December 2024 (369 employees at this date).
Remuneration for non-executive Directors has not been included in the calculations.
The conversion for part-time colleagues to FTE equivalent uses a standard working week of 37.5 hours and 52 weeks a year.
The ratio includes the value of vested LTIP awards, as is required by reporting regulations. Consequently the 2024 ratio, which includes the value of vested LTIP awards that were 
granted to Duncan Garrood in March 2022, is higher than the equivalent ratios for the years 2019-2022 when no LTIP awards vested to the in-post CEO. Excluding the value of 
vesting LTIP awards, which are subject to a further two-year holding period before they become exercisable, the pay ratio remains below 2019 pre-Pandemic median, 25th and 75th 
percentiles, demonstrating our continued investment in the pay and reward of our workforce. 
The Group adopts a reward framework which is based on consistency with all our employees. Remuneration should remain competitive compared to comparative roles and always 
equal to or more than the Real Living Wage. Our employees are paid using the same principles as the pay for our executive Directors. The median ratio is consistent with the Group’s 
wider policies on pay, reward and progression.
Remuneration committee report | continued

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Governance report
139
Percentage change in remuneration of the Directors
The table below shows the change in the various elements of Director remuneration relative to the change in average employee remuneration between 2023 v 2024 (plus the four 
preceding periods) as set out in the prior year’s Remuneration Report). The table is presented for those Directors who held Board positions throughout both the current and previous year.
Percentages disclosed below are calculated to show the change in the figures within the table entitled Single total figure of remuneration (audited), appearing on page 131. Average 
employee disclosure is based on the full Group because the number of employees employed by the parent company is considered too small to provide a meaningful comparison.
Year to
31 December 2024
Mark Pain
change
Alice Avis
change 
Martin Ratchford
change
Clair Preston-Beer
change
Duncan Garrood
change
Donald Grant
change
Average employee
change
Base salary / fee
+13.0%
+2.2%
+2.2%
+2.2%
+3.0%
+3.0%
+4.4%
Benefits
+0%
+0%
+0%
+0%
+2.6%
+6.9%
+9.7%
Annual bonus
+0%
+0%
+0%
+0%
-78.3%
-80.1%
-64.9%
Year to
31 December 2023
Mark Pain
change
Alice Avis
change 
Martin Ratchford
change
Duncan Garrood
change
Average employee
change
Base salary / fee
+0%
+0%
+0%
+4.0%
+8.3%
Benefits
+0%
+0%
+0%
+1.4%
+5.7%
Annual bonus
+0%
+0%
+0%
+11.1%
+15.8%
Year to
31 December 2022
Mark Pain
change
Alice Avis
change1
Martin Ratchford
change
Duncan Garrood
change
Average employee
change
Base salary / fee
+0%
+21.0%
+0%
+2.5%
+6.9%
Benefits
+0%
+0%
+0%
+0.3%
+18.2%
Annual bonus
+0%
+0%
+0%
+531%
+111.4%
Year to
31 December 2021
Mark Pain
change
Alice Avis
change4 
Martin Ratchford
change2
Duncan Garrood
change3
Average employee
change
Base salary
+0%
+5.6%
+0%
+0%
+4.0%
Benefits
+0%
+0%
+0%
+0%
+0%
Annual bonus
+0%
+0%
+0%
+100%
-100%
Year to
31 December 2020
Mark Pain
change
Alice Avis
change 
Martin Ratchford
change 
Duncan Garrood
change
Average employee
change
Base salary
+0%
+0%
+0%
+0%
+10.0%
Benefits
+0%
+0%
+0%
+0%
+0%
Annual bonus
+0%
+0%
+0%
+0%
+100%
1 	
Alice Avis assumed the Chair of the Remuneration Committee following Stuart Beevor’s retirement and her fee was adjusted accordingly 
2 	
Alice Avis was appointed Senior Independent Director from 1 October 2021 with her fee adjusted accordingly from this date.
3 	
Martin Ratchford joined the Board on 1 October 2021.
4 	 Base salary change from the prior year is calculated with reference to an annualised prior year base salary as Duncan Garrood joined the Board part way through the prior year.

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Governance report
140
Remuneration committee report | continued
Relative importance of spend on pay
The table below sets out the total expenditure on pay for all of the Group’s employees, 
compared to distributions to shareholders by way of dividend.
Year ended
31 December  
2024
Year ended 
31 December  
2023
Total staff costs (Note 6 to the financial statements)
£16.9m
£16.6m
Total dividends
£22.0m
£20.7m
Internal advice
No individual was present when their own remuneration was being discussed.  
The Company Secretary acted as secretary to the Committee. The executives, Chief 
Operating Officer and Head of People joined certain meetings to discuss relevant 
matters, as required.
External advice
Deloitte LLP was appointed by the Company in 2015 to provide independent advice on 
executive remuneration matters, it having no other connection with the Company or with 
its Directors. Although there is no requirement for mandatory rotation of remuneration 
advisers, the current engagement partner has been in post since 2019. 
During the year, the Committee received independent and objective advice from 
Deloitte, principally on the drafting of the Remuneration Report, benchmarking, market 
practice and the valuation of share awards in line with International Financial Reporting 
Standards. Deloitte was paid £24,680 in fees during the year ended 31 December 2024 
for these services (charged on a time plus expense basis). Deloitte is a founding member 
of the Remuneration Consultants Group and, as such, voluntarily operates under the 
Code of Conduct in relation to executive remuneration consulting in the UK. Deloitte 
provided no other services to the Company during this period.
Compliance with the UK Corporate Governance Code
The Committee is mindful of the UK Corporate Governance Code and considers that it 
has appropriately addressed the principles of Provision 40 in the Code:
	î Clarity: This Remuneration Report provides a straightforward and transparent 
disclosure of our executive remuneration arrangements. Alice Avis, the Employee 
Representative on the Board, has discussed the structure, role and remit of the 
Remuneration Committee with the One Team Collective employee forum, explaining 
how the remuneration practices help support the delivery of strategy. Shareholder 
engagement was conducted during Roadshows, with particular interest around the 
LTIP performance conditions. With a review of the Remuneration Policy due to be held 
during 2025, shareholder engagement will be conducted ahead of the triennial vote at 
the 2026 Annual General Meeting. 
	î Simplicity and alignment to culture: Our variable remuneration arrangements are 
straightforward with individuals eligible for an annual bonus and, at more senior levels, 
LTIP awards. Performance measures used in these plans are aligned with key strategic 
objectives and their performance indicators and long-term sustainable value creation. 
	î Predictability: The Policy Tables on pages 127 to 129 contain maximum opportunity 
levels for executive Directors’ bonus and LTIP awards and pension provision. The 
charts on page 92 of the Annual Report & Accounts 2022 provide an illustration of the 
potential total reward opportunity for the executive Directors. LTIP and Bonus awards 
are subject to performance, but may also be subject to discretion and malus and 
clawback provisions. 
	î Proportionality: Our variable remuneration arrangements are designed to provide a fair 
and proportionate link between Group performance and reward. The Committee has 
overriding discretion that allows it to adjust formulaic annual bonus or LTIP outcomes 
so as to prevent disproportionate results. Additionally, we ensure there is a clear link 
between executive remuneration and the longer-term performance of the Group 
through a combination of bonus deferral into shares, five-year release periods for LTIP 
awards and stretching shareholding requirements that apply during and  
post employment. 
	î Risk: Before approving any bonus or LTIP pay out, the Committee confirms that they 
were achieved within an acceptable risk profile. Should any behavioural risks arise, 
malus and clawback provisions apply to both the annual bonus and LTIP awards up to 
three and five years from the date of award respectively, which is in line with the UK 
Corporate Governance Code.

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Governance report
141
Shareholder voting
At the Annual General Meeting of the Company held on 22 May 2024, shareholder 
support was received for the proposed resolutions on remuneration, as  
summarised below:
Votes for
Votes against
Votes withheld
Approval of the Directors’ 
Remuneration Report 
415,178,567 (91.2%)
39,893,651 (8.8%)
22,157
Approval of replacement Long 
Term Incentive Plan
448,055,710 (98.5%)
7,008,386 (1.5%)
30,279
At the Annual General Meeting of the Company held on 24 May 2023, shareholder 
support was received for the proposed resolution on remuneration, as summarised 
below:
Votes for
Votes against
Votes withheld
Approval of the  
Remuneration Policy 
401,730,425 (91.9%)
35,262,666 (8.1%)
39,408
External Board appointments
Executive Directors are only entitled to accept appointments outside the Company with 
the consent of the Board. Any fees received may be retained by the Director. 
This report was approved by the Board on 12 March 2025.
On behalf of the Board
Alice Avis MBE  |  Remuneration Committee Chair
12 March 2025

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Governance report
142
Directors’ report
Introduction
The Directors are pleased to present their Annual Report, including the Group and 
Company’s audited financial statements, for the year ended 31 December 2024.  
The Strategic Report on pages 2 to 51 comprise the Management Report, for the 
purposes of Disclosure Guidance and Transparency Rule 4.1.5R.
Statutory information incorporated by reference
Pursuant to UKLR 6.6.4R the Company’s discloses the following information: 
1.	
No interest was capitalised by the Group during the year; 
2.	 No unaudited financial information was required to be issued pursuant to UK LR 
6.2.23R;
3.	 Details of the Long-Term Incentive Plans can be found in the Remuneration 
Committee Report on page 129; 
4.	 No Director has agreed to waive any emoluments from the Company or any subsidiary 
undertaking;
5.	 Shares issued under the share authorities approved by shareholders at the 2024 AGM 
are shown below;
6.	 No Director was materially interested in any Contracts of Significance; 
7.	 The Company does not have a controlling shareholder;
8.	 No shareholder has waived or agreed to waive any dividends. 
Pursuant to UKLR 6.6.6R, and as a company listed in the United Kingdom, the Company 
provides the following additional information: 
1.	
PDMR notifiable transactions are shown in the table overleaf; 
2.	 No further interests have been disclosed in accordance with DTR 5 between 31 
December 2024 and the date of this report;
3.	 The Going Concern and Viability statements can be found on page 47 and 43. 
4.	 The Company has complied with the Principles and Provisions of the UK Corporate 
Governance Code and their application is laid out in the Governance section on  
page 97;
5.	 There are no unexpired terms of Directors service contracts. Details of Directors 
contracts can be found on page 111;
6.	 TCFD disclosures can be found in the ESG report on page 66. A separate, more 
comprehensive, ESG document will be published shortly and will be available on the 
Company’s website; 
7.	 Diversity of the Board and Senior Management, as at 31 December 2024, and the 
method for collecting data, are disclosed on page 114. No changes have taken place 
since the end of the year and the date of this document and no Directors or Senior 
Management are situated overseas.
Information required to be part of this Directors’ Report can be found elsewhere in the 
Annual Report and is incorporated into this report by reference, as indicated opposite:
	î Future developments and outlook are contained within the CEO report on page 20. 
	î Important events which have taken place since the end of the financial year are set out 
on page 176.
	î Likely future developments in the business are described on page 18.
	î Details of financial instruments and financial risk management objectives and policies 
are detailed on page 178.
	î Consultation with employees is undertaken through the One Team Collective, which 
comprises eleven employees and is attended by the Senior Independent Director.  
Further details can be found on page 124.
	î Principal and emerging risks and uncertainties pertaining to the Group and the way in 
which it manages and controls these risks are outlined on page 38.
	î Disclosures regarding the employment of disabled people, human rights, social 
matters, employee engagement and TCFD disclosures are contained within the ESG 
report on page 66 and in a separate ESG report, available on the Company’s website 
www.Empiric.co.uk	
	î No political donations were made during the year.	
Policy and practice on payment to creditors 
Standard payment terms are 30 days from receipt, with 82% of invoices paid within 
this period and 93% paid within 60 days. If a dispute arises in relation to an invoice, the 
Company will seek to resolve the dispute within 30 days. If this is not possible then the 
supplier will be notified with an explanation of the reason for the delay and a contact at 
the Company who is responsible for resolving the dispute. 
Financial results and dividends
The financial results for the year can be found in the Group Statement of Comprehensive 
Income on page 153.
Details of dividends paid and declared for the year are set out on page 168. No dividends 
were waived or were agreed to be waived by any Director or shareholder during the year.
Directors
The names of the Directors of the Company who served during the year together with 
the biographical details of the current Board are on pages 98 to 99. The process for 
appointing Directors is found on page 111.
Subject to the Articles, the Companies Act 2006 and any directions given to the 
Company by special resolution, the business of the Company will be managed by the 
Board, which may exercise all the powers of the Company.
Directors’ interests in ordinary shares, and share dealing undertaken during the year are 
shown below. Dividends received are disclosed in the Annual Report on Remuneration on 
page 136.

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Governance report
143
PDMR share dealing disclosures during 2024
Shareholding as 
at 31 December 
2023
Percentage of 
Issued Share 
Capital
Number of 
Shares acquired 
in Capital Raise 
announced on 18 
October 2024 
Exercise of 
2021 SAYE 
share options, 
announced on 14 
November 2024 
Shareholding as 
at 31 December 
2024 
Percentage of 
Issued Share 
Capital 
Mark Pain
100,000
0.0166
20,000
–
120,000
0.0181
Duncan Garrood
93,122
0.0154
32,000
25,316 
150,438
0.0227
Donald Grant
33,177
0.0055
20,876
–
54,053
0.0081
Alice Avis 
53,600
0.0089
6,000
–
59,600
0.0090
Martin Ratchford
0
0.0000
–
–
0
0
Clair Preston Beer 
0
0.0000
–
–
0
0
Total shares/percentage of share capital held by Directors 
279,899
0.0464
78,876
25,316
384,091 
0.0578
Share capital, share authorities and share issues
At 31 December 2024, the total number of ordinary shares in issue as per Note 19 to the 
financial statements is 663,996,844. No shares are held in Treasury. 
The Company has one class of shares, this being ordinary shares of 1p each, all of which 
are fully paid. Rights of shareholders are set out in the Company’s Articles of Association 
and also in the notes of the Notice of Annual General Meeting. 
No person holds securities in the Company carrying special rights with regard to control 
of the Company.
There are no restrictions on the transfer of securities in the Company, except pursuant to:
	î the Listing Rules of the Financial Conduct Authority (the “Listing Rules”), whereby 
certain individuals require approval to deal in the Company’s shares; and 
	î the Company’s Articles of Association, whereby the Board may decline to register a 
transfer of shares or otherwise impose a restriction on shares, to prevent the Company 
breaching any law or regulation. 
The Company is not aware of any agreements between holders of securities that may 
result in restrictions on the transfer of securities in the Company.
At the Company’s Annual General Meeting held on 22 May 2024, the Directors were 
granted a general authority to allot shares or grant rights to subscribe for or convert any 
securities into ordinary shares up to an aggregate nominal amount equal to £2,011,459, 
as well as an additional authority to allot shares for the same amount on a rights issue 
only. Of these ordinary shares, the Directors were granted authority to issue up to an 
aggregate nominal amount of £603,438 of equity securities on a non-pre-emptive basis 
and wholly for cash. All of these authorities will expire at the conclusion of the Company’s 
2025 Annual General Meeting.
Pursuant to this general authority 107,747 ordinary shares were issued to employees and 
former employees under the LTIP (nil cost options) and 100,750 ordinary shares were 
issued under the 2021 SAYE Option Plan, which were priced at 71.1p. The SAYE Option 
plan is open to all employees, subject to passing their induction period. 
At the AGM on 22 May 2024, shareholders approved Resolution 15, which gave the Board 
authority to allot shares for cash without first offering them to existing shareholders in 
proportion to their existing shareholdings. On 16 October 2024, the Company exercised 
this authority and conducted a capital raise. A total of 59,686,950 new ordinary shares 
(the “Placing Shares”) representing approximately 10 per cent. of the Company’s existing 
issued ordinary share capital were placed at a price of 93 pence per Placing Share (the 
“Placing Price”) raising proceeds of approximately £55.5 million (before expenses). 
Certain Directors of the Company also subscribed for new ordinary shares at the Placing 
Price. In addition, a total of 663,714 new ordinary shares representing approximately 
0.1 per cent. of the Company’s existing issued ordinary shares were issued to retail 
customers at the Placing Price raising proceeds of approximately £0.6 million  
(before expenses);
At the 22 May 2024 Annual General Meeting, the Directors were granted authority to 
make one or more market purchases of ordinary shares in the Company, in accordance 
with sections 693 and 701 of the Companies Act 2006, up to an aggregate number of 
60,343,768 ordinary shares, within certain price parameters. No ordinary shares have 
been purchased by the Company under this authority, which will expire at the conclusion 
of the Company’s 2025 Annual General Meeting.

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Governance report
144
Directors’ report | continued
Substantial shareholdings
As at 31 January 2025, the Company had been notified under the Disclosure Guidance 
and Transparency Rules (“DTR 5”) of the following substantial holders who were  
directly or indirectly interested in three per cent or more of the issued share capital  
of the Company:
as at 31 January 2025
Number of 
ordinary
shares
Percentage of 
ordinary
shares
BlackRock
47,225,169
7.11%
Investec Wealth & Investment
46,588,230
7.02%
Premier Miton Investors
36,784,073
5.54%
Janus Henderson Investors
34,220,843
5.15%
Fidelity International
33,560,210
5.05%
Jupiter Asset Management
31,246,354
4.71%
East Riding of Yorkshire
28,071,731
4.23%
CCLA Investment Management
23,343,425
3.52%
Waverton Investment Management
22,733,530
3.42%
Amendment of articles
The Articles may be amended by a special resolution of the Company’s shareholders.  
No amendments were made during 2024. 
Independent Auditor
BDO LLP has expressed its willingness to continue as auditor for the financial year ending 
31 December 2025 and a resolution relating to its reappointment will be tabled at the 
Annual General Meeting on 4 June 2025.
Disclosure of information to Auditor
The Directors who were members of the Board at the time of approving the Directors’ 
Report have confirmed that:
	î so far as each Director is aware, there is no relevant audit information of which the 
Company’s auditor is not aware; and 
	î each Director has taken all the steps that they ought to have taken as a Director in 
order to make themselves aware of any relevant audit information and to establish that 
the Company’s auditor is aware of that information. 
Annual General Meeting
The 2025 Annual General Meeting will be held at 11:00 a.m. on 4 June 2025. The notice of 
meeting will be sent to shareholders at the end of April 2025.
This report was approved by the Board on 12 March 2025.
Donald Grant  |  Director
12 March 2025

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Governance report
145
Directors’ responsibilities
The Directors are responsible for preparing the Annual Report and the Group and 
Company financial statements in accordance with applicable law and regulations.
Company law requires the Directors to prepare the Group and Company financial 
statements for each financial year. Under that law the Directors are required to prepare 
the Group financial statements in accordance with UK adopted International Accounting 
Standards and have elected to prepare the Company financial statements in accordance 
with United Kingdom Generally Accepted Accounting Practice (United Kingdom 
Accounting Standards comprising FRS 101 ‘Reduced Disclosure Framework’), and 
applicable law. 
Under company law the Directors must not approve the financial statements unless they 
are satisfied that they give a true and fair view of the state of affairs of the Group and 
Company and of the profit or loss for the Group for that year.
In preparing these financial statements, the Directors are required to:
	î select suitable accounting policies and then apply them consistently; 
	î make judgements and accounting estimates that are reasonable and prudent; 
	î for the Group financial statements, state whether they have been prepared in 
accordance with UK-adopted International Accounting Standards, subject to any 
material departures disclosed and explained in the financial statements;
	î for the Company financial statements, state whether applicable UK Accounting 
Standards have been followed, subject to any material departures disclosed and 
explained in the financial statements; 
	î prepare the Group and Company financial statements on the going concern basis 
unless it is inappropriate to presume that the Group and the Company will continue in 
business; and 
	î prepare a Directors’ Report, a Strategic Report and Directors’ Remuneration Report 
which comply with the requirements of the Companies Act 2006. 
The Directors are responsible for keeping adequate accounting records that are 
sufficient to show and explain the Group and the Company’s transactions and disclose 
with reasonable accuracy at any time the financial position of the Group and the 
Company and enable them to ensure that the financial statements comply with the 
Companies Act 2006. The Directors are also responsible for safeguarding the assets of 
the Group and hence for taking reasonable steps for the prevention and detection of 
fraud and other irregularities.
Website publication
The Directors are responsible for ensuring the Annual Report and the financial 
statements are made available on a website. Financial statements are published 
on the Company’s website in accordance with legislation in the UK governing the 
preparation and dissemination of financial statements, which may vary from legislation 
in other jurisdictions. The maintenance and integrity of the Company’s website is the 
responsibility of the Directors. The Directors’ responsibility also extends to the ongoing 
integrity of the financial statements contained therein.
Directors’ responsibilities pursuant to DTR4
The Directors confirm that to the best of their knowledge:
	î the Group financial statements have been prepared in accordance with UK adopted 
International Accounting Standards in conformity with the requirements of the 
Companies Act 2006 and give a true and fair view of the assets, liabilities, financial 
position and profit and loss of the Group and the undertakings included in the 
consolidation as a whole; 
	î the Annual Report includes a fair review of the development and performance of the 
business and the financial position of the Group and the Parent Company, together 
with a description of the principal risks and uncertainties that they face; and 
	î the Annual Report and Accounts, taken as a whole, is fair, balanced and understandable 
and provides the information necessary for shareholders to assess the Group’s 
position, performance, business model, strategy and principal risks. 
Signed on behalf of the Board by
Donald Grant  |  Director
12 March 2025

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Financial statements
146
Independent auditor’s report to the members of Empiric Student Property plc
Opinion on the financial statements
In our opinion:
	î the financial statements give a true and fair view of the state of the Group’s and of the 
Parent Company’s affairs as at 31 December 2024 and of the Group’s profit for the year 
then ended;
	î the Group financial statements have been properly prepared in accordance with UK 
adopted International Accounting Standards;
	î the Parent Company financial statements have been properly prepared in accordance 
with United Kingdom Generally Accepted Accounting Practice; and
	î the financial statements have been prepared in accordance with the requirements of 
the Companies Act 2006.
We have audited the financial statements of Empiric Student Property plc (the ‘Parent 
Company’) and its subsidiaries (the ’Group’) for the year ended 31 December 2024 which 
comprise the Consolidated Statement of Comprehensive Income, the Consolidated 
Statement of Financial Position, the Company Statement of Financial Position, the 
Consolidated Statement of Changes in Equity, the Company Statement of Changes in 
Equity, the Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows and notes to the financial statements, 
including a summary of material accounting policy information. The financial reporting 
framework that has been applied in the preparation of the Group financial statements 
is applicable law and UK adopted international accounting standards. The financial 
reporting framework that has been applied in the preparation of the Parent Company 
financial statements is United Kingdom Accounting Standards, including Financial 
Reporting Standard 101 “Reduced Disclosure Framework” (United Kingdom Generally 
Accepted Accounting Practice).
Basis for opinion
We conducted our audit in accordance with International Standards on Auditing (UK) 
(ISAs (UK)) and applicable law. Our responsibilities under those standards are further 
described in the Auditor’s responsibilities for the audit of the financial statements 
section of our report. We believe that the audit evidence we have obtained is sufficient 
and appropriate to provide a basis for our opinion. Our audit opinion is consistent with 
the additional report to the Audit and Risk Committee. 
Independence
Following the recommendation of the Audit and Risk Committee, we were appointed 
by the Board of Directors on 4 August 2015 to audit the financial statements for 
the year ended 30 June 2015 and subsequent financial periods. The period of total 
uninterrupted engagement including retenders and reappointments is 11 years, covering 
the years ended 30 June 2015 to 31 December 2024. We remain independent of the 
Group and the Parent Company in accordance with the ethical requirements that are 
relevant to our audit of the financial statements in the UK, including the FRC’s Ethical 
Standard as applied to listed public interest entities, and we have fulfilled our other 
ethical responsibilities in accordance with these requirements. The non-audit services 
prohibited by that standard were not provided to the Group or the Parent Company. 
Conclusions relating to going concern
In auditing the financial statements, we have concluded that the Directors’ use of the 
going concern basis of accounting in the preparation of the financial statements is 
appropriate. Our evaluation of the Directors’ assessment of the ability of the Group  
and of the Parent Company to continue to adopt the going concern basis of  
accounting included:
	î We assessed the appropriateness of the going concern period, being to 31 December 
2026, in light of the nature of the Group’s operations being linked to the academic and 
financial year cycles.
	î We assessed the appropriateness of the cash flow forecasts in the context of the 
Group’s and Parent Company’s 31 December 2024 financial position and expected 
student occupancies and compared the Directors’ downside sensitivities against 
results achieved in the current and previous years along with letting levels currently 
obtained for the next student year. 
	î We evaluated the key assumptions in these forecasts and considered whether these 
appear reasonable, for example by comparing rental revenue to expected student 
occupancy, comparing the projected SONIA interest rates to forward curves, agreeing 
the utility partial price fixing arrangement to the underlying position reports, and 
considering the ability to pause future capital expenditure if required. We also 
compared the overhead to previous years and considered the nature of spend and 
challenged the Directors as to what they considered discretionary.
	î We obtained covenant calculations and forecast calculations to test for any potential 
future covenant breaches. We also considered the covenant compliance headroom 
for sensitivity to both future changes in property valuations and the Group’s future 
financial performance. 
	î Where facilities were refinanced during the year, we obtained supporting 
documentation in the form of a facility agreement to verify this. 
	î We reviewed the disclosures relating to the going concern basis of preparation  
and considered whether these were consistent with the Directors’ going  
concern assessment.
Based on the work we have performed, we have not identified any material uncertainties 
relating to events or conditions that, individually or collectively, may cast significant 
doubt on the ability of the Group or the Parent Company to continue as a going concern 
for a period of at least twelve months from when the financial statements are authorised 
for issue. 
In relation to the Parent Company’s reporting on how it has applied the UK Corporate 
Governance Code, we have nothing material to add or draw attention to in relation to the 
Directors’ statement in the financial statements about whether the Directors considered 
it appropriate to adopt the going concern basis of accounting.
Our responsibilities and the responsibilities of the Directors with respect to going 
concern are described in the relevant sections of this report.

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Financial statements
147
Overview
Coverage
100% (2022: 100%) of Group profit before tax 
100% (2022: 100%) of Group revenue 
100% (2022: 100%) of Group total assets
Key audit matters
2024
2023
Valuation of investment property  
(excluding properties under development)
Yes
Yes
Materiality
Group financial statements as a whole
£12.25m (2023: £11.5m) based on 1% (2023: 1%) of Group Total assets
An overview of the scope of our audit
Our audit was scoped by obtaining an understanding of the Group and its environment, 
including the Group’s system of internal control, and assessing the risks of material 
misstatement in the financial statements. We also addressed the risk of management 
override of internal controls, including assessing whether there was evidence of bias by 
the Directors that may have represented a risk of material misstatement.
The Group is a single component as it invests only in UK student accommodation with 
a single finance team, a common IT system and internal control framework. The audit 
approach included undertaking audit work on the key risks of material misstatement 
identified for the Group across the single component. The Group audit team performed 
all the work necessary to issue the Group and Parent Company audit opinion.
Climate change
Our work on the assessment of potential impacts on climate-related risks on the Group’s 
operations and financial statements included:
	î Enquiries and challenge of management to understand the actions they have taken to 
identify climate-related risks and their potential impacts on the financial statements 
and adequately disclose climate-related risks within the Annual Report;
	î Our own qualitative risk assessment taking into consideration the sector in which the 
Group operates and how climate change affects this particular sector; and
	î Review of the minutes of Board and Audit and Risk Committee meetings and other 
papers related to climate change and performed a risk assessment as to how the 
impact of the Group’s commitment as set out in the Task Force on Climate-related 
Financial Disclosures (“TCFD”) may affect the financial statements and our audit.
We challenged the extent to which climate-related considerations, including the 
expected cash flows from the initiatives and commitments have been reflected,  
where appropriate, in management’s going concern assessment and viability assessment, 
and in management’s judgements and estimates in relation to the investment  
property portfolio.
Based on our risk assessment procedures, we did not identify there to be any key audit 
matters materially impacted by climate-related risks and related commitments. 
Key audit matters
Key audit matters are those matters that, in our professional judgement, were of most 
significance in our audit of the financial statements of the current period and include 
the most significant assessed risks of material misstatement (whether or not due to 
fraud) that we identified, including those which had the greatest effect on: the overall 
audit strategy, the allocation of resources in the audit, and directing the efforts of the 
engagement team. These matters were addressed in the context of our audit of the 
financial statements as a whole, and in forming our opinion thereon, and we do not 
provide a separate opinion on these matters.

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Financial statements
148
Independent auditor’s report to the members of Empiric Student Property plc | continued
Key audit matter 
How the scope of our audit addressed the key audit matter
Valuation of Investment 
Property (excluding 
commercial properties 
and properties under 
development)
Refer to Note 1.5 
(Accounting Policies) 
and Note 11 (Investment 
Property).
The valuation of investment property requires 
significant judgement and estimates by the 
Directors and the independent external valuer 
(the “Valuer”) and was therefore considered a 
significant risk due to the subjective nature of 
certain assumptions inherent in each valuation.
Any input inaccuracies or unreasonable bases 
used in the valuation judgements (such as 
capitalisation yields, future lease income, 
operating costs and future capital expenditure) 
could result in a material misstatement of the 
financial statements.
There is also a risk that the Directors may 
influence the significant judgements and 
estimates in respect of property valuations 
in order to achieve property valuation and 
other performance targets to meet market 
expectations.
For these reasons we considered the valuation of 
investment property to be a key audit matter.
We met with the Group’s external valuer, who valued all the Group’s investment properties to 
understand the assumptions and methodologies used in valuing these properties, the market 
evidence supporting the valuation assumptions and the valuation movements in the year. 
We assessed the competency, independence, and objectivity of the external Valuer, which 
included making enquiries regarding interests and relationships that may have created a threat to 
the Valuer’s objectivity. 
We used our knowledge and experience, including the assistance of our internal RICS qualified 
valuers, to evaluate and challenge the valuation assumptions, methodologies and the inputs used. 
This included establishing our own range of expectations for the valuation of investment property 
based on externally available metrics and wider economic and commercial factors. We assessed 
the valuation for each of the investment properties against our own expectation and challenged 
the external Valuer in respect of those properties where the valuations fell outside of our range 
of expectation through discussion and inspection of corroborating information to determine the 
appropriate valuation. 
We checked the data provided to the Valuer by the Group was consistent with the data we had 
audited. This data included inputs such as rent for the current academic year (which we have 
assessed through evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of relevant controls which 
record and calculate straight line rent over the lease term and performing a reconciliation of total 
revenue for student rental income to underlying cash receipts), projected capital expenditure and 
fire safety works. 
We reviewed the Directors’ assessment of the future capital expenditure including fire safety 
works. We corroborated a sample of costs to supporting documentation such as subcontractor 
agreements and price quotes. We also obtained a copy of the report detailing the expected 
works that management commissioned from an external expert. We assessed the competency, 
independence, and objectivity of the external expert, which included making enquiries regarding 
interests and relationships that may have created a threat to the expert’s objectivity. 
Key observations:
Based on the procedures we performed, we considered the assumptions and methodologies 
used to value the Group’s investment portfolio to be appropriate.

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Financial statements
149
Our application of materiality
We apply the concept of materiality both in planning and performing our audit, and in 
evaluating the effect of misstatements. We consider materiality to be the magnitude by 
which misstatements, including omissions, could influence the economic decisions of 
reasonable users that are taken on the basis of the financial statements. 
In order to reduce to an appropriately low level the probability that any misstatements 
exceed materiality, we use a lower materiality level, performance materiality, to determine 
the extent of testing needed. Importantly, misstatements below these levels will not 
necessarily be evaluated as immaterial as we also take account of the nature of identified 
misstatements, and the particular circumstances of their occurrence, when evaluating 
their effect on the financial statements as a whole. 
Based on our professional judgement, we determined materiality for the financial 
statements as a whole and performance materiality as follows:
Group financial statements
Parent Company financial statements
2024  
£
2023  
£
2024  
£
2023  
£
Materiality
£12,250,000
£11,500,000
£11,025,000
£10,350,000
Basis for 
determining 
materiality
1% of Group Total Assets
2% of Total Assets, capped at 90% 
of Group materiality
Rationale for  
the benchmark 
applied
We determined that Group 
Total Assets would be the most 
appropriate basis for determining 
overall materiality as we consider 
this to be one of its principal 
considerations for users of the 
financial statements in assessing 
the financial performance of the 
Group.
We determined that Parent 
Total Assets would be the most 
appropriate basis for determining 
materiality as we consider 
this to be one of its principal 
considerations for users of the 
financial statements in assessing 
the financial performance of the 
Parent. This is capped at 90% 
of Group materiality given the 
assessment of aggregation risk.
Performance 
materiality
£9,187,500
£8,025,000
£8,268,750
£7,762,500
Basis for 
determining 
performance 
materiality
75% of materiality - in determining performance materiality we have 
considered the following factors:
•	 Our risk assessment, including our assessment of the Group’s and 
the Parent Company’s overall control environment; and
•	 Our past experience of the audit and the level of corrected 
and uncorrected misstatements identified in prior periods and 
Management’s willingness to investigate and correct these.
Specific materiality
We also determined that for other account balances and classes of transactions that 
impact the calculation of European Public Real Estate Association (“EPRA”) earnings a 
misstatement of less than materiality for the financial statements as a whole, specific 
materiality, could influence the economic decisions of users. We consider EPRA earnings 
to be a key performance measure of the Company. EPRA earnings exclude the impact of 
the net surplus on revaluation of investment properties, profit on disposal of investment 
properties and changes in the fair value of interest rate derivatives. As a result, we 
determined materiality for these items to be £1,150,000 (2023: £1,200,000), based on 
5% of EPRA earnings (2023: 5%). This materiality was applied to test those items which do 
or may impact the measurement of EPRA earnings. Disclosure matters and the cashflow 
statement are subject to Group financial statement materiality. We further applied a 
performance materiality level of 75% of specific materiality to ensure that the risk of 
errors exceeding specific materiality was appropriately mitigated.
Reporting threshold 
We agreed with the Audit and Risk Committee that we would report to them all individual 
audit differences in excess of £612,500 (2023: £230,000) and for those items impacting 
the calculation of EPRA earnings £57,500 (2023: £60,000). We also agreed to report 
differences below this threshold that, in our view, warranted reporting on qualitative 
grounds.
Other information
The Directors are responsible for the other information. The other information comprises 
the information included in the Annual Report other than the financial statements and 
our auditor’s report thereon. Our opinion on the financial statements does not cover 
the other information and, except to the extent otherwise explicitly stated in our report, 
we do not express any form of assurance conclusion thereon. Our responsibility is to 
read the other information and, in doing so, consider whether the other information 
is materially inconsistent with the financial statements or our knowledge obtained in 
the course of the audit, or otherwise appears to be materially misstated. If we identify 
such material inconsistencies or apparent material misstatements, we are required to 
determine whether this gives rise to a material misstatement in the financial statements 
themselves. If, based on the work we have performed, we conclude that there is a material 
misstatement of this other information, we are required to report that fact.
We have nothing to report in this regard.

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Financial statements
150
Independent auditor’s report to the members of Empiric Student Property plc | continued
Corporate governance statement
The UK Listing Rules require us to review the Directors’ statement in relation to going 
concern, longer-term viability and that part of the Corporate Governance Statement 
relating to the Parent Company’s compliance with the provisions of the UK Corporate 
Governance Code specified for our review. 
Based on the work undertaken as part of our audit, we have concluded that each of the 
following elements of the Corporate Governance Statement is materially consistent with 
the financial statements or our knowledge obtained during the audit. 
Going concern and 
longer-term viability
•	 The Directors’ statement with regards to the appropriateness 
of adopting the going concern basis of accounting and any 
material uncertainties identified set out on page 159; and
•	 The Directors’ explanation as to their assessment of the Parent 
Company’s prospects, the period this assessment covers and 
why the period is appropriate set out on page 43.
Other Code 
provisions 
•	 Directors’ statement on fair, balanced and understandable set 
out on page 122; 
•	 Board’s confirmation that it has carried out a robust assessment 
of the emerging and principal risks set out on page 121;
•	 The section of the Annual Report that describes the review of 
effectiveness of risk management and internal control systems 
set out on page 120; and
•	 The section describing the work of the audit committee set out 
on page 119.
Other Companies Act 2006 reporting
Based on the responsibilities described below and our work performed during the course 
of the audit, we are required by the Companies Act 2006 and ISAs (UK) to report on 
certain opinions and matters as described below. 
Strategic report and 
Directors’ report 
In our opinion, based on the work undertaken in the course of the 
audit:
•	 the information given in the Strategic report and the Directors’ 
report for the financial year for which the financial statements 
are prepared is consistent with the financial statements; and
•	 the Strategic report and the Directors’ report have been 
prepared in accordance with applicable legal requirements.
In the light of the knowledge and understanding of the Group and 
the Parent Company and its environment obtained in the course 
of the audit, we have not identified material misstatements in the 
Strategic report or the Directors’ report.
Directors’ 
remuneration
In our opinion, the part of the Directors’ remuneration report to 
be audited has been properly prepared in accordance with the 
Companies Act 2006.
Matters on which 
we are required to 
report by exception
We have nothing to report in respect of the following matters in 
relation to which the Companies Act 2006 requires us to report 
to you if, in our opinion:
•	 adequate accounting records have not been kept by the Parent 
Company, or returns adequate for our audit have not been 
received from branches not visited by us; or
•	 the Parent Company financial statements and the part of 
the Directors’ remuneration report to be audited are not in 
agreement with the accounting records and returns; or
•	 certain disclosures of Directors’ remuneration specified by law 
are not made; or
•	 we have not received all the information and explanations we 
require for our audit.
Responsibilities of Directors
As explained more fully in the Directors’ responsibilities statement, the Directors are 
responsible for the preparation of the financial statements and for being satisfied that 
they give a true and fair view, and for such internal control as the Directors determine is 
necessary to enable the preparation of financial statements that are free from material 
misstatement, whether due to fraud or error.
In preparing the financial statements, the Directors are responsible for assessing the 
Group’s and the Parent Company’s ability to continue as a going concern, disclosing, 
as applicable, matters related to going concern and using the going concern basis 
of accounting unless the Directors either intend to liquidate the Group or the Parent 
Company or to cease operations, or have no realistic alternative but to do so.
Auditor’s responsibilities for the audit of the financial statements
Our objectives are to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial 
statements as a whole are free from material misstatement, whether due to fraud or error, 
and to issue an auditor’s report that includes our opinion. Reasonable assurance is a high 
level of assurance, but is not a guarantee that an audit conducted in accordance with 
ISAs (UK) will always detect a material misstatement when it exists. Misstatements can 
arise from fraud or error and are considered material if, individually or in the aggregate, 
they could reasonably be expected to influence the economic decisions of users taken 
on the basis of these financial statements.

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Financial statements
151
Extent to which the audit was capable of detecting irregularities, including fraud
Irregularities, including fraud, are instances of non-compliance with laws and regulations. 
We design procedures in line with our responsibilities, outlined above, to detect material 
misstatements in respect of irregularities, including fraud. The extent to which our 
procedures are capable of detecting irregularities, including fraud is detailed below:
Non-compliance with laws and regulations
Based on:
	î Our understanding of the Group and the industry in which it operates;
	î Discussion with management and those charged with governance (including the Audit 
and Risk Committee); and
	î Obtaining and understanding of the Group’s policies and procedures regarding 
compliance with laws and regulations; 
we considered the significant laws and regulations to be the applicable accounting 
framework, Companies Act 2006, the UK Listing Rules and the REIT tax regime 
requirements.
The Group is also subject to laws and regulations where the consequence of non-
compliance could have a material effect on the amount or disclosures in the financial 
statements, for example through the imposition of fines or litigations. We identified such 
laws and regulations to be the Fire Safety (England) Regulations 2022.
Our procedures in response to the above included:
	î Agreement of the financial statement disclosures to underlying supporting 
documentation to assess compliance with those laws and regulations having an impact 
on the financial statements;
	î Review of minutes of Board and committee meetings throughout the period and 
enquiries of management and the Audit and Risk Committee as to their identification 
of any non-compliance with laws or regulations;
	î Obtaining an understanding of the control environment in monitoring compliance 
with laws and regulations and performing our own checks of compliance with relevant 
requirements, including the Companies Act 2006, the UK Listing Rules and the REIT tax 
regime requirements.
Irregularities including fraud
We assessed the susceptibility of the financial statements to material misstatement, 
including fraud. Our risk assessment procedures included:
	î Enquiry of management and those charged with governance, including the Audit and 
Risk Committee, regarding any known or suspected instances of fraud;
	î Obtaining an understanding of the Group’s policies and procedures relating to:
	î
Detecting and responding to the risks of fraud; and 
	î
Internal controls established to mitigate risks related to fraud. 
	î Review of minutes of Board and committee meetings throughout the period and 
enquiries of management and the Audit and Risk Committee as to their identification 
of any actual or potential claims or fraud;
	î Discussion amongst the engagement team as to how and where fraud might occur in 
the financial statements; 
	î Performing analytical procedures to identify any unusual or unexpected relationships 
that may indicate risks of material misstatement due to fraud; and
	î Considering remuneration incentive schemes and performance targets and the related 
financial statement areas impacted by these.
Based on our risk assessment, we identified specific fraud risks with respect to the 
valuation of investment property, which has been included as a key audit matter and our 
audit response is set out in that section of our audit report. We also identified specific 
fraud risks with respect to revenue recognition (student rental income) and management 
override of controls. 
Our procedures in respect of the above included:
	î We addressed the risk of revenue recognition for student rental income through 
involving internal IT specialists who reviewed the design and operating effectiveness 
of relevant controls which automatically record and calculate straight line rent over 
the lease term. We also performed a reconciliation of total revenue for student rental 
income to underlying cash receipts. In addition, we tested a sample of manual journals 
processed during the year to supporting documentation and evaluating whether there 
was evidence of management override due to fraud; and
	î We addressed the risk of management override of controls by testing a sample of 
journals processed during the year to supporting documentation and evaluating 
whether there was evidence of bias that represented a risk of material misstatement 
due to fraud.

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Financial statements
152
We also communicated relevant identified laws and regulations and potential fraud risks 
to all engagement team members who were all deemed to have appropriate competence 
and capabilities and remained alert to any indications of fraud or non-compliance with 
laws and regulations throughout the audit. 
Our audit procedures were designed to respond to risks of material misstatement in the 
financial statements, recognising that the risk of not detecting a material misstatement 
due to fraud is higher than the risk of not detecting one resulting from error, as fraud 
may involve deliberate concealment by, for example, forgery, misrepresentations or 
through collusion. There are inherent limitations in the audit procedures performed and 
the further removed non-compliance with laws and regulations is from the events and 
transactions reflected in the financial statements, the less likely we are to become aware 
of it.
A further description of our responsibilities is available on the Financial Reporting 
Council’s website at: www.frc.org.uk/auditorsresponsibilities. This description forms part 
of our auditor’s report.
Use of our report
This report is made solely to the Parent Company’s members, as a body, in accordance 
with Chapter 3 of Part 16 of the Companies Act 2006. Our audit work has been 
undertaken so that we might state to the Parent Company’s members those matters 
we are required to state to them in an auditor’s report and for no other purpose. To the 
fullest extent permitted by law, we do not accept or assume responsibility to anyone 
other than the Parent Company and the Parent Company’s members as a body, for our 
audit work, for this report, or for the opinions we have formed.
Richard Levy (Senior Statutory Auditor)
For and on behalf of BDO LLP, Statutory Auditor
London, UK
12 March 2025
BDO LLP is a limited liability partnership registered in England and Wales (with registered 
number OC305127).
Independent auditor’s report to the members of Empiric Student Property plc | continued

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Financial statements
153
Consolidated statement of comprehensive income
Note
Year ended
31 December
2024
£m
Year ended
31 December
2023
£m
Continuing operations
Revenue
2
84.2
80.5
Property expenses
3
(25.6)
(25.2)
Gross profit
58.6
55.3
Administrative expenses
4
(15.4)
(14.0)
Loss on disposal of investment property
(4.2)
(0.6)
Change in fair value of investment property
11,16
15.4
30.1
Operating profit
54.4
70.8
Finance costs
5
(19.5)
(17.4)
Finance income
5
0.8
0.2
Derivative fair value movement
(1.3)
(0.2)
Profit before income tax
34.4
53.4
Corporation tax
7
–
–
Profit for the year and total comprehensive income
34.4
53.4
Earnings per share expressed in pence per share
8
Basic
5.6
8.8
Diluted
5.5
8.8

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Financial statements
154
Consolidated statement of financial position
Note
At 
31 December 
2024 
£m
At 
31 December 
2023 
£m
ASSETS
Non-current assets
Investment property – Operational Assets
11
1,118.9
1,072.7
Investment property – Development Assets
11
6.0
3.0
Property, plant and equipment
13
0.8
0.8
Intangible assets
12
5.5
3.1
Right of use asset
1.0
1.2
Total non-current assets
1,132.2
1,080.8
Current assets
Trade and other receivables
14
7.9
6.5
Assets classified as held for sale
15
10.7
22.4
Cash and cash equivalents
16
75.4
40.5
Derivative fair value
0.5
0.1
Total current assets
94.5
69.5
Total assets
1,226.7
1,150.3
LIABILITIES
Current liabilities
Trade and other payables
17
19.2
23.4
Borrowings
18
–
56.5
Lease liability
0.2
0.1
Deferred income
17
34.8
34.9
Total current liabilities
54.2
114.9
Non-current liabilities
Borrowings
18
370.4
300.2
Lease liability
0.8
1.0
Total non-current liabilities
371.2
301.2
Total liabilities
425.4
416.1
Total net assets
801.3
734.2
Note
At 
31 December 
2024 
£m
At 
31 December 
2023 
£m
Equity
Called up share capital
19
6.6
6.0
Share premium
20
54.1
0.3
Capital reduction reserve
21
402.1
424.1
Retained earnings
338.5
303.8
Total equity
801.3
734.2
Total equity and liabilities
1,226.7
1,150.3
Net Asset Value per share basic (pence)
9
120.7
121.7
Net Asset Value per share diluted (pence)
9
119.7
120.8
EPRA NTA per share (pence)
9
119.6
120.7
These financial statements were approved by the Board of Directors on 12 March 2025 
and signed on its behalf by:
Donald Grant  |  Director

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Financial statements
155
Company statement of financial position
Note
At
31 December
2024
£m
At
31 December
2023
£m
Fixed assets
Investments in subsidiaries
30
222.6
222.6
Property, plant and equipment
13
0.8
0.7
Intangible assets
12
5.5
3.1
Right of use asset
1.0
1.2
Total fixed assets
229.9
227.6
Current assets
Amounts due from Group undertakings
14
819.4
391.4
Trade and other receivables
14
0.7
0.7
Cash and cash equivalents
16
24.7
2.4
Total current assets
844.8
394.5
Current creditors
Amounts due to Group undertakings
17
454.8
111.0
Trade and other payables
17
2.1
3.4
Lease liability
0.2
0.1
Total current creditors
457.1
114.5
Total assets less current liabilities
617.6
507.6
Net current assets
387.7
280.0
Non-current creditors
Lease liability
0.8
1.0
Total non-current creditors
0.8
1.0
Total net assets
616.8
506.6
Note
At
31 December
2024
£m
At
31 December
2023
£m
Capital and reserves
Called up share capital
19
6.6
6.0
Share premium
20
54.1
0.3
Capital reduction reserve
21
402.1
424.1
Retained earnings
154.0
76.2
Total capital and reserves
616.8
506.6
The Company made a profit for the year of £77.5 million (2023: loss of £13.1 million).
These financial statements were approved by the Board of Directors on 12 March 2025 
and signed on its behalf by:
Donald Grant  |  Director

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Financial statements
156
Consolidated statement of changes in equity
Year ended 31 December 2024
Called up
share capital
£m
Share 
premium
£m
Capital 
reduction 
reserve
£m
Retained
earnings
£m
Total
equity
£m
Balance at 1 January 2024
6.0
0.3
424.1
303.8
734.2
Profit for the year
–
–
–
34.4
34.4
Total comprehensive income for the year
–
–
–
34.4
34.4
Share-based payments
–
0.1
–
0.3
0.4
Issue of shares net of fund raising costs
0.6
53.7
–
–
54.3
Dividends
–
–
(22.0)
–
(22.0)
Amounts recognised directly in equity
0.6
53.8
(22.0)
0.3
32.7
Balance at 31 December 2024
6.6
54.1
402.1
338.5
801.3
Balance at 1 January 2023
6.0
0.3
444.7
249.8
700.8
Profit for the year
–
–
–
53.4
53.4
Total comprehensive income for the year
–
–
–
53.4
53.4
Share-based payments
–
–
–
0.7
0.7
Reserves transfer
–
–
0.1
(0.1)
–
Dividends
–
–
(20.7)
–
(20.7)
Amounts recognised directly in equity
–
–
(20.6)
0.6
(20.0)
Balance at 31 December 2023
6.0
0.3
424.1
303.8
734.2

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Financial statements
157
Company statement of changes in equity
Year ended 31 December 2023
Called up
share capital
£m
Share 
premium
£m
Capital 
reduction 
reserve
£m
Retained
earnings
£m
Total
equity
£m
Balance at 1 January 2024
6.0
0.3
424.1
76.2
506.6
Profit for the year
–
–
–
77.5
77.5
Total comprehensive income for the year
–
–
–
77.5
77.5
Share-based payments
–
0.1
–
0.3
0.4
Issue of shares net of fund raising costs
0.6
53.7
–
–
54.3
Dividends
–
–
(22.0)
–
(22.0)
Amounts recognised directly in equity
0.6
53.8
(22.0)
0.3
32.7
Balance at 31 December 2024
6.6
54.1
402.1
154.0
616.8
Balance at 1 January 2023
6.0
0.3
444.7
88.7
539.7
Loss for the year
–
–
–
(13.1)
(13.1)
Total comprehensive income for the year
–
–
0.1
13.1
(13.1)
Share-based payments
–
–
–
0.7
0.7
Reserves transfer
–
–
0.1
(0.1)
–
Dividends
–
–
(20.7)
–
(20.7)
Amounts recognised directly in equity
–
–
(20.6)
0.6
(20.0)
Balance at 31 December 2023
6.0
0.3
424.1
76.2
506.6

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Financial statements
158
Consolidated statement of cash flows
Note
Year ended
31 December
2024
£m
Year ended
31 December
2023
£m
Cash flows from operating activities
Profit before income tax
34.4
53.4
Share-based payments expense
0.4
0.9
Depreciation and amortisation
0.6
0.8
Finance costs
19.5
17.4
Finance income
(0.8)
(0.2)
Loss on disposal of investment property
4.2
0.6
Change in fair value of investment property
(15.4)
(30.1)
Change in fair value of derivative 
1.3
0.2
44.2
43.0
(Increase)/decrease in trade and other receivables
(1.5)
0.3
Decrease in trade and other payables
(1.0)
(2.0)
Increase in deferred rental income
1.3
2.4
(1.2)
0.7
Net cash flows generated from operations
43.0
43.7
Cash flows from investing activities
Purchases of tangible fixed assets
(0.1)
–
Purchases of intangible assets
(2.7)
(1.6)
Purchase and development of investment 
property
(72.1)
(32.4)
Proceeds on disposal of asset held for sale, net of 
selling costs
11.5
13.6
Proceeds on disposal of investment property, net 
of selling costs
31.1
29.0
Finance income
0.8
0.2
Net cash flows (deployed to)/from  
investing activities
(31.5)
8.8
Note
Year ended
31 December
2024
£m
Year ended
31 December
2023
£m
Cash flows from financing activities
Dividends paid
(22.5)
(20.2)
Proceeds from equity raise, net of costs
54.3
–
Bank borrowings drawn
28
164.9
–
Bank borrowings repaid
28
(150.8)
(30.9)
Loan arrangement fee paid
28
(2.2)
(0.1)
Lease liability paid
28
(0.2)
(0.3)
Derivative premium paid
(1.7)
(0.3)
Interest rate cap termination receipt
0.1
–
Finance costs
(18.5)
(16.0)
Net cash flows generated from/(used in) 
financing activities
23.4
(67.8)
Increase/(decrease) in cash and cash equivalents
34.9
(15.3)
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year
16
40.5
55.8
Cash and cash equivalents at end of year
16
75.4
40.5

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Financial statements
159
Notes to the financial statements
1. Accounting policies
1.1 Period of Account
The consolidated financial statements of the Group are in respect of the reporting period 
from 1 January 2024 to 31 December 2024.
The consolidated financial statements comprise the results of Empiric Student Property 
plc (the “Company”) and its subsidiaries and were approved by the Board for issue on 
12 March 2025. The Company is a public limited company incorporated and domiciled 
in England and Wales. The Company’s ordinary shares are admitted to the official list of 
the UK Listing Authority, a division of the Financial Conduct Authority, and traded on 
the London Stock Exchange. The registered address of the Company is disclosed in the 
Company information.
1.2 Basis of Preparation
The consolidated financial statements of the Group for the year to 31 December 
2024 comprise the results of Empiric Student Property plc (the “Company”) and its 
subsidiaries (together, the “Group”). The Group and Parent Company financial statements 
have been prepared on a going concern basis. The Group financial statements have been 
prepared in accordance with UK adopted international accounting standards. The Parent 
Company financial statements have been prepared in accordance with FRS 101, Financial 
Reporting Standards Reduced Disclosure Framework.
The Group’s financial statements have been prepared on a historical cost basis, except 
for investment property and derivative financial instruments which have been measured 
at fair value. The consolidated financial statements are presented in Pounds Sterling 
which is also the Company and the Group’s functional currency.
The Company has applied the exemption allowed under section 408(1b) of the 
Companies Act 2006 and has therefore not presented its own Statement of 
Comprehensive Income in these financial statements. The Group profit for the year 
includes a profit after taxation of £77.5 million (2023: loss of £13.1 million) for the 
Company, which is reflected in the financial statements of the Company.
1.3 Disclosure Exemptions Adopted
In preparing the financial statements of the Parent Company, advantage has been 
taken of all disclosure exemptions conferred by FRS 101. The Parent Company financial 
statements do not include:
	î certain comparative information as otherwise required by international  
accounting standards; 
	î a statement of cash flows; 
	î the effect of future accounting standards not yet adopted; and 
	î disclosure of related party transactions with other wholly owned members of  
the Group headed by Empiric Student Property plc. 
In addition, and in accordance with FRS 101, further disclosure exemptions have been 
adopted because equivalent disclosures are included in the consolidated financial 
statements of Empiric Student Property plc. The Parent Company financial statements do 
not include certain disclosures in respect of:
	î Financial instruments (other than certain disclosures required as a result of recording 
financial instruments at fair value); and 
	î Fair value measurement (other than certain disclosures required as a result of recording 
financial instruments at fair value). 
1.4 Going Concern
At 31 December 2024, the Group’s cash position was £75.4 million and its capital 
commitments were £2.8 million.
Occupancy is a key driver of profitability and cash flows, and at 12 March 2025 occupancy, 
based on forward reservations for the upcoming 2025/26 academic year, was 48 per cent 
compared to 61 per cent for the 2024/25 academic year at 13 March 2024.
As part of the Group’s going concern and viability modelling, certain scenarios are 
considered to model the impact on liquidity. All of the Group’s covenants are currently 
compliant and we envisage compliance to continue to be achieved in a reasonably 
severe downside scenarios. The Group’s portfolio could currently withstand a 16 per cent 
decline in property valuations before a breach in any loan to value covenant is triggered. 
The Group’s average interest cover ratio across all facilities is 1.9 times, whereas gross 
profit is currently in excess of 3.0 times total finance costs, providing a good degree 
of comfort. Following refinancing completed during 2024, exposure to interest rate 
volatility has been significantly mitigated.
Bank borrowings would be renegotiated in advance of any potential covenant 
breaches, insofar as factors are within the control of the Group. Facility agreements 
typically contain cure provisions providing for prepayment, cash deposits or security 
enhancement as may be required to mitigate any potential breach. The Group’s 
borrowings are spread across a range of lenders and maturities so as to minimise any 
potential concentration of risk.
The Directors have considered the Group’s principal risks and severe but plausible 
downside scenarios in assessing the Group’s and Company’s going concern for the 
period to 31 December 2026. The Directors have considered, in particular:
	î a material reduction in revenue, both in terms of occupancy and growth rate;
	î inflation rates of 5 per cent, significantly above the Bank of England target rate of  
2 per cent;
	î utilities costs increase by 1.5 times that of current market expectation (where price 
fixing arrangements are not in place);
	î floating interest rates increase by 1.0 per cent over current forecasts;

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Financial statements
160
1. Accounting policies continued
1.4 Going Concern continued
	î an immediate valuation shock of minus 10 per cent in property valuations;
	î individually, the level at which banking covenants would come under pressure; 
In addition, the Directors have considered potential mitigants to the downside scenario 
which include, but are not limited to, utilising existing liquidity reserves, further asset 
disposals, pledging as security ungeared properties, suspending non committed capital 
expenditure and temporary suspension of the dividend.
Having made enquiries, the Directors have reasonable expectation that the Group and 
Company have adequate resources to continue in operational existence for the period 
to 31 December 2026. In addition, having reassessed the Group and Company’s principal 
risks, the Directors considered it appropriate to adopt the going concern basis of 
accounting in preparing these financial statements.
1.5 Significant Accounting Estimates and Judgements 
The preparation of the Group’s financial statements requires management to make 
estimates and judgements that affect the reported amounts of revenues, expenses, 
assets and liabilities, and the disclosure of contingent liabilities, at the reporting date. 
However, uncertainty about these estimates and judgements could result in outcomes 
that require a material adjustment to the carrying amount of the asset or liability affected 
in future periods.
Estimates
In the process of applying the Group’s accounting policies, management has made the 
following estimates, which have the most significant effect on the amounts recognised in 
the consolidated financial statements:
(a) Fair Valuation of Investment Property
The market value of investment property is determined, by an independent external 
real estate valuation expert, to be the estimated amount for which a property should 
exchange on the date of the valuation in an arm’s length transaction. Properties have 
been valued on an individual basis. The valuation experts use recognised valuation 
techniques and the principles of IFRS 13.
The valuations have been prepared in accordance with the RICS Valuation – Global 
Standards (incorporating the International Valuation Standards) and the UK national 
supplement (the “Red Book”). Factors reflected include current market conditions, net 
underlying operational income, periodic rentals, lease lengths and location, as well as 
estimated costs to be incurred as part of the Group’s EWS programme. The significant 
methods and assumptions used by valuers in estimating the fair value of investment 
property are set out in Note 11.
For properties under development, the fair value is calculated by estimating the fair value 
of the completed property using the income capitalisation technique less estimated 
costs to completion and an appropriate developer’s margin.
(b) Expected Credit Loss
Impairment provisions for trade receivables are recognised based on the simplified 
approach within IFRS 9 using the lifetime expected credit losses. During this process 
the probability of the non-payment of the trade receivable is assessed. This probability 
is then multiplied by the amount of the expected loss arising from default to determine 
the lifetime expected credit loss for the trade receivables. For trade receivables, which 
are reported net of impairment provisions, such provisions are recorded in a separate 
provision account with the loss being recognised within cost of sales in the Statement  
of Comprehensive Income.
Judgements
In the process of applying the Group’s accounting policies, management has made the 
following judgements, which have the most significant effect on the amounts recognised 
in the consolidated financial statements:
(a) Operating Lease Contracts – the Group as Lessor
The Group has investment properties which have various categories of leases in place 
with tenants. The judgements by lease type are detailed below:
	î Student leases: As these leases all have a term of less than one year, the Group retains 
all the significant risks and rewards of ownership of these properties and so accounts 
for the leases as operating leases. 
	î Commercial leases: The Group has determined, based on an evaluation of the 
terms and conditions of the arrangements, particularly the lease terms, insurance 
requirements and minimum lease payments, that it retains all the significant risks and 
rewards of ownership of these properties and so accounts for the leases as operating 
leases. 
1.6 Summary of Material Accounting Policies
Basis of Consolidation
The consolidated financial statements comprise the financial statements of the Company 
and its subsidiaries as at 31 December 2024. Subsidiaries are those investee entities 
where control is achieved when the Group is exposed, or has rights, to variable returns 
from its involvement with the investee and has the ability to affect those returns through 
its power over the investee.
Specifically, the Group controls an investee if, and only if, it has:
(a)	 power over the investee (i.e. existing rights that give it the current ability to direct the 
relevant activities of the investee); 
(b)	exposure, or rights, to variable returns from its involvement with the investee; and 
(c)	 the ability to use its power over the investee to affect its returns. 
Notes to the financial statements | continued

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Financial statements
161
The Group reassesses whether or not it controls an investee if facts and circumstances 
indicate that there are changes to one or more of the three elements of control. 
Consolidation of a subsidiary begins when the Group obtains control over the subsidiary 
and ceases when the Group loses control of the subsidiary.
The financial statements of the subsidiaries are prepared for the same reporting period 
as the Parent Company, using consistent accounting policies. All intra-Group balances, 
transactions and unrealised gains and losses resulting from intra-Group transactions are 
eliminated in full.
Financial Assets
The Group classifies its financial assets into one of the categories discussed below, 
depending on the purpose for which the asset was acquired. 
Fair Value Through Profit or Loss
These are carried in the Statement of Financial Position at fair value with changes in fair 
value recognised in the Statement of Comprehensive Income. This includes the Group’s 
derivative financial instruments.
Amortised Cost
These assets are primarily from the provision of goods and services to customers (e.g. 
trade receivables). They are initially recognised at fair value plus transaction costs that 
are directly attributable to their acquisition or issue and are subsequently carried at 
amortised cost using the effective interest rate method, less provision for impairment.
Impairment provisions for trade receivables are recognised based on the simplified 
approach within IFRS 9 using the lifetime expected credit losses. During this process 
the probability of the non-payment of the trade receivable is assessed. This probability 
is then multiplied by the amount of the expected loss arising from default to determine 
the lifetime expected credit loss for the trade receivables. For trade receivables, which 
are reported net of impairment provisions, such provisions are recorded in a separate 
provision account with the loss being recognised within cost of sales in the Statement 
of Comprehensive Income. On confirmation that the trade receivable will not be 
collectable, the gross carrying value of the asset is written off against the associated 
provision.
Impairment provisions for intercompany receivables are recognised based on a forward-
looking expected credit loss model. The methodology used to determine the amount 
of the provision is based on whether there has been a significant increase in credit risk 
since initial recognition of the financial asset. For those where the credit risk has not 
increased significantly since initial recognition of the financial asset, 12-month expected 
credit losses against gross interest income are recognised. For those where the credit 
risk has increased significantly, lifetime expected credit losses along with the gross 
interest income are recognised. For those that are determined to be credit impaired, 
lifetime expected credit losses along with interest income on a net basis are recognised.
From time to time, the Group elects to renegotiate the terms of trade receivables 
due from customers with which it has previously had a good trading history. Such 
renegotiations will lead to changes in the timing of payments rather than changes to 
the amounts owed and, in consequence, the new expected cash flows are discounted 
at the original effective interest rate and any resulting difference to the carrying value is 
recognised in the Statement of Comprehensive Income (operating profit).
The Group’s financial assets measured at amortised cost comprise trade and other 
receivables and cash and cash equivalents in the Statement of Financial Position.
Cash and Cash Equivalents
Cash and cash equivalents include cash on hand, short-term deposits and other short-
term highly liquid investments with maturities of three months or less.
Financial Liabilities
The Group classifies all of its financial liabilities as other financial liabilities which include 
the following items:
	î Bank borrowings, which are initially recognised at fair value net of any transaction costs 
directly attributable to the issue of the instrument. Such interest-bearing liabilities are 
subsequently measured at amortised cost using the effective interest rate method, 
which ensures that any interest expense over the period to repayment is at a constant 
rate on the balance of the liability carried in the Consolidated Statement of Financial 
Position. For the purposes of each financial liability, interest expense includes initial 
transaction costs and any premium payable on redemption, as well as any interest or 
coupon payable while the liability is outstanding. 
	î Trade payables and other short-term monetary liabilities, which are initially recognised 
at fair value and subsequently carried at amortised cost using the effective  
interest method. 
Intangible Assets
An intangible asset is recognised when it can be separately identified, will provide future 
economic benefits, and its cost can be reliably measured. Further consideration is given 
to each intangible asset as to whether it is internally generated or externally acquired.
Intangible assets are initially recognised at cost and then subsequently recognised at 
cost less accumulated depreciation and impairment losses. Amortisation is charged to 
the Consolidated Statement of Comprehensive Income within administrative expenses 
on a straight-line basis over a period of ten years. Intangible assets that are undergoing 
development are not amortised until such a time that they are ready for use.

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Financial statements
162
1. Accounting policies continued
1.6 Summary of Material Accounting Policies continued
Investment Property
Investment property comprises property that is held to generate rental income or for 
capital appreciation. This includes property under development rather than for sale in  
the ordinary course of business.
Investment property is measured initially at cost including transaction costs and is 
included in the financial statements on unconditional exchange. Transaction costs 
include transfer taxes, professional fees and initial leasing commissions to bring the 
property to the condition necessary for it to be capable of operating.
Once purchased, investment property is stated at fair value. Gains or losses arising from 
changes in fair value are included in the Consolidated Statement of Comprehensive 
Income in the period in which they arise.
A property ceases to be recognised as investment property and is transferred at its fair 
value to property held for sale when it meets the criteria of IFRS 5. Under IFRS 5 the asset 
must be available for immediate sale in its present condition subject only to the terms 
that are usual and customary for sales of such assets and its sale must be highly probable.
Investment property is derecognised when it has been disposed of, or permanently 
withdrawn from use, and no future economic benefit is expected from its disposal. The 
investment property is derecognised upon unconditional exchange. The difference 
between the net disposal proceeds and the carrying amount of the asset would result 
in either a gain or loss at the retirement or disposal of investment property. Any gains 
or losses are recognised as a net gain or loss on disposal of investment property in the 
Consolidated Statement of Comprehensive Income in the period of retirement  
or disposal.
Property, Plant and Equipment
All property, plant and equipment is stated at historical cost less depreciation. Historical 
cost includes expenditure which is directly attributable to the acquisition of the asset.
Depreciation has been charged to the Consolidated Statement of Comprehensive 
Income within administrative expenses on the following basis:
	î Fixtures and fittings:	
straight-line basis over seven years; and 
	î Computer equipment:	
straight-line basis over three years. 
Rental Income
The Group is the lessor in respect of operating leases. Rental income arising from 
operating leases on investment property is accounted for on a straight-line basis over 
the lease term and is included in gross rental income in the Consolidated Statement of 
Comprehensive Income due to its operating nature.
Tenant lease incentives are recognised as a reduction of rental revenue on a straight-line 
basis over the term of the lease. The lease term is the non-cancellable period of the lease 
together with any further term for which the tenant has the option to continue the lease, 
where, at the inception of the lease, the Directors are reasonably certain that the tenant 
will exercise that option.
Amounts received from tenants to terminate leases or to compensate for dilapidations 
are recognised in the Consolidated Statement of Comprehensive Income when the right 
to receive them arises.
Where a student requests a rent refund and they meet the necessary criteria, including 
leaving the property, the Group recognise no further income in relation to that tenancy. 
Segmental Information
The Directors are of the opinion that the Group is engaged in a single segment business, 
being the investment in student and associated commercial lettings, within the  
United Kingdom.
Share-based Payments
Where share options are awarded to employees or Directors, the fair value of the options 
at the date of grant is charged to the Consolidated Statement of Comprehensive Income 
over the vesting period. Non-market vesting conditions are taken into account by 
adjusting the number of equity instruments expected to vest at each reporting date so 
that, ultimately, the cumulative amount recognised over the vesting period is based on 
the number of options that eventually vest. Non-vesting conditions and market vesting 
conditions are factored into the fair value of the options granted. So long as all other 
vesting conditions are satisfied, a charge is made irrespective of whether the market 
vesting conditions are satisfied.
Share Capital
Ordinary shares are classified as equity. External costs directly attributable to the 
issuance of shares are recognised as a deduction from equity.
Taxation
As the Group is a UK REIT, profits arising in respect of the property rental business are not 
subject to UK corporation tax.
Taxation in respect of profits and losses outside of the property rental business comprise 
current and deferred taxes. Taxation is recognised in the Consolidated Statement of 
Comprehensive Income except to the extent that it relates to items recognised as a 
direct movement in equity, in which case it is also recognised as a direct movement  
in equity.
Current tax is the total of the expected corporation tax payable in respect of any non-
REIT taxable income for the year and any adjustment in respect of previous periods, 
based on tax rates applicable to the periods.
Notes to the financial statements | continued

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Financial statements
163
Deferred tax is calculated in respect of temporary differences between the carrying 
amount of assets and liabilities for financial reporting purposes and their tax bases, 
based on tax rates enacted or substantively enacted at the balance sheet date.
Deferred tax liabilities are recognised in full except to the extent that they relate to 
the initial recognition of assets and liabilities not acquired in a business combination. 
Deferred tax assets are only recognised to the extent that it is considered probable that 
the Group will obtain a tax benefit when the underlying temporary differences unwind.
1.7 Impact of New Accounting Standards and Changes in  
Accounting Policies 
At the date of authorisation of these financial statements, the following accounting 
standards had been issued but are not yet effective:
	î IFRS 9 and IFRS 7 Classification and Measurement of Financial Instruments
	î IFRS 18 Presentation and Disclosure in Financial Statements
	î IFRS 19 Subsidiaries without Public Accountability: Disclosures
The above standards or interpretations not yet effective are not expected to have a 
material impact on the consolidated financial statements of the Group.
2. Revenue
Group
Year ended
31 December
2024
£m
Year ended
31 December
2023
£m
Student rental income
82.6
79.0
Commercial rental income
1.6
1.5
Total revenue
84.2
80.5
3. Property expenses
Group
Year ended
31 December
2024
£m
Year ended
31 December
2023
£m
Direct site costs (income generating properties)
5.8
5.0
Technology services
0.6
0.7
Site office and utilities
14.3
14.3
Cleaning and service contracts
3.2
3.3
Repairs and maintenance
1.7
1.9
Total property expenses
25.6
25.2
4. Administrative expenses
Group
Year ended
31 December
2024
£m
Year ended
31 December
2023
£m
Salaries and Directors’ remuneration
8.9
8.8
Legal and professional fees
1.6
1.4
Other administrative costs
1.9
1.3
Depreciation and amortisation
0.6
0.8
IT expenses
1.3
1.0
Internal audit fees1
0.1
–
Abortive acquisition costs
0.5
0.1
Administrative expenses excluding external audit fees
14.9
13.3
Fees payable for the audit of the Group’s annual results
0.4
0.3
Fees payable for the audit of the Group’s interim results
0.1
0.1
Fees payable for the audit of the Group’s subsidiaries
–
0.2
Total auditor’s fees1
0.5
0.6
Total administrative expenses
15.4
14.0
1	
Audit and related fees for the year ended 31 December 2023 includes £0.1 million arising in respect of the 
audit for the year ended 31 December 2022. In both years, external audit services were carried out by BDO and 
internal audit services were carried out by Grant Thornton.

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Financial statements
164
5. Net finance costs
Group
Year ended
31 December
2024
£m
Year ended
31 December
2023
£m
Finance costs
Interest expense on bank borrowings
17.8
16.2
Amortisation of loan transaction costs
1.7
1.2
19.5
17.4
Finance income
Interest received on bank deposits
0.8
0.2
Net finance costs
18.7
17.2
6. Employees and directors
Group
Company
Year ended
31 December
2024
£m
Year ended
31 December
2023
£m
Year ended
31 December
2024
£m
Year ended
31 December
2023
£m
Wages and salaries
13.7
12.3
6.0
5.2
Pension costs
0.9
0.7
0.4
0.5
Cash bonus
0.5
1.3
0.3
0.9
Share-based payments
0.4
0.9
0.4
0.9
National insurance
1.4
1.4
0.7
0.6
16.9
16.6
7.8
8.1
Less: Hello Student employee costs 
included within property expenses
(7.5)
(7.7)
–
–
Less: capitalised salaries 
(0.5)
–
(0.5)
–
Amounts included in administrative 
expenses
8.9
8.9
7.3
8.1
The average monthly number of 
employees:
Management – Company
5
5
5
5
Administration – Company
70
60
70
60
Group
Company
Year ended
31 December
2024
£m
Year ended
31 December
2023
£m
Year ended
31 December
2024
£m
Year ended
31 December
2023
£m
Operations – Hello Student 
Management Limited
299
293
–
–
374
358
75
65
Directors’ remuneration
Group
Year ended
31 December
2024
£m
Year ended
31 December
2023
£m
Salaries and fees
1.0
1.0
Pension costs
0.1
0.1
Bonus
0.1
0.5
Share-based payments
0.3
0.6
1.5
2.2
A summary of the Directors’ emoluments, including the disclosures required by the 
Companies Act 2006 is set out in the Directors’ Remuneration Report.
7. Corporation tax
The Group became a REIT on 1 July 2014 and as a result does not pay UK corporation tax 
on its profits and gains from its qualifying property rental business in the UK provided it 
meets certain conditions. Non-qualifying profits and gains of the Group continue to be 
subject to corporation tax as normal.
In order to achieve and retain REIT status, several conditions have to be met on entry to 
the regime and on an ongoing basis, including:
	î at the start of each accounting period, the assets of the property rental business (plus 
any cash and certain readily realisable investments) must be at least 75% of the total 
value of the Group’s assets; 
	î at least 75% of the Group’s total profits must arise from the tax-exempt property rental 
business; and 
	î at least 90% of the tax exempt profit of the property rental business (excluding gains) 
of the accounting period must be distributed. 
Notes to the financial statements | continued

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Financial statements
165
In addition, the full UK corporation tax exemption in respect of the profits of the property 
rental business will not be available if the profit financing cost ratio in respect of the 
property rental business is less than 1.25.
The Directors intend that the Group should continue as a REIT for the foreseeable future, 
with the result that deferred tax is not required to be recognised in respect of temporary 
differences relating to the property rental business.
Group
Year ended
31 December
2024
£m
Year ended
31 December
2023
£m
Current tax
Income tax charge for the year
–
–
Adjustment in respect of prior year
–
–
Total current income tax charge in the income statement
–
–
Deferred tax
Total deferred income tax charge in the income statement
–
–
Total current income tax charge in the income statement
–
–
The tax assessed for the year is lower than the standard rate of 
corporation tax in the year
Profit for the year
34.4
53.4
Profit before tax multiplied by the rate of corporation tax in the 
UK of 25% (2023: 23.5%)
8.6
12.5
Exempt property rental profits in the year
(8.2) 
(9.1)
Exempt property revaluations in the year
(3.9)
(7.1)
Effects of:
Non-allowable expenses
0.2
0.1
Unutilised current year tax losses
3.3
3.6
Total current income tax charge in the income statement
–
–
No deferred tax asset has been recognised in respect of gross tax losses of £60.6 
million (2023: £48.8 million), accelerated capital allowances of £4.2 million (2023: £3.8 
million) and share based payments of £2.5 million (2023: £2.1 million) on the basis that 
the business is not expected to generate taxable profits in future periods against which 
these amounts can be applied. Therefore, a deferred tax asset of £16.2 million (2023: £13.1 
million) has not been recognised in respect of such timing differences.
8. Earnings per share
The number of shares used in the calculation of basic earnings per share is based on the 
time weighted average number of shares throughout the year.
Basic EPS is calculated by dividing the earnings attributable to ordinary shareholders by 
the weighted average number of ordinary shares outstanding during the year.
Diluted EPS is calculated using the weighted average number of shares adjusted to 
assume the conversion of all dilutive potential ordinary shares.
EPRA EPS, reported on the basis recommended for real estate companies by EPRA, is 
a key measure of the Group’s operating results, and used by the Board to assess the 
Group’s dividend payments. 
The Group has early adopted EPRA’s Best Practice Recommendations issued in 
September 2024 for accounting periods beginning on or after 01 October 2024. The 
impact of adoption has led to a refinement of the EPRA Earnings Per Share (EPS) metric, 
introduced to ensure EPRA’s earnings metric remains robust, accurate and aligned to 
both its original definition and applied consistently across the sector.
The primary amendment made allows Companies to make adjustments for items 
considered to be non-operating, unusual or exceptional within the calculation of EPRA 
EPS, thereby reducing the need for Company adjusted earnings metrics.
During the year two exceptional non-recurring charges totalling £1.4 million were made, 
which have been adjusted for in arriving at EPRA Earnings and EPRA EPS, as set out below. 
There were no equivalent charges in the comparative period and therefore no change to 
EPRA Earnings or EPRA EPS as a result of adoption.
The calculation of each earnings measure is set out on the next page.

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Financial statements
166
8. Earnings per share continued
Year to 31 December 2024
Calculation of 
basic EPS
£m
Calculation of 
diluted EPS 
£m
Calculation 
of EPRA basic 
EPS
£m
Calculation of 
EPRA diluted 
EPS
£m
Earnings per IFRS statement  
of comprehensive income
34.4
34.4
34.4
34.4
Adjustments to remove:
Changes in fair value of  
investment property
–
–
(15.4)
(15.4)
Loss on disposal of  
investment property
–
–
4.2
4.2
Loss on derivative financial 
instruments
–
–
1.3
1.3
Accelerated debt issue cost 
amortisation on refinancing –  
non-recurring
–
–
0.9
0.9
Abortive costs in relation to 
prospective Joint Venture –  
non-recurring
–
–
0.5
0.5
Earnings
34.4
34.4
25.9
25.9
Weighted average number of  
shares (m)
616.2
616.2
616.2
616.2
Adjustment for employee share 
options (m)
–
5.6
–
5.6
Total number shares (m)
616.2
621.8
616.2
621.8
Earnings per share (pence)
5.6 
5.5 
4.2 
4.2 
Year to 31 December 2023
Calculation of 
basic EPS
£m
Calculation of 
diluted EPS 
£m
Calculation 
of EPRA basic 
EPS
£m
Calculation of 
EPRA diluted 
EPS
£m
Earnings per IFRS statement  
of comprehensive income
53.4
53.4
53.4
53.4
Adjustments to remove:
Changes in fair value of  
investment property
–
–
0.6
0.6
Loss on disposal of  
investment property
–
–
(30.1)
(30.1)
Loss on derivative financial 
instruments
0.2
0.2
Earnings
53.4
53.4
24.1
24.1
Weighted average number of  
shares (m)
603.4
603.4
603.4
603.4
Adjustment for employee share 
options (m)
–
4.6
–
4.6
Total number shares (m)
603.4
608.0
603.4
608.0
Earnings per share (pence)
 8.8 
 8.8 
 4.0 
4.0 
Notes to the financial statements | continued

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Financial statements
167
9. Net asset value per share
The principles of the three EPRA measures are set out below:
EPRA Net Reinstatement Value (“NRV”): Assumes that entities never sell assets and aims 
to represent the value required to reinstate entity assets.
EPRA Net Tangible Assets (“NTA”): Assumes that entities buy and sell assets, which 
crystalises unavoidable deferred tax.
EPRA Net Disposal Value (“NDV”): Represents the shareholders’ value under a disposal 
scenario, where deferred tax, financial instruments and certain other adjustments are 
calculated to the full extent of their liability, net of any resulting tax. As the Group is a 
REIT, no adjustment is made for deferred tax.
The Group considers EPRA NTA to be the most relevant measure and this is used as the 
Group’s primary NAV measure.
A reconciliation of the three EPRA NAV metrics from IFRS NAV is shown in the  
table below:
Year ended 31 December 2024
NAV
EPRA NAV measures
IFRS
£m
EPRA
NTA
£m
EPRA
NRV
£m
EPRA
NDV
£m
Net assets per Statement of  
Financial Position 
801.3
801.3
801.3
801.3
Adjustments
–
Fair value of fixed rate debt
–
–
–
20.7
Derivative fair value
–
(0.5)
(0.5)
–
Purchaser’s costs1
–
–
67.3
–
Net assets used in per  
share calculation
801.3
800.8
868.1
822.0
Number of shares in issue
Issued share capital (m)
664.0
664.0
664.0
664.0
Issued share capital plus employee 
options (m)
669.6
669.6
669.6
669.6
Net Asset Value per share
Basic Net Asset Value per share 
(pence)
120.7 
Diluted Net Asset Value per share 
(pence)
119.7 
119.6 
 129.6
122.8 
Year ended 31 December 2023
NAV
EPRA NAV measures
IFRS
£m
EPRA
NTA
£m
EPRA
NRV
£m
EPRA
NDV2
£m
Net assets per Statement of  
Financial Position 
734.2
734.2
734.2
734.2
Adjustments
–
Fair value of fixed rate debt
–
–
–
20.9
Derivative fair value
–
(0.1)
(0.1)
–
Purchaser’s costs1
–
–
37.1
–
Net assets used in per  
share calculation
734.2
734.1
771.2
755.1
Number of shares in issue
Issued share capital (m)
603.4
603.4
603.4
603.4
Issued share capital plus employee 
options (m)
608.0
608.0
608.0
608.0
Net Asset Value per share
Basic Net Asset Value per share 
(pence)
 121.7 
Diluted Net Asset Value per share 
(pence)
 120.8 
 120.7 
 126.8 
 124.2 
1	
Restated to reflect full application of the equity method. 
2	
EPRA NTA and EPRA NDV reflect IFRS values which are net of purchaser’s costs. Any purchaser’s costs deducted 
from the market value are added back when calculating EPRA NRV. 

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Financial statements
168
10. Dividends paid
Group and Company
Year ended
31 December
2024
£m
Year ended
31 December
2023
£m
Interim dividend of 0.875 pence per ordinary share in respect 
of the quarter ended 31 December 2022
5.3
Interim dividend of 0.8125 pence per ordinary share in respect 
of the quarter ended 31 March 2023
4.9
Interim dividend of 0.8125 pence per ordinary share in respect 
of the quarter ended 30 June 2023
4.9
Interim dividend of 0.9375 pence per ordinary share in respect 
of the quarter ended 30 September 2023
5.6
Interim dividend of 0.9375 pence per ordinary share in respect 
of the quarter ended 31 December 2023
5.7
Interim dividend of 0.875 pence per ordinary share in respect 
of the quarter ended 31 March 2024
5.3
Interim dividend of 0.875 pence per ordinary share in respect 
of the quarter ended 30 June 2024
5.3
Interim dividend of 0.875 pence per ordinary share in respect 
of the quarter ended 30 September 2024
5.7
22.0
20.7
As at 31 December 2024, no withholding tax was recorded in trade payables (2023: £0.5 
million). On 12 March 2025 the Company declared a dividend of 1.075 pence per share to 
be paid on 11 April 2025.
11. Investment property
Year ended 31 December 2024
Group
Investment
property
freehold
£m
Investment
property
long leasehold
£m
Total 
operational 
assets
£m
Property 
under 
development
£m
Total
investment
property
£m
As at 1 January 2024
940.0
132.7
1,072.7
3.0
1,075.7
Capital expenditure
25.4
6.1
31.5
1.3
32.8
Property acquisitions
31.3
–
31.3
5.9
37.2
Sale of investment 
property
(32.7)
–
(32.7)
(3.0)
(35.7)
Transfer to held for  
sale asset
(2.7)
–
(2.7)
–
(2.7)
Change in fair value 
during the year1
12.3
6.5
18.8
(1.2)
17.6
As at 31 December 2024
973.6
145.3
1,118.9
6.0
1,124.9
1	
The change in fair value of investment property during the year for the Group was £15.4 million. Of this, a fair 
value gain of £17.6 million has been recorded in Investment Property, and a £2.2 million loss has been recorded 
in held for sale assets.
Year ended 31 December 2023
Group
Investment
property
freehold
£m
Investment
property
long
leasehold
£m
Total
operational
assets
£m
Property
under
development
£m
Total
investment
property
£m
As at 1 January 2023
920.4
142.0
1,062.4
3.3
1,065.7
Capital expenditure
29.7
2.8
32.5
–
32.5
Sale of investment 
property
(12.0)
(18.2)
(30.2)
–
(30.2)
Transfer to held for sale 
asset
(22.4)
–
(22.4)
–
(22.4)
Change in fair value 
during the year
24.3
6.1
30.4
(0.3)
30.1
As at 31 December 2023
940.0
132.7
1,072.7
3.0
1,075.7
Notes to the financial statements | continued

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Financial statements
169
All rental income as well as all direct operating expenses, including repairs and 
maintenance, recorded in the Statement of Comprehensive Income were derived 
from those assets held under Investment Property and Held For Sale Assets. No direct 
operating expenses, including repairs and maintenance, arose from Investment Property 
or Held For Sale Assets that did not generate rental income.
£374.3 million (nominal value) of the Group’s borrowings are secured by fixed charges 
over certain investment properties held by subsidiaries, with a market value of £1,021.7 
million (31 December 2023: £1,074.9 million), and by floating charges over the assets of 
certain subsidiaries. There are currently no restrictions on the remittance of income from 
investment properties.
In accordance with IAS 40, the carrying value of investment property is their fair value as 
determined by independent external valuers. This valuation has been conducted by CBRE 
Limited, as external valuer, and has been prepared as at 31 December 2024, in accordance 
with the Appraisal & Valuation Standards of the RICS, on the basis of market value. 
Properties have been valued on an individual basis. This value has been incorporated into 
the financial statements.
The valuation of all property assets uses market evidence and includes assumptions 
regarding income expectations and yields that investors would expect to achieve on 
those assets over time. Many external economic and market factors, such as interest rate 
expectations, bond yields, the availability and cost of finance and the relative attraction 
of property against other asset classes, could lead to a reappraisal of the assumptions 
used to arrive at current valuations. In adverse conditions, this reappraisal can lead to a 
reduction in property values and a loss in Net Asset Value.
The valuers of the Group’s property portfolio have made enquiries to ascertain 
sustainability factors which are likely to impact value and reflect their understanding 
of how market participants include sustainability factors in their pricing decisions in 
arriving at their opinion of market value. The valuer considers the following sustainability 
considerations to have the greatest potential to impact value:
	î Energy performance;
	î Green certification;
	î Sources of fuel and renewable energy sources; and
	î Physical risk/Climate related risk
The table opposite reconciles between the fair value of the investment property per 
the Consolidated Statement of Financial Position and investment property per the 
independent valuation performed in respect of each year end.
Group
As at
31 December
2024
£m
As at
31 December
2023
£m
Value per independent valuation report
1,135.0
1,097.9
Add: Head lease
0.6
0.2
Deduct: Assets classified as held for sale
(10.7)
(22.4)
Fair value per Consolidated Statement of Financial Position
1,124.9
1,075.7
Fair Value Hierarchy
The following table provides the fair value measurement hierarchy for investment 
property:
Date of valuation 31 December 2024
Total
£m
Quoted
prices
inputs
markets
(Level 1)
£m
Significant
observable
inputs
(Level 2)
£m
Significant
unobservable
inputs
(Level 3)
£m
Assets measured at fair value:
Student property
1,118.5
–
–
1,118.5
Commercial property
16.5
–
–
16.5
As at 31 December 2024
1,135.0
1,135.0
Date of valuation 31 December 2023
Total
£m
Quoted prices
in active
markets
(Level 1)
£m
Significant
observable
inputs
(Level 2)
£m
Significant
unobservable
inputs
(Level 3)
£m
Assets measured at fair value:
Student property
1,082.1
–
–
1,082.1
Commercial property
15.8
–
–
15.8
As at 31 December 2023
1,097.9
–
–
1,097.9
There have been no transfers between Level 1 and Level 2 during the year, nor have there 
been any transfers between Level 2 and Level 3 during the year.

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Financial statements
170
11. Investment property continued
The valuations have been prepared on the basis of market value which is defined in the 
RICS Valuation Standards, as:
“The estimated amount for which a property should exchange on the date of valuation 
between a willing buyer and a willing seller in an arm’s-length transaction after proper 
marketing wherein the parties had each acted knowledgeably, prudently and without 
compulsion.”
Market value as defined in the RICS Valuation Standards is the equivalent of fair value 
under IFRS.
The following descriptions and definitions relate to valuation techniques and key 
unobservable inputs made in determining fair values. The valuation technique for  
student property uses a discounted cash flow with the following inputs:
(a)	 Unobservable input: Rental income 
The rent at which space could be let in the market conditions prevailing at the date of 
valuation. Range £116 per week–£549 per week with a weighted average weekly rent of 
£235 (31 December 2023: £96–£493 per week, weighted average £184).
(b)	Unobservable input: Rental growth 
The estimated average increase in rent based on both market estimations and 
contractual arrangements. Assumed rental growth of 3.5% used in valuations  
(31 December 2023: growth of 6.2%). 
(c)	 Unobservable input: Net initial yield 
The net initial yield is defined as the initial net income as a percentage of the market value 
(or purchase price as appropriate) plus standard costs of purchase. 
Range: 4.8%–8.9%, with a weighted average of 5.5% (31 December 2023: 4.5%–8.9%, 
weighted average 5.5%). 
(d)	Unobservable input: Physical condition of the property 
The Group indicated that it would spend £46.0 million on health and safety works over a 
five year period through to 2026. CBREs assumption at 31 December 2024 is that £29.5 
million for EWS and £1.5 million for internal fire safety works reflected as a deduction 
within the valuation (31 December 2023: £33.0 million). This deduction is in respect of 
work on external wall systems and fire stopping on buildings over 11 meters.
(e)	 Sensitivities of measurement of significant unobservable inputs
The Group’s portfolio valuation is subject to judgement and is inherently subjective by 
nature. As a result, the following sensitivity analysis has been prepared by the valuer.  
For the purposes of the sensitivity analysis, the Group considers its property portfolio to 
be one homogeneous group of properties.
As at 31 December 2024
15% increase
in cost of EWS 
works
£m
-3% change
in rental
income
£m
+3% change
in rental
income
£m
-0.25%
change
in yield
£m
+0.25%
change
in yield
£m
(Decrease)/increase 
in the fair value of 
investment property
(4.4)
(45.8)
45.6
57.2
(52.1)
As at 31 December 2023
15% increase
in cost of EWS
Works
£m
-3% change
in rental
income
£m
+3% change
in rental
income
£m
-0.25%
change
in yield
£m
+0.25%
change
in yield
£m
(Decrease)/increase 
in the fair value of 
investment property
(4.9)
(45.1)
45.0
55.5
(50.5)
(f)	 Commercial properties
The key assumptions for the commercial properties are net initial yield, current rent and 
rental growth. A 3% movement in commercial rental income would not materially impact 
the commercial property valuation of £16.5 million at the year end (2023: £15.8 million).
12. Intangible assets
Year ended 31 December 2024
Group and 
Company
External 
software 
development
£m
Costs
As at 1 January 2024
4.6
Additions
2.7
As at 31 December 2024
7.3
Amortisation
As at 1 January 2024
(1.5)
Charge for the year
(0.3)
As at 31 December 2024
(1.8)
Net book value
As at 31 December 2024
5.5
Notes to the financial statements | continued

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Financial statements
171
Year ended 31 December 2023
Group and 
Company
External 
software 
development
£m
Costs
As at 1 January 2023
3.0
Additions
1.6
As at 31 December 2023
4.6
Amortisation
As at 1 January 2023
(1.1)
Charge for the year
(0.4)
As at 31 December 2023
(1.5)
Net book value
As at 31 December 2023
3.1
13. Property, plant and equipment
Year ended 31 December 2024
Group
Company
Fixtures 
and
fittings
£m
Computer
equipment
£m
Total
£m
Fixtures 
and
fittings
£m
Computer 
equipment
£m
Total
£m
Costs
As at 1 January 2024
1.8
0.6
2.4
1.7
0.3
2.0
Additions
–
0.1
0.1
–
0.1
0.1
As at 31 December 2024
1.8
0.7
2.5
1.7
0.4
2.1
Depreciation
As at 1 January 2024
(1.1)
(0.5)
(1.6)
(1.0)
(0.3)
(1.3)
Charge for the year
–
(0.1)
(0.1)
–
–
–
As at 31 December 2024
(1.1)
(0.6)
(1.7)
(1.0)
(0.3)
(1.3)
Net book value
As at 31 December 2024
0.7
0.1
0.8
0.7
0.1
0.8
Year ended 31 December 2023
Group
Company
Fixtures 
and
fittings
£m
Computer
equipment
£m
Total
£m
Fixtures 
and
fittings
£m
Computer 
equipment
£m
Total
£m
Costs
As at 1 January 2023
1.7
0.6
2.3
1.7
0.3
2.0
Additions
0.1
–
0.1
–
–
–
As at 31 December 2023
1.8
0.6
2.4
1.7
0.3
2.0
Depreciation
As at 1 January 2023
(0.8)
(0.4)
(1.2)
(0.8)
(0.2)
(1.0)
Charge for the year
(0.3)
(0.1)
(0.4)
(0.2)
(0.1)
(0.3)
As at 31 December 2023
(1.1)
(0.5)
(1.6)
(1.0)
(0.3)
(1.3)
Net book value
As at 31 December 2023
0.7
0.1
0.8
0.7
–
0.7
14. Trade and other receivables
Group
Company
31 December
2024
£m
31 December
2023
£m
31 December
2024
£m
31 December
2023
£m
Trade receivables
2.9
1.4
–
–
Other receivables
1.7
1.6
0.2
0.3
Prepayments
3.2
3.3
0.5
0.4
VAT recoverable
0.1
0.2
–
–
7.9
6.5
0.7
0.7
Amounts due from Group 
undertakings
–
–
819.3
391.4
7.9
6.5
820.0
392.1
In the Company, amounts owed from Group undertakings are classified as due within 
one year due to their legal agreements with the debtor, however, such amounts might 
be recovered after more than one year should the debtors’ circumstance not permit 
repayment on demand.
The Group’s trade receivables of £3.7 million at 31 December 2024 (2023: £1.4 million)  
is shown net of the provision for impairment of trade receivables of £1.9 million  
(2023: £2.1 million).

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Financial statements
172
14. Trade and other receivables continued
Movements on the Group provision for impairment of trade receivables were as follows:
Group
31 December
2024
£m
31 December
2023
£m
At 1 January
2.1
1.9
Increase in provision for receivables impairment
(0.2)
0.2
At 31 December
1.9
2.1
The provision for impairment of trade receivables is assessed at each reporting period. 
Where trade receivables have arisen in the year ended 31 December 2024, a provision for 
impairment is considered by applying the historic rate at which trade receivables have 
been deemed to be irrecoverable, and applying this to the revenue of that year. Where 
trade receivables have arisen in a prior year, a provision for impairment equal to the value 
of those trade receivables is recognised.
Provisions for impaired receivables have been included in property expenses in the 
income statement. Amounts charged to the impairment provision are generally written 
off when there is no expectation of recovery.
The maximum exposure to credit risk at the reporting date is the book value of each class 
of receivable mentioned above and its cash and cash equivalents. The Group does not 
hold any collateral as security, though in some instances students provide guarantors.
Management believes that the concentration of credit risk with respect to trade 
receivables is limited due to the Group’s customer base being broad and independent 
of each other, and because they are residing in the Group’s accommodation. As such we 
have regular communication with them.
At 31 December 2024, there were no material trade receivables overdue at the year end 
which have not been fully provided for, and no aged analysis of trade receivables has 
been included. The carrying value of trade and other receivables classified at amortised 
cost approximates fair value. The Company performed a review of the expected credit 
loss on the amounts due from Group undertakings; there was no provision made during 
the year (2023: £nil). There are no security obligations related to these amounts due from 
Group undertakings.
15. Held for sale assets
Group
31 December
2024
£m
31 December
2023
£m
At 1 January
22.4
13.7
Capital expenditure
0.4
0.4
Sale of investment property
(12.6)
(14.1)
Transfer to held for sale assets
2.7
22.4
Change in fair value during year1
(2.2)
–
At 31 December
10.7
22.4
1	
The change in fair value of investment property during the year for the Group was £15.4 million. Of this, a fair 
value gain of £17.6 million has been recorded in Investment Property, and a £2.2 million loss has been recorded 
in held for sale assets.
Management considers that two properties (2023: three properties) meet the conditions 
relating to assets held for sale under IFRS 5: Non-current Assets Held for Sale. The 
combined fair value in these financial statements is £10.7 million (2023: £22.4 million). 
One of the three assets, with book value of £2.7 million, completed on its disposal on 
29 January 2025 for consideration of £2.8 million. The remaining two assets are being 
actively marketed, management expects the sales to be completed in 2025. 
All assets held for sale fall within ‘Level 3’ as defined by IFRS. There have been no transfers 
within the fair value hierarchy during the year.
16. Cash and cash equivalents
Group
Company
31 December
2024
£m
31 December
2023
£m
31 December
2024
£m
31 December
2023
£m
Unrestricted cash and cash 
equivalents
36.0
11.0
24.7
2.4
Restricted cash and  
cash equivalents1
39.4
29.5
–
–
Cash and cash equivalents
75.4
40.5
24.7
2.4
1	
Restricted cash relates to certain bank accounts held by the Group where funds are not immediately available at 
31 December but may be utilised to settle contractual obligations.
Notes to the financial statements | continued

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Financial statements
173
17. Trade and other payables
Group
Company
31 December
2024
£m
31 December
2023
£m
31 December
2024
£m
31 December
2023
£m
Trade payables
0.8
1.3
0.1
0.3
Other payables
4.1
4.2
0.4
0.2
Accruals
14.3
17.9
1.6
2.9
19.2
23.4
2.1
3.4
Amounts owed to  
Group undertakings
–
–
454.8
111.0
19.2
23.4
456.9
114.4
The Directors consider that the carrying value of trade and other payables approximates 
to their fair value.
Amounts owed to Group undertakings are interest free and repayable on demand.
At 31 December 2024, there was deferred rental income of £34.8 million (2023: £34.9 
million) which was rental income that had been charged that relates to future periods.
18. Bank borrowings
A summary of the drawn and undrawn bank borrowings in the year is shown below:
Group
Bank
borrowings
drawn
31 December
2024
£m
Bank
borrowings
undrawn
31 December
2024
£m
Total
31 December
2024
£m
Bank
borrowings
drawn
31 December
2023
£m
Bank
borrowings
undrawn
31 December
2023
£m
Total
31 December
2023
£m
At 1 January
360.3
42.0
402.3
391.2
20.0
411.2
Bank borrowings 
repaid
(150.9)
–
(150.9)
(30.9)
24.6
(6.3)
Part cancellation 
of revolving credit 
facility
–
(2.0)
(2.0)
–
(22.6)
(22.6)
Unsecured facility 
refinanced
–
–
–
–
20.0
20.0
Bank borrowings 
drawn in the year
40.0
(40.0)
–
–
–
–
New facility drawn
124.9
–
124.9
–
–
–
At 31 December
374.3
–
374.3
360.3
42.0
402.3
At year end the Group had no undrawn borrowings (2023: two facilities with undrawn 
borrowings totalling £42 million). The weighted average term to maturity of the Group’s 
debt as at the year end is 4.7 years (2023: 3.9 years).
Bank borrowings are secured by charges over individual investment properties held by 
certain asset-holding subsidiaries. These assets have a fair value of £1,021.7 million at  
31 December 2024 (2023: £1,074.9 million). In some cases, the lenders also hold charges 
over the shares of the subsidiaries and the intermediary holding companies of those 
subsidiaries.
In March 2024, four small near term debt facilities were refinanced into one consolidated 
seven year £124.9 million facility. As the refinancing represented a substantial 
modification of terms, the near term facilities were derecognised, with accelerated 
unamortised arrangement fees of £0.9 million being charged to finance costs upon 
derecognition. The new £124.9 million facility is held at floating rate, subject to an 
interest rate cap with arrangement fees amortising on a straight line basis over the term 
of the facility.

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Financial statements
174
18. Bank borrowings continued
Any associated fees in arranging the bank borrowings unamortised as at the year end are 
offset against amounts drawn on the facilities as shown in the table below:
Non-current
Group
31 December
2024
£m
31 December
2023
£m
Balance brought forward
302.6
391.2
Total bank borrowings drawn in the year
164.9
–
Bank borrowings becoming non-current in the year
–
–
Less: Bank borrowings becoming current in the year
–
(57.7)
Less: Bank borrowings repaid during the year
(93.2)
(30.9)
Bank borrowings drawn: due in more than one year
374.3
302.6
Less: Unamortised costs
(3.9)
(2.4)
Bank borrowings due in more than one year
370.4
300.2
Current
Group
31 December
2024
£m
31 December
2023
£m
Balance brought forward
57.7
–
Total bank borrowings in the year
–
–
Less: Bank borrowings becoming non-current in the year 
(57.7)
–
Bank borrowings becoming current in the year
–
57.7
Bank borrowings drawn: due in less than one year
–
57.7
Less: Unamortised costs
–
(1.2)
Bank borrowings due in less than one year
–
56.5
Maturity of Bank Borrowings
Group
31 December
2024
£m
31 December
2023
£m
Repayable in less than one year
–
57.7
Repayable between one and two years
–
45.4
Repayable between two and five years
206.1
206.1
Repayable in over five years
168.2
51.1
Bank borrowings
374.3
360.3
All of the Group’s facilities have an interest charge payable quarterly. One of the facilities 
has an interest charge that is based on a margin above SONIA, however with an interest 
rate cap in place it has an effective fixed rate of 6.8%. Other facilities interest charges are 
fixed at 4.0%, 3.5%, 3.2% and 3.6%. The weighted average rate payable by the Group on its 
debt portfolio as at the year end was 4.5% (2023: 4.3%). 
The Group monitors its covenant position and headroom on a regular basis.  
At 31 December 2024, the Group was in full compliance with all of its borrowing 
covenants, which are tested quarterly on 31 March. 30 June, 30 September and  
31 December, annually. Interest coverage ratio covenants, across both historic and 
prospective, range from 150% to 225%. Loan to value covenants range from a minimum 
of 50% to a minimum 75%. Attention is also drawn to note 1.4 for conclusions reached in 
respect of Going Concern.
Fair value of fixed rate borrowings
The Group considers that all bank loans fall within ‘Level 3’ as defined by IFRS 13 ‘Fair 
value measurement’. The nominal value of floating rate borrowings is considered to be a 
reasonable approximation of fair value. However, the fair value of fixed rate borrowings 
at the reporting date has been calculated by discounting cash flows under the relevant 
agreements at indicative interest rates for similar debt instruments using indicative rates 
provided by lenders or advisers, which are considered unobservable.
Group
31 December
2024
£m
31 December
20231
£m
Nominal value of fixed rate borrowings
257.2
270.9
Fair value adjustment 
(20.7)
(20.9)
Fair value of fixed rate borrowings
236.5
250.0
1	
Restated to reflect full application of the equity method.
Notes to the financial statements | continued

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Financial statements
175
The Group has bank loans with a total carrying value of £374.3 million, including the 
nominal value of fixed rate borrowings of £257.2 million. The fair value equivalent at the 
reporting date of the fixed rate debt was £236.5 million (2023 restated: £250.0 million). 
The discount rate was arrived at after considering the weighted average cost of capital, 
an unlevered property discount rate, the market rate and the loan to value.
An increase in the discount rate by 20 basis points would result in a decrease of the fair 
value of the fixed rate borrowings by £2.0 million (2023 restated: £2.0 million).  
A decrease in the discount rate by 20 basis points would result in an increase of the fair 
value of the fixed rate borrowings by £2.0 million (2023 restated: £2.0 million).
19. Share capital
Group and Company
Group and Company
31 December
2024
Number
31 December
2024
£m
31 December
2023
Number
31 December
2023
£m
Balance brought forward
603,437,683
6.0
603,351,880
6.0
Capital raise
60,350,664
0.6
–
–
Exercise of share options
208,497
–
85,803
–
Balance carried forward
663,996,844
6.6
603,437,683
6.0
On 17 October 2024 60,350,664 shares were issued at an average price of 93.0 pence per 
share raising gross proceeds of £56.1 million.
During the year 208,497 shares were issued to satisfy the exercise of options under the 
Long Term Incentive Plan and the Sharesave scheme offered to employees of the Group 
(2023: 85,803 shares).
20. Share premium
The share premium relates to amounts subscribed for share capital in excess of  
nominal value:
Group and Company
31 December
2024
£m
31 December
2023
£m
Balance brought forward
0.3
0.3
Share premium relating to shares issued during the year
53.8
–
Balance carried forward
54.1
0.3
21. Capital reduction reserve
Group and Company
31 December
2024
£m
31 December
2023
£m
Balance brought forward
424.1
444.7
Reserves transfer
–
0.1
Less interim dividends declared and paid per Note 10
(22.0)
(20.7)
Balance carried forward
402.1
424.1
The capital reduction reserve account is a distributable reserve
22. Leasing agreements
Future total minimum lease receivables under non-cancellable operating leases on 
investment properties are as follows:
Group and Company
31 December
2024
£m
31 December
2023
£m
Less than one year
22.0
20.1
Between one and two years
1.2
1.2
Between two and three years
1.0
1.1
Between three and four years
0.8
0.9
Between four and five years
0.8
0.7
More than five years
7.1
5.9
Total
32.9
29.9
The above relates to assured shorthold tenancies (ASTs) and commercial leases in place 
as at, and had commenced by, 31 December 2024.
23. Contingent liabilities
There were no contingent liabilities at 31 December 2024 (31 December 2023: £nil).
24. Capital commitments
The Group was contractually committed to expenditure of £2.8 million at 31 December 
2024 (31 December 2023: £1.7 million) for the future development and enhancement of 
investment property.

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Financial statements
176
25. Related party disclosures
Key Management Personnel
Key management personnel are considered to comprise the Board of Directors. Please 
refer to Note 6 for details of the remuneration for the key management.
Share Capital
The below sets out the share capital transactions during the year with related parties:
Date
Related party
Nature of related party
Nature of transaction
Number of 
shares
17-Oct-24
Mark Pain
Chair of the Board
Capital Raise Share 
Purchase
20,000
17-Oct-24
Duncan Garrood
Chief Executive 
Officer
Capital Raise Share 
Purchase
32,000
17-Oct-24
Donald Grant
Chief Financial 
and Sustainability 
Officer
Capital Raise Share 
Purchase
20,876
17-Oct-24
Alice Avis
Senior 
Independent Non-
Executive Director
Capital Raise Share 
Purchase
6,000
14-Nov-24
Duncan Garrood
Chief Executive 
Officer
Sharesave Plan 
Share Purchase
25,316
The shares issued to Duncan Garrood as part of the Sharesave Plan derived a gain of 
£4,532 when exercised.
Dividends
The below sets out the dividends transactions during the year with related parties:
Date
Related party
Nature of related party
Nature of transaction
Number of 
shares
Paid 
quarterly
Mark Pain
Chair of the Board
Dividends received 
on shareholding
£3,738
Paid 
quarterly
Duncan Garrood
Chief Executive 
Officer
Dividends received 
on shareholding
£3,819
Paid 
quarterly
Donald Grant
Chief Financial 
and Sustainability 
Officer
Dividends received 
on shareholding
£1,365
Paid 
quarterly
Alice Avis
Senior 
Independent Non-
Executive Director
Dividends received 
on shareholding
£1,962
During the year £85,361 was paid to AXA PPP Healthcare Limited, a subsidiary of AXA 
Insurance UK PLC, in relation to the employee healthcare plan. Mark Pain, Chair of the 
Board, is Chair of the Board of AXA Insurance UK PLC. Of this amount, £24,866 was 
included in trade and other payables at year end.
Share-based Payments
The below sets out the awards to related parties during the year under the Empiric 
Student Property plc Long Term Incentive Plan and the Deferred Bonus Scheme: 
Date
Related party
Nature of related party
Nature of transaction
Number of 
shares
12-Apr-24
Duncan Garrood
Chief Executive 
Officer
LTIP Nil-cost 
Option Grant over 
Ordinary Shares
728,294
12-Apr-24
Duncan Garrood
Chief Executive 
Officer
Deferred Bonus 
Plan Option Grant 
over Ordinary 
Shares
136,476
12-Apr-24
Donald Grant
Chief Financial 
and Sustainability 
Officer
LTIP Nil-cost 
Option Grant over 
Ordinary Shares
515,135
12-Apr-24
Donald Grant
Chief Financial 
and Sustainability 
Officer
Deferred Bonus 
Plan Option Grant 
over Ordinary 
Shares
96,532
26. Subsequent events
On 28 January 2025 the Group commenced a collective consultation on proposals aimed 
at implementing certain organisational changes. The proposal is expected to complete 
by 31 March 2025 and dependent on the conclusions reached, could result in up to £0.6 
million of related restructuring costs being incurred.
On 29 January 2025, the Group completed on the disposal of Radway House, Bath for 
consideration of £2.8 million.
Notes to the financial statements | continued

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Financial statements
177
27. Share-based payments
The Company operates two equity-settled share-based remuneration schemes for 
Executive Directors (deferred annual bonus and LTIP schemes) and certain members of 
the Senior Leadership Team (“SLT”) who participate in the LTIP scheme. The details of the 
schemes are included in the Remuneration Committee Report. The Group also operates a 
Save As You Earn (SAYE) scheme for employees.
On 12 April 2024, the Company granted nil-cost options over a total of 1,243,429 (Duncan 
Garrood 728,294 and Donald Grant 515,135) ordinary shares pursuant to the Empiric 
Student Property plc Long Term Incentive Plan for the 2024 financial year.
During the year, the Company granted nil-cost options over a total of 772,967 ordinary 
shares to members of the Senior Leadership Team pursuant to the Empiric Student 
Property plc Long Term Incentive Plan for the 2024 financial year.
During the year, the Company granted options over a total of 201,922 ordinary shares in 
relation to the Save As You Earn scheme at an exercise price of £0.77. The earliest date on 
which the options will become exercisable is 1 July 2027.
Of the nil-cost options, 72,396 were exercisable at 31 December 2024. The weighted 
average remaining contractual life of these options was 0.2 years (2023: 1.2 years).
During the year to 31 December 2024 the amount recognised in the Statement of 
Comprehensive Income relating to option plans was £0.3 million (2023: £0.7 million).
The awards have the benefit of dividend equivalence. The Remuneration Committee will 
determine on or before vesting whether the dividend equivalent will be provided in the 
form of cash and/or shares.
31/12/2024
31/12/2023
31/12/2022
31/12/2021
31/12/2020
31/12/2019
Outstanding 
number brought 
forward
4,866,099
3,756,874 3,446,320
2,314,539 1,250,045
1,051,708
Granted during  
the period
2,451,326
1,886,191 2,430,279 
1,725,577 1,064,494
604,134
Vested and 
exercised during 
the period
(182,563)
(80,116)
(127,492) 
(35,779)
–
(129,253)
Lapsed during  
the period
(1,523,881) (696,850) (1,992,233)
(558,017)
–
(276,544)
Outstanding 
number carried 
forward
5,610,981 4,866,099  3,756,874 3,446,320
2,314,539 1,250,045
The fair value on date of grant for the nil-cost options under the LTIP Awards and Annual 
Bonus Awards were priced using the Monte Carlo pricing model. The weighted average 
share price for the options exercised in the period was 90.9 pence per share. For those 
share options outstanding at year end, the exercise prices ranged from 75.5 pence per 
share to 78.9 pence per share, and the weighted average of the remaining contractual life 
of those shares is 1.6 years.
The following information is relevant in the determination of the fair value of the options 
granted in the year, for those related to market based vesting conditions:
Deferred 
bonus shares
LTIPs (market 
based 
conditions)
LTIPs (Total 
Return 
conditions)
SAYE Award
(a)
Share price at grant date
£0.91
£0.91
£0.91
£0.92
(b)
Exercise price
£nil
£nil
£nil
£0.77
(c)
Vesting period
3 years
3 years
3 years
3 years
(d)
Expected volatility
N/A
23.5%
N/A
24.1%
(e)
Risk-free rate
N/A
4.3%
N/A
4.2%
The volatility assumption is based on a statistical analysis of daily share prices of 
comparator companies over the last three years.
The TSR performance conditions have been considered when assessing the fair value of 
the options.

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Financial statements
178
28. Financial risk management
Financial Instruments
The Group’s principal financial assets and liabilities are those which arise directly from 
its operations: trade and other receivables, trade and other payables; and cash and cash 
equivalents. Set out below is a comparison by class of the carrying amounts and fair value 
of the Group’s financial instruments that are shown in the financial statements:
Reconciliation of liabilities to cash flows from financing activities
31 December
2024
£m
31 December
2023
£m
Bank borrowings and leasehold liability at start of the year
357.8
387.8
Cash flows from financing activities
Bank borrowings drawn
164.9
–
Bank borrowings repaid
(150.8)
(30.9)
Lease liability paid
(0.2)
(0.2)
Loan arrangement fees paid
(2.2)
(0.1)
Non-cash movements
Amortisation of loan arrangement fees
1.7
1.2
Recognition of lease liabilities
0.1
–
Bank borrowings and leasehold liability at end of the year
371.3
357.8
Risk Management
The Company and Group is exposed to market risk (including interest rate risk), credit 
risk and liquidity risk. 
The Board of Directors oversees the management of these risks.
The Board of Directors reviews and agrees policies for managing each of these risks 
which are summarised below.
(a) Market Risk
Market risk is the risk that the fair values of financial instruments will fluctuate because of 
changes in market prices. The financial instruments held by the Company and Group that 
are affected by market risk are principally the Company and Group bank balances.
(b) Credit Risk
Credit risk is the risk of financial loss to the Company and Group if a customer or 
counterparty to a financial instrument fails to meet its contractual obligations.  
The Company and Group is exposed to credit risks from both its leasing activities  
and financing activities, including deposits with banks and financial institutions.
The Group has established a credit policy under which each new tenant is assessed 
based on an extensive credit rating scorecard at the time of entering into a  
lease agreement.
The Group’s review includes external rating, when available, and in some cases bank 
references.
The Group determines concentrations of credit risk by monthly monitoring the 
creditworthiness rating of existing customers and through a monthly review of the trade 
receivables’ ageing analysis.
Credit risk also arises from cash and cash equivalents and deposits with banks and 
financial institutions. For banks and financial institutions, only independently rated 
parties with minimum rating “B” are accepted.
Further disclosures regarding trade and other receivables, which are neither past due nor 
impaired, are provided in Note 14.
(i) Tenant Receivables
Tenant receivables, primarily tenant rentals, are presented in the Consolidated Statement 
of Financial Position net of allowances for doubtful receivables and are monitored on a 
case-by-case basis. Credit risk is primarily managed by requiring tenants to pay rentals in 
advance and performing tests around strength of covenant prior to acquisition. 
(ii) Credit Risk Related to Financial Instruments and Cash Deposits
One of the principal credit risks of the Company and Group arises with the banks and 
financial institutions. The Board of Directors believes that the credit risk on short-term 
deposits and current account cash balances are limited because the counterparties are 
banks, which are committed lenders to the Company and Group, with high credit ratings 
assigned by international credit rating agencies.
Credit ratings (Moody’s)
Long-term
Outlook
Canada Life
Aa3
Stable
Mass Mutual
Aa3
Stable
Scottish Widows
A2
Positive
Aareal Bank AG
Baa1
Stable
Notes to the financial statements | continued

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Financial statements
179
(c) Liquidity Risk
Liquidity risk arises from the Company and Group management of working capital, and 
going forward, the finance charges and principal repayments on any borrowings, of 
which currently there are none. It is the risk that the Company and Group will encounter 
difficulty in meeting their financial obligations as they fall due as the majority of the 
Company and Group assets are property investments and are therefore not readily 
realisable. The Company and Group objective is to ensure they have sufficient available 
funds for their operations and to fund their capital expenditure. This is achieved by 
continuous monitoring of forecast and actual cash flows by management.
The monitoring of liquidity is also assisted by the quarterly review of covenants which are 
ordinarily imposed by lenders, such as loan to value and interest cover ratios. The loan 
to value ratio is typically expressed as the outstanding loan principal as a percentage 
of a lender approved valuation of the underlying properties secured under the facility. 
Interest cover ratio’s reflect the quantum or finance costs (either historic or forecast) as a 
multiple of recurring earnings, normally a measure of gross profit. As part of the Group’s 
viability modelling, certain scenarios are considered to model the impact on liquidity.  
All of the Group’s covenants are currently compliant and it is envisaged that compliance 
will continue to be achieved in a reasonably severe downside scenario. The Group’s 
portfolio could currently withstand a 16 per cent decline in property valuations before a 
breach in loan to value covenants are triggered. The Group’s average interest cover ratio 
across all facilities is 1.9 times, whereas gross profit is currently in excess of 3.0 times 
total finance costs, providing a good degree of comfort.
Bank borrowings would be renegotiated in advance of any potential covenant 
breaches, insofar as factors are within the control of the Group. Facility agreements 
typically contain cure provisions providing for prepayment, cash deposits or security 
enhancement as maybe required to mitigate any potential breach. The Group’s 
borrowings are spread across a range of lenders and maturities so as to minimise any 
potential concentration of risk.
The following table sets out the contractual obligations (representing undiscounted 
contractual cash flows) of financial liabilities:
Group
On demand
£m
Less than 3
months
£m
3 to 12
months
£m
1 to 5
years
£m
Greater than 
5 years
£m
Total
£m
At 31 December 
2024
Bank borrowings 
and interest
–
4.1
12.6
263.3
179.1
459.1
Trade and other 
payables
–
19.2
–
–
–
19.2
–
23.3
12.6
263.3
179.1
478.3
Group
On demand
£m
Less than 3
months
£m
3 to 12
months
£m
1 to 5
years
£m
Greater than 
5 years
£m
Total
£m
At 31 December 
2023
Bank borrowings 
and interest
–
17.6
54.8
286.3
54.6
413.3
Trade and other 
payables
–
23.4
–
–
–
23.4
–
41.0
54.8
286.3
54.6
436.7
29. Capital management
The primary objectives of the Group’s capital management are to ensure that it remains a 
going concern and continues to qualify for UK REIT status.
The Board of Directors monitors and reviews the Group’s capital so as to promote the 
long-term success of the business, facilitate expansion and to maintain sustainable 
returns for shareholders.
Capital consists of ordinary shares, other capital reserves and retained earnings.

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Financial statements
180
30. Investments in subsidiaries
Investments in subsidiaries are accounted for at cost less any accumulated impairment 
losses in the Company’s Statement of Financial Position. The carrying amounts of these 
investments are reviewed for impairment whenever events or changes in circumstances 
indicate that their carrying amount may not be recoverable, with any impairment being 
recognised in the statement of comprehensive income. During the year, the Company 
assessed the carrying value of its investments in subsidiaries and concluded that no 
impairment was required.
Those entities listed below are considered subsidiaries of the Company at 31 December 
2024, with the shares issued being ordinary shares. All subsidiaries are registered at the 
following address: 1st Floor Hop Yard Studios, 72 Borough High Street, London, SE1 1XF.
In each case the country of incorporation is England and Wales.
Company
31 December
2024
£m
31 December
2023
£m
As at 1 January
222.6
222.6
Additions in the year
–
–
Disposals
–
–
Balance at 31 December
222.6
222.6
During 2024, there were a number of subsidiaries which moved within the Group, due to 
reorganisations relating to debt refinancing.
Company
Status
Ownership
Principal activity
Brunswick Contracting Limited
Active**
100%
Property Contracting
Empiric (Alwyn Court) Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Baptists Chapel) Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Bath Canalside) Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Bath James House) Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Bath JSW) Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Bath Oolite Road) Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Bath Piccadilly Place) Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Birmingham Emporium) Limited Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Birmingham) Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Bristol CH) Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Company
Status
Ownership
Principal activity
Empiric (Bristol St Mary’s) Leasing 
Limited
Active**
100%
Property Leasing
Empiric (Bristol St Mary’s) Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Bristol) Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Buccleuch Street) Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Canterbury Franciscans) 
Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Canterbury Pavilion Court) 
Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Cardiff Wndsr House)  
Leasing Limited
Dormant
100%
Property Leasing
Empiric (Cardiff Wndsr House) Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Centro Court) Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Claremont Newcastle) Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (College Green) Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Developments) Limited
Dormant*
100%
Development 
Management
Empiric (Edge Apartments) Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Edinburgh KSR) Leasing Limited Active**
100%
Property Leasing
Empiric (Edinburgh KSR) Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Edinburgh South Bridge) 
Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Exeter Bishop Blackall School) 
Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Exeter Bonhay Road) Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Exeter City Service) Limited
Dormant*
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Exeter DCL) Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Exeter LL) Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Falmouth Maritime Studios) 
Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Falmouth Ocean Bowl) Leasing 
Limited
Active**
100%
Property Leasing
Empiric (Falmouth Ocean Bowl) Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Glasgow Ballet School) Limited Active**
100%
Property Investment
Notes to the financial statements | continued

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Financial statements
181
Company
Status
Ownership
Principal activity
Empiric (Glasgow Bath St) Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Glasgow George St) Leasing 
Limited
Active**
100%
Property Leasing
Empiric (Glasgow George St) Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Glasgow) Leasing Limited
Active**
100%
Property Leasing
Empiric (Glasgow) Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Hatfield CP) Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Huddersfield Oldgate House) 
Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Huddersfield Snow Island) 
Leasing Limited
Dormant*
100%
Property Leasing
Empiric (Lancaster Penny Street 1) 
Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Lancaster Penny Street 2) 
Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Lancaster Penny Street 3) 
Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Leeds Algernon) Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Leeds Pennine House) Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Leeds St Marks) Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Leicester 134 New Walk) 
Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Leicester 136-138 New Walk) 
Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Leicester 140-142 New Walk) 
Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Leicester 160 Upper New Walk) 
Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Leicester Bede Park) Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Leicester De Montfort Square) 
Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Leicester Hosiery Factory) 
Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Leicester Peacock Lane) 
Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Company
Status
Ownership
Principal activity
Empiric (Leicester Shoe & Boot Factory) 
Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Liverpool Art School/Maple 
House) Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Liverpool Grove Street) Limited Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Liverpool Hahnemann Building) 
Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Liverpool Octagon/Hayward) 
Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (London Camberwell) Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (London Road) Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Manchester Ladybarn) Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Manchester TH) Limited 
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Manchester Victoria Point) 
Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Newcastle Metrovick) Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Northgate House) Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Nottingham 95 Talbot) Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Nottingham Frontage) Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Oxford Stonemason) Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Picturehouse Apartments) 
Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Portobello House) Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Portsmouth Elm Grove Library) 
Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Portsmouth Europa House) 
Leasing Limited
Active**
100%
Property Leasing
Empiric (Portsmouth Europa House) 
Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Portsmouth Kingsway House) 
Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Portsmouth Registry) Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Provincial House) Leasing 
Limited
Active**
100%
Property Leasing

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Financial statements
182
Company
Status
Ownership
Principal activity
Empiric (Provincial House) Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Reading Saxon Court) Leasing 
Limited
Active**
100%
Property Leasing
Empiric (Reading Saxon Court) Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Snow Island) Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Southampton Emily Davies) 
Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Southampton) Leasing Limited
Active**
100%
Property Leasing
Empiric (Southampton) Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (St Andrews Ayton House) 
Leasing Limited
Active**
100%
Property Leasing
Empiric (St Andrews Ayton House) 
Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (St Peter Street) Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Stoke Caledonia Mill) Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Summit House) Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Talbot Studios) Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Trippet Lane) Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (Twickenham Grosvenor Hall) 
Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (York Foss Studios 1) Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (York Lawrence Street) Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric (York Percy’s Lane) Limited
Active**
100%
Property Investment
Empiric Acquisitions Limited
Dormant*
100%
Immediate Holding 
Company
Empiric Investment Holdings (Eight) 
Limited
Active**
100%
Holding Company
Empiric Investment Holdings (Five) 
Limited
Active**
100%
Holding Company
Empiric Investment Holdings (Four) 
Limited
Active**
100%
Holding Company
Company
Status
Ownership
Principal activity
Empiric Investment Holdings (Seven) 
Limited
Active**
100%
Holding Company
Empiric Investment Holdings (Six) 
Limited
Active**
100%
Holding Company
Empiric Investment Holdings (Two) 
Limited
Active**
100%
Holding Company
Empiric Investments (Eight) Limited
Active
100%
Immediate Holding 
Company
Empiric Investments (Five) Limited
Active
100%
Immediate Holding 
Company
Empiric Investments (Four) Limited
Active
100%
Immediate Holding 
Company
Empiric Investments (One) Limited
Dormant
100%
Immediate Holding 
Company
Empiric Investments (Seven) Limited
Active**
100%
Immediate Holding 
Company
Empiric Investments (Six) Limited
Active**
100%
Immediate Holding 
Company
Empiric Investments (Three) Limited
Active**
100%
Immediate Holding 
Company
Empiric Investments (Two) Limited
Active
100%
Immediate Holding 
Company
Empiric Student Property Trustees 
Limited
Dormant
100%
Trustee
Hello Student Management Limited
Active
100%
Property 
Management
*	
Company in liquidation since September 2024
**	 These companies are claiming an exemption from audit under sections 479A of the Companies Act 2006
Notes to the financial statements | continued
30. Investments in subsidiaries continued

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Financial statements
183
31. Alternative performance measures
The below sets out our alternative performance measures.
Gross margin – Gross profit expressed as a percentage of rental income.  
A business KPI to monitor how efficiently we are running our buildings.
Gross Margin
Group
31 December
2024
£m
31 December
2023
£m
Revenue
84.2
80.5
Property Expenses
(25.6)
(25.2)
Gross profit
58.6
55.3
Gross Margin calculated as Gross profit/Revenue
70%
69%
Total accounting return – The growth of EPRA NTA per share plus dividends per share 
measured as a percentage. A key business indicator used to monitor the level of overall 
return the Group is generating.
Total accounting return
Group
31 December
2024
(Pence)
31 December
2023
(Pence)
EPRA NTA per share at start of year
120.7 
 115.4 
EPRA NTA per share at end of year
119.6 
120.7
EPRA NTA growth/(reduction) per share in the period
(1.1) 
5.3 
Dividend per share paid in year
3.6
 3.4 
Dividends plus growth in EPRA NTA
2.5
8.7
Total accounting return calculated as Dividends plus EPRA 
NTA growth in year per share/ NTA at start of year (%)
2.0
7.6
EPRA Loan to Value – a measure of gearing, calculated as gross borrowings without 
deducting unamortised financing costs, less cash and adjusted for net receivables or 
payables and intangibles, divided by gross portfolio valuation. This was 27.2 per cent for 
the year (2023: 30.6 per cent).
Dividend cover – a measure of EPRA earnings relative to dividends declared for the year. 
This was 114 per cent for the year (2023: 114 per cent).
Dividend pay-out ratio – a measure of dividends relative to EPRA earnings. This was  
88 per cent for the year (2023: 88 per cent).

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Financial statements
184
Five year historical record
31 December
2024
£m
31 December
2023
£m
31 December
2022
£m
31 December
2021
£m
31 December
2020
£m
Revenue
84.2
80.5
73.0
56.0
59.4
Direct costs
(25.6)
(25.2)
(24.0)
(23.1)
(22.7)
Gross profit
58.6
55.3
49.0
32.9
36.7
Gross margin
69.6%
68.7%
67.1%
58.8%
61.8%
Administrative expenses
(15.4)
(14.0)
(13.4)
(10.6)
(9.8)
Gain/(loss) on disposals
(4.2)
(0.6)
1.5
1.7
–
Property revaluation
15.4
30.1
45.6
17.6
(37.6)
Operating profit
54.4
70.8
82.7
41.6
(10.7)
Net finance costs
(18.7)
(17.2)
(15.0)
(12.4)
(13.3)
Derivative fair value movement
(1.3)
(0.2)
–
–
–
Net profit/(loss)
34.4
53.4
67.7
29.2
(24.0)
EPRA EPS (pence)
4.2 
 4.0 
3.4
1.7
2.3
Portfolio valuation1
1,135.0
1,098.1
1,079.4
995.9
1,005.1
Borrowings
(370.4)
(356.7)
(386.5)
(371.0)
(385.3)
Other net assets/(liabilities)
36.7
(7.2)
7.9
22.7
13.5
Net assets
801.3
734.2
700.8
647.6
633.3
EPRA NTA
800.8
734.1
700.8
647.6
633.3
EPRA NTA per share
119.6 
 120.7 
115.4
106.8
104.6
Shares in issue
663,996,844
603,437,683 
603,351,880
603,203,052
603,160,940
Weighted average cost of debt
4.5%
4.3%
4.0%
3.0%
2.9%
Weighted average debt maturity
4.7 years 
 3.9 years 
4.8 years
4.9 years
5.9 years
Property LTV
29.1%
31.1%
33.1%
35.4%
EPRA LTV
27.2%
30.6%
32.7%
1	
Includes properties classified as held for sale and under development

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Financial statements
185
Glossary
Alternative Performance Measures (“APM”) – Performance measures to supplement 
IFRS to provide users of the Annual Report with a better understanding of the underlying 
performance of the Group’s property portfolio.
Colleague Engagement – Calculated using the results of our biannual colleague 
engagement surveys.
Company – Empiric Student Property plc.
Dividend Cover – EPRA earnings divided by dividends declared for the year.
Dividend pay-out ratio – Dividends declared relative to EPRA earnings.
EPRA – European Public Real Estate Association.
EPRA basic EPS – EPRA Earnings divided by the weighted average number of ordinary 
shares outstanding during the period (refer to Note 8).
EPRA diluted EPS - EPRA Earnings divided by the weighted average number of shares 
during the period, taking into account all potentially issuable shares. 
EPRA Earnings – the IFRS profit after taxation excluding investment and development 
property revaluations, gains/losses on investing property disposals and changes in the 
fair value of financial instruments.
EPRA Loan to Value – a measure of gearing, calculated as gross borrowings without 
deducting unamortised financing costs, less cash and adjusted for net receivables or 
payables and intangibles, divided by gross portfolio valuation.
EPRA Net Disposal Value (“NDV”) – Represents the shareholders’ value under a disposal 
scenario. The value of the Company assuming assets are sold, and the liabilities are 
settled and not held to maturity.
EPRA Net Reinvestment Value (“NRV”) – The value of the assets on a long-term basis, 
assets and liabilities are not expected to crystallise under normal circumstances.
EPRA Net Tangible Assets (“NTA”) – Assumes the underlying value of the Company 
assuming it buys and sells assets. 
Gross margin – Gross profit expressed as a percentage of revenue.
Group – Empiric Student Property plc and its subsidiaries.
Hello Student – Our customer-facing brand and operating platform. 
HMO – House in multiple occupation.
IFRS – International Financial Reporting Standards.
IFRS EPS – IFRS earnings divided by the weighted average number of ordinary shares 
outstanding during the period.
Like for like rental growth – Compares the growth in rental income for operational assets, 
throughout both the current and comparative year, and excludes acquisitions, disposals 
and developments.
Like for like valuation (gross) – Compares the growth in capital values of the Group’s 
standing portfolio from the prior year end to the current year end, excluding acquisitions 
and disposals.
Like for like valuation (net) – Compares the growth in capital values of the Group’s 
standing portfolio from the prior year end to the current year end, excluding acquisitions, 
disposals, capital expenditure and development properties.
Net Asset Value or NAV – Net Asset Value is the net assets in the Statement of Financial 
Position.
PBSA – Purpose Built Student Accommodation.
Postgrad – Postgraduate students who have successfully completed an undergraduate 
course and are undertaking further studies at a more advanced level.
RCF – Revolving credit facility.
REIT – Real estate investment trust.
Revenue Occupancy – Calculated as the percentage of our Gross Annualised Revenue we 
have achieved for an academic year.
RICS – Royal Institution of Chartered Surveyors.
SONIA – Sterling Over Night Index Average is the effective reference for overnight 
indexed swaps for unsecured transactions in the Sterling market. The SONIA itself is a 
risk-free rate.
Total accounting return – The growth in EPRA NTA over the period plus dividends paid 
for the period expressed as a percentage of opening EPRA NTA.
Weighted average cost of debt – Debt weighted by value multiplied by the interest rate.
Weighted average debt maturity – The weighted average term of our debt facilities at 
the balance sheet date.

Empiric Student Property plc  |  Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Financial statements
186
Company information and corporate advisers
Empiric Student Property plc
1st Floor Hop Yard Studios 
72 Borough High Street 
London, SE1 1XF
t +44 (0)20 8078 8791
e info@empiric.co.uk
More information on 
www.empiric.co.uk
Company Registration Number: 08886906 
Incorporated in the UK
Empiric Student Property plc is a public company limited by shares
Registered office
1st Floor Hop Yard Studios 
72 Borough High Street 
London, SE1 1XF
DIRECTORS AND ADVISERS
Directors
Mark Pain (Chairman)
Duncan Garrood (Chief Executive Officer)
Donald Grant (Chief Financial and Sustainability Officer)
Alice Avis (Non-Executive Director, Senior Independent Director)
Martin Ratchford (Non-Executive Director)
Clair Preston-Beer (Non-Executive Director)
Broker and joint financial adviser
Jefferies International Ltd
100 Bishopsgate
London, EC2N 4JL
Broker and joint financial adviser
Peel Hunt LLP
7th Floor 
100 Liverpool Street
London, EC2M 2AT
Legal adviser to the Company
Gowling WLG (UK) LLP
4 More London Riverside 
London, SE1 2AU
Company Secretary
Lisa Hibberd
1st Floor Hop Yard Studios 
72 Borough High Street 
London, SE1 1XF
Registrar
Computershare Investor Services PLC
The Pavilions
Bridgwater Road
Bristol, BA13 6ZZ
External auditor
BDO LLP
55 Baker Street
London, W1U 7EU
Communications adviser
FTI Consulting LLP
200 Aldersgate 
Aldersgate Street
London, EC1A 4HD
Valuer
CBRE Limited
Henrietta House
Henrietta Place
London, W1G 0NB
Tax adviser
KPMG
15 Canada Square
London, E14 5GL


Empiric Student Property plc
1st Floor Hop Yard Studios 
72 Borough High Street 
London 
SE1 1XF
T +44 (0)20 8078 8791 
E info@empiric.co.uk
More information on
www.empiric.co.uk